dep: Add FFmpeg v7.0.2 headers
This commit is contained in:
parent
ee07e9e0f1
commit
d5b6d35d3e
|
@ -0,0 +1,502 @@
|
|||
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
|
||||
Version 2.1, February 1999
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
|
||||
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
|
||||
|
||||
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts
|
||||
as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence
|
||||
the version number 2.1.]
|
||||
|
||||
Preamble
|
||||
|
||||
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
|
||||
freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
|
||||
Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change
|
||||
free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users.
|
||||
|
||||
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some
|
||||
specially designated software packages--typically libraries--of the
|
||||
Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it. You
|
||||
can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether
|
||||
this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better
|
||||
strategy to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
|
||||
|
||||
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use,
|
||||
not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that
|
||||
you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge
|
||||
for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get
|
||||
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of
|
||||
it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do
|
||||
these things.
|
||||
|
||||
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
|
||||
distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these
|
||||
rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for
|
||||
you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
|
||||
|
||||
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis
|
||||
or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave
|
||||
you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source
|
||||
code. If you link other code with the library, you must provide
|
||||
complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them
|
||||
with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling
|
||||
it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
|
||||
|
||||
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the
|
||||
library, and (2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal
|
||||
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library.
|
||||
|
||||
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that
|
||||
there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the library is
|
||||
modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know
|
||||
that what they have is not the original version, so that the original
|
||||
author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be
|
||||
introduced by others.
|
||||
|
||||
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of
|
||||
any free program. We wish to make sure that a company cannot
|
||||
effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a
|
||||
restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that
|
||||
any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be
|
||||
consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license.
|
||||
|
||||
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the
|
||||
ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser
|
||||
General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and
|
||||
is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We use
|
||||
this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those
|
||||
libraries into non-free programs.
|
||||
|
||||
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using
|
||||
a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a
|
||||
combined work, a derivative of the original library. The ordinary
|
||||
General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the
|
||||
entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General
|
||||
Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with
|
||||
the library.
|
||||
|
||||
We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License because it
|
||||
does Less to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General
|
||||
Public License. It also provides other free software developers Less
|
||||
of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages
|
||||
are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many
|
||||
libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain
|
||||
special circumstances.
|
||||
|
||||
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to
|
||||
encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes
|
||||
a de-facto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be
|
||||
allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free
|
||||
library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this
|
||||
case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free
|
||||
software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License.
|
||||
|
||||
In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free
|
||||
programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of
|
||||
free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in
|
||||
non-free programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU
|
||||
operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating
|
||||
system.
|
||||
|
||||
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the
|
||||
users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is
|
||||
linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run
|
||||
that program using a modified version of the Library.
|
||||
|
||||
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
|
||||
modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a
|
||||
"work based on the library" and a "work that uses the library". The
|
||||
former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must
|
||||
be combined with the library in order to run.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
|
||||
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
|
||||
|
||||
0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other
|
||||
program which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or
|
||||
other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of
|
||||
this Lesser General Public License (also called "this License").
|
||||
Each licensee is addressed as "you".
|
||||
|
||||
A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data
|
||||
prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs
|
||||
(which use some of those functions and data) to form executables.
|
||||
|
||||
The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work
|
||||
which has been distributed under these terms. A "work based on the
|
||||
Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under
|
||||
copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a
|
||||
portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated
|
||||
straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is
|
||||
included without limitation in the term "modification".)
|
||||
|
||||
"Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for
|
||||
making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means
|
||||
all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated
|
||||
interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation
|
||||
and installation of the library.
|
||||
|
||||
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
|
||||
covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
|
||||
running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from
|
||||
such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based
|
||||
on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for
|
||||
writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does
|
||||
and what the program that uses the Library does.
|
||||
|
||||
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's
|
||||
complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that
|
||||
you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an
|
||||
appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
|
||||
all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any
|
||||
warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the
|
||||
Library.
|
||||
|
||||
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy,
|
||||
and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a
|
||||
fee.
|
||||
|
||||
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion
|
||||
of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and
|
||||
distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
|
||||
above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
|
||||
|
||||
a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
|
||||
|
||||
b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices
|
||||
stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
|
||||
|
||||
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no
|
||||
charge to all third parties under the terms of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a
|
||||
table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses
|
||||
the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility
|
||||
is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that,
|
||||
in the event an application does not supply such function or
|
||||
table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of
|
||||
its purpose remains meaningful.
|
||||
|
||||
(For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has
|
||||
a purpose that is entirely well-defined independent of the
|
||||
application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any
|
||||
application-supplied function or table used by this function must
|
||||
be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square
|
||||
root function must still compute square roots.)
|
||||
|
||||
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
|
||||
identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library,
|
||||
and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
|
||||
themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
|
||||
sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
|
||||
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
|
||||
on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
|
||||
this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
|
||||
entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote
|
||||
it.
|
||||
|
||||
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
|
||||
your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
|
||||
exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
|
||||
collective works based on the Library.
|
||||
|
||||
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library
|
||||
with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of
|
||||
a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
|
||||
the scope of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public
|
||||
License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do
|
||||
this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so
|
||||
that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2,
|
||||
instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the
|
||||
ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify
|
||||
that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in
|
||||
these notices.
|
||||
|
||||
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for
|
||||
that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all
|
||||
subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy.
|
||||
|
||||
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of
|
||||
the Library into a program that is not a library.
|
||||
|
||||
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
|
||||
derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form
|
||||
under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany
|
||||
it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which
|
||||
must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
|
||||
medium customarily used for software interchange.
|
||||
|
||||
If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy
|
||||
from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the
|
||||
source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to
|
||||
distribute the source code, even though third parties are not
|
||||
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
|
||||
|
||||
5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the
|
||||
Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or
|
||||
linked with it, is called a "work that uses the Library". Such a
|
||||
work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and
|
||||
therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library
|
||||
creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it
|
||||
contains portions of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the
|
||||
library". The executable is therefore covered by this License.
|
||||
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.
|
||||
|
||||
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file
|
||||
that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a
|
||||
derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not.
|
||||
Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be
|
||||
linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The
|
||||
threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law.
|
||||
|
||||
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data
|
||||
structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline
|
||||
functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object
|
||||
file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
|
||||
work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the
|
||||
Library will still fall under Section 6.)
|
||||
|
||||
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may
|
||||
distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6.
|
||||
Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6,
|
||||
whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
|
||||
|
||||
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or
|
||||
link a "work that uses the Library" with the Library to produce a
|
||||
work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work
|
||||
under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit
|
||||
modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse
|
||||
engineering for debugging such modifications.
|
||||
|
||||
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the
|
||||
Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by
|
||||
this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work
|
||||
during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the
|
||||
copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference
|
||||
directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one
|
||||
of these things:
|
||||
|
||||
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding
|
||||
machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever
|
||||
changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under
|
||||
Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked
|
||||
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable "work that
|
||||
uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the
|
||||
user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified
|
||||
executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood
|
||||
that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the
|
||||
Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application
|
||||
to use the modified definitions.)
|
||||
|
||||
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the
|
||||
Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a
|
||||
copy of the library already present on the user's computer system,
|
||||
rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2)
|
||||
will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if
|
||||
the user installs one, as long as the modified version is
|
||||
interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with.
|
||||
|
||||
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at
|
||||
least three years, to give the same user the materials
|
||||
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more
|
||||
than the cost of performing this distribution.
|
||||
|
||||
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy
|
||||
from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above
|
||||
specified materials from the same place.
|
||||
|
||||
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these
|
||||
materials or that you have already sent this user a copy.
|
||||
|
||||
For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the
|
||||
Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for
|
||||
reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception,
|
||||
the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is
|
||||
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major
|
||||
components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on
|
||||
which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies
|
||||
the executable.
|
||||
|
||||
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license
|
||||
restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally
|
||||
accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot
|
||||
use both them and the Library together in an executable that you
|
||||
distribute.
|
||||
|
||||
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the
|
||||
Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library
|
||||
facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined
|
||||
library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on
|
||||
the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise
|
||||
permitted, and provided that you do these two things:
|
||||
|
||||
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work
|
||||
based on the Library, uncombined with any other library
|
||||
facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the
|
||||
Sections above.
|
||||
|
||||
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact
|
||||
that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining
|
||||
where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
|
||||
|
||||
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute
|
||||
the Library except as expressly provided under this License. Any
|
||||
attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
|
||||
distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your
|
||||
rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies,
|
||||
or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
|
||||
terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
|
||||
|
||||
9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
|
||||
signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
|
||||
distribute the Library or its derivative works. These actions are
|
||||
prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
|
||||
modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the
|
||||
Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
|
||||
all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
|
||||
the Library or works based on it.
|
||||
|
||||
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the
|
||||
Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
|
||||
original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library
|
||||
subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
|
||||
restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
|
||||
You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with
|
||||
this License.
|
||||
|
||||
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
|
||||
infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
|
||||
conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
|
||||
otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
|
||||
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
|
||||
distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
|
||||
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
|
||||
may not distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent
|
||||
license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by
|
||||
all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
|
||||
the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
|
||||
refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
|
||||
|
||||
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any
|
||||
particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply,
|
||||
and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
|
||||
patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
|
||||
such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
|
||||
integrity of the free software distribution system which is
|
||||
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
|
||||
generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
|
||||
through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
|
||||
system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
|
||||
to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
|
||||
impose that choice.
|
||||
|
||||
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
|
||||
be a consequence of the rest of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in
|
||||
certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
|
||||
original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add
|
||||
an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries,
|
||||
so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus
|
||||
excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if
|
||||
written in the body of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new
|
||||
versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time.
|
||||
Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version,
|
||||
but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
|
||||
|
||||
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library
|
||||
specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and
|
||||
"any later version", you have the option of following the terms and
|
||||
conditions either of that version or of any later version published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
|
||||
license version number, you may choose any version ever published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free
|
||||
programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these,
|
||||
write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is
|
||||
copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free
|
||||
Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our
|
||||
decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
|
||||
of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing
|
||||
and reuse of software generally.
|
||||
|
||||
NO WARRANTY
|
||||
|
||||
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
|
||||
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
|
||||
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR
|
||||
OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
|
||||
KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
|
||||
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
|
||||
LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
|
||||
THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
|
||||
|
||||
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
|
||||
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY
|
||||
AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU
|
||||
FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
|
||||
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
|
||||
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
|
||||
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
|
||||
FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
|
||||
SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
|
||||
DAMAGES.
|
||||
|
||||
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
|
||||
|
||||
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
|
||||
|
||||
If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest
|
||||
possible use to the public, we recommend making it free software that
|
||||
everyone can redistribute and change. You can do so by permitting
|
||||
redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the
|
||||
ordinary General Public License).
|
||||
|
||||
To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is
|
||||
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
|
||||
convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the
|
||||
"copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
|
||||
|
||||
<one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
|
||||
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
|
||||
|
||||
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
|
||||
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
|
||||
|
||||
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
|
||||
school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the library, if
|
||||
necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
|
||||
|
||||
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the
|
||||
library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
|
||||
|
||||
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
|
||||
Ty Coon, President of Vice
|
||||
|
||||
That's all there is to it!
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
|
|||
See the Git history of the project (https://git.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg) to
|
||||
get the names of people who have contributed to FFmpeg.
|
||||
|
||||
To check the log, you can type the command "git log" in the FFmpeg
|
||||
source directory, or browse the online repository at
|
||||
https://git.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg
|
|
@ -0,0 +1 @@
|
|||
7.0.2
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* AC-3 parser prototypes
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2003 Fabrice Bellard
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2003 Michael Niedermayer
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_AC3_PARSER_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_AC3_PARSER_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extract the bitstream ID and the frame size from AC-3 data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_ac3_parse_header(const uint8_t *buf, size_t size,
|
||||
uint8_t *bitstream_id, uint16_t *frame_size);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_AC3_PARSER_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_ADTS_PARSER_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_ADTS_PARSER_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_AAC_ADTS_HEADER_SIZE 7
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extract the number of samples and frames from AAC data.
|
||||
* @param[in] buf pointer to AAC data buffer
|
||||
* @param[out] samples Pointer to where number of samples is written
|
||||
* @param[out] frames Pointer to where number of frames is written
|
||||
* @return Returns 0 on success, error code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_adts_header_parse(const uint8_t *buf, uint32_t *samples,
|
||||
uint8_t *frames);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_ADTS_PARSER_H */
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_AVDCT_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_AVDCT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/opt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVDCT context.
|
||||
* @note function pointers can be NULL if the specific features have been
|
||||
* disabled at build time.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDCT {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
void (*idct)(int16_t *block /* align 16 */);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* IDCT input permutation.
|
||||
* Several optimized IDCTs need a permutated input (relative to the
|
||||
* normal order of the reference IDCT).
|
||||
* This permutation must be performed before the idct_put/add.
|
||||
* Note, normally this can be merged with the zigzag/alternate scan<br>
|
||||
* An example to avoid confusion:
|
||||
* - (->decode coeffs -> zigzag reorder -> dequant -> reference IDCT -> ...)
|
||||
* - (x -> reference DCT -> reference IDCT -> x)
|
||||
* - (x -> reference DCT -> simple_mmx_perm = idct_permutation
|
||||
* -> simple_idct_mmx -> x)
|
||||
* - (-> decode coeffs -> zigzag reorder -> simple_mmx_perm -> dequant
|
||||
* -> simple_idct_mmx -> ...)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t idct_permutation[64];
|
||||
|
||||
void (*fdct)(int16_t *block /* align 16 */);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DCT algorithm.
|
||||
* must use AVOptions to set this field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int dct_algo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* IDCT algorithm.
|
||||
* must use AVOptions to set this field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int idct_algo;
|
||||
|
||||
void (*get_pixels)(int16_t *block /* align 16 */,
|
||||
const uint8_t *pixels /* align 8 */,
|
||||
ptrdiff_t line_size);
|
||||
|
||||
int bits_per_sample;
|
||||
|
||||
void (*get_pixels_unaligned)(int16_t *block /* align 16 */,
|
||||
const uint8_t *pixels,
|
||||
ptrdiff_t line_size);
|
||||
} AVDCT;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates a AVDCT context.
|
||||
* This needs to be initialized with avcodec_dct_init() after optionally
|
||||
* configuring it with AVOptions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To free it use av_free()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDCT *avcodec_dct_alloc(void);
|
||||
int avcodec_dct_init(AVDCT *);
|
||||
|
||||
const AVClass *avcodec_dct_get_class(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_AVDCT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,149 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_AVFFT_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_AVFFT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
#if FF_API_AVFFT
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_fft
|
||||
* FFT functions
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_fft FFT functions
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_misc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef float FFTSample;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct FFTComplex {
|
||||
FFTSample re, im;
|
||||
} FFTComplex;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct FFTContext FFTContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set up a complex FFT.
|
||||
* @param nbits log2 of the length of the input array
|
||||
* @param inverse if 0 perform the forward transform, if 1 perform the inverse
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_tx_init from libavutil/tx.h with a type of AV_TX_FLOAT_FFT
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
FFTContext *av_fft_init(int nbits, int inverse);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Do the permutation needed BEFORE calling ff_fft_calc().
|
||||
* @deprecated without replacement
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_fft_permute(FFTContext *s, FFTComplex *z);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Do a complex FFT with the parameters defined in av_fft_init(). The
|
||||
* input data must be permuted before. No 1.0/sqrt(n) normalization is done.
|
||||
* @deprecated use the av_tx_fn value returned by av_tx_init, which also does permutation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_fft_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTComplex *z);
|
||||
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_fft_end(FFTContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_tx_init from libavutil/tx.h with a type of AV_TX_FLOAT_MDCT,
|
||||
* with a flag of AV_TX_FULL_IMDCT for a replacement to av_imdct_calc.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
FFTContext *av_mdct_init(int nbits, int inverse, double scale);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_imdct_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_imdct_half(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_mdct_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_mdct_end(FFTContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Real Discrete Fourier Transform */
|
||||
|
||||
enum RDFTransformType {
|
||||
DFT_R2C,
|
||||
IDFT_C2R,
|
||||
IDFT_R2C,
|
||||
DFT_C2R,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct RDFTContext RDFTContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set up a real FFT.
|
||||
* @param nbits log2 of the length of the input array
|
||||
* @param trans the type of transform
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_tx_init from libavutil/tx.h with a type of AV_TX_FLOAT_RDFT
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
RDFTContext *av_rdft_init(int nbits, enum RDFTransformType trans);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_rdft_calc(RDFTContext *s, FFTSample *data);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_rdft_end(RDFTContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Discrete Cosine Transform */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct DCTContext DCTContext;
|
||||
|
||||
enum DCTTransformType {
|
||||
DCT_II = 0,
|
||||
DCT_III,
|
||||
DCT_I,
|
||||
DST_I,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set up DCT.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param nbits size of the input array:
|
||||
* (1 << nbits) for DCT-II, DCT-III and DST-I
|
||||
* (1 << nbits) + 1 for DCT-I
|
||||
* @param type the type of transform
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the first element of the input of DST-I is ignored
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_tx_init from libavutil/tx.h with an appropriate type of AV_TX_FLOAT_DCT
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
DCTContext *av_dct_init(int nbits, enum DCTTransformType type);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_dct_calc(DCTContext *s, FFTSample *data);
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_dct_end (DCTContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* FF_API_AVFFT */
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_AVFFT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,332 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Bitstream filters public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_BSF_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_BSF_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/dict.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/log.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "codec_id.h"
|
||||
#include "codec_par.h"
|
||||
#include "packet.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_bsf Bitstream filters
|
||||
* @ingroup libavc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Bitstream filters transform encoded media data without decoding it. This
|
||||
* allows e.g. manipulating various header values. Bitstream filters operate on
|
||||
* @ref AVPacket "AVPackets".
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The bitstream filtering API is centered around two structures:
|
||||
* AVBitStreamFilter and AVBSFContext. The former represents a bitstream filter
|
||||
* in abstract, the latter a specific filtering process. Obtain an
|
||||
* AVBitStreamFilter using av_bsf_get_by_name() or av_bsf_iterate(), then pass
|
||||
* it to av_bsf_alloc() to create an AVBSFContext. Fill in the user-settable
|
||||
* AVBSFContext fields, as described in its documentation, then call
|
||||
* av_bsf_init() to prepare the filter context for use.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Submit packets for filtering using av_bsf_send_packet(), obtain filtered
|
||||
* results with av_bsf_receive_packet(). When no more input packets will be
|
||||
* sent, submit a NULL AVPacket to signal the end of the stream to the filter.
|
||||
* av_bsf_receive_packet() will then return trailing packets, if any are
|
||||
* produced by the filter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Finally, free the filter context with av_bsf_free().
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The bitstream filter state.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This struct must be allocated with av_bsf_alloc() and freed with
|
||||
* av_bsf_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The fields in the struct will only be changed (by the caller or by the
|
||||
* filter) as described in their documentation, and are to be considered
|
||||
* immutable otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBSFContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A class for logging and AVOptions
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The bitstream filter this context is an instance of.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const struct AVBitStreamFilter *filter;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Opaque filter-specific private data. If filter->priv_class is non-NULL,
|
||||
* this is an AVOptions-enabled struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *priv_data;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameters of the input stream. This field is allocated in
|
||||
* av_bsf_alloc(), it needs to be filled by the caller before
|
||||
* av_bsf_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVCodecParameters *par_in;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameters of the output stream. This field is allocated in
|
||||
* av_bsf_alloc(), it is set by the filter in av_bsf_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVCodecParameters *par_out;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The timebase used for the timestamps of the input packets. Set by the
|
||||
* caller before av_bsf_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational time_base_in;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The timebase used for the timestamps of the output packets. Set by the
|
||||
* filter in av_bsf_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational time_base_out;
|
||||
} AVBSFContext;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVBitStreamFilter {
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A list of codec ids supported by the filter, terminated by
|
||||
* AV_CODEC_ID_NONE.
|
||||
* May be NULL, in that case the bitstream filter works with any codec id.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const enum AVCodecID *codec_ids;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A class for the private data, used to declare bitstream filter private
|
||||
* AVOptions. This field is NULL for bitstream filters that do not declare
|
||||
* any options.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this field is non-NULL, the first member of the filter private data
|
||||
* must be a pointer to AVClass, which will be set by libavcodec generic
|
||||
* code to this class.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *priv_class;
|
||||
} AVBitStreamFilter;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return a bitstream filter with the specified name or NULL if no such
|
||||
* bitstream filter exists.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bsf_get_by_name(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over all registered bitstream filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param opaque a pointer where libavcodec will store the iteration state. Must
|
||||
* point to NULL to start the iteration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the next registered bitstream filter or NULL when the iteration is
|
||||
* finished
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bsf_iterate(void **opaque);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a context for a given bitstream filter. The caller must fill in the
|
||||
* context parameters as described in the documentation and then call
|
||||
* av_bsf_init() before sending any data to the filter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param filter the filter for which to allocate an instance.
|
||||
* @param[out] ctx a pointer into which the pointer to the newly-allocated context
|
||||
* will be written. It must be freed with av_bsf_free() after the
|
||||
* filtering is done.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_alloc(const AVBitStreamFilter *filter, AVBSFContext **ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Prepare the filter for use, after all the parameters and options have been
|
||||
* set.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx a AVBSFContext previously allocated with av_bsf_alloc()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_init(AVBSFContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Submit a packet for filtering.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After sending each packet, the filter must be completely drained by calling
|
||||
* av_bsf_receive_packet() repeatedly until it returns AVERROR(EAGAIN) or
|
||||
* AVERROR_EOF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an initialized AVBSFContext
|
||||
* @param pkt the packet to filter. The bitstream filter will take ownership of
|
||||
* the packet and reset the contents of pkt. pkt is not touched if an error occurs.
|
||||
* If pkt is empty (i.e. NULL, or pkt->data is NULL and pkt->side_data_elems zero),
|
||||
* it signals the end of the stream (i.e. no more non-empty packets will be sent;
|
||||
* sending more empty packets does nothing) and will cause the filter to output
|
||||
* any packets it may have buffered internally.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return
|
||||
* - 0 on success.
|
||||
* - AVERROR(EAGAIN) if packets need to be retrieved from the filter (using
|
||||
* av_bsf_receive_packet()) before new input can be consumed.
|
||||
* - Another negative AVERROR value if an error occurs.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_send_packet(AVBSFContext *ctx, AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Retrieve a filtered packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an initialized AVBSFContext
|
||||
* @param[out] pkt this struct will be filled with the contents of the filtered
|
||||
* packet. It is owned by the caller and must be freed using
|
||||
* av_packet_unref() when it is no longer needed.
|
||||
* This parameter should be "clean" (i.e. freshly allocated
|
||||
* with av_packet_alloc() or unreffed with av_packet_unref())
|
||||
* when this function is called. If this function returns
|
||||
* successfully, the contents of pkt will be completely
|
||||
* overwritten by the returned data. On failure, pkt is not
|
||||
* touched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return
|
||||
* - 0 on success.
|
||||
* - AVERROR(EAGAIN) if more packets need to be sent to the filter (using
|
||||
* av_bsf_send_packet()) to get more output.
|
||||
* - AVERROR_EOF if there will be no further output from the filter.
|
||||
* - Another negative AVERROR value if an error occurs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note one input packet may result in several output packets, so after sending
|
||||
* a packet with av_bsf_send_packet(), this function needs to be called
|
||||
* repeatedly until it stops returning 0. It is also possible for a filter to
|
||||
* output fewer packets than were sent to it, so this function may return
|
||||
* AVERROR(EAGAIN) immediately after a successful av_bsf_send_packet() call.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_receive_packet(AVBSFContext *ctx, AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reset the internal bitstream filter state. Should be called e.g. when seeking.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bsf_flush(AVBSFContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free a bitstream filter context and everything associated with it; write NULL
|
||||
* into the supplied pointer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bsf_free(AVBSFContext **ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the AVClass for AVBSFContext. It can be used in combination with
|
||||
* AV_OPT_SEARCH_FAKE_OBJ for examining options.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_opt_find().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *av_bsf_get_class(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Structure for chain/list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
* Empty list can be allocated by av_bsf_list_alloc().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBSFList AVBSFList;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate empty list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
* The list must be later freed by av_bsf_list_free()
|
||||
* or finalized by av_bsf_list_finalize().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Pointer to @ref AVBSFList on success, NULL in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBSFList *av_bsf_list_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param lst Pointer to pointer returned by av_bsf_list_alloc()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bsf_list_free(AVBSFList **lst);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append bitstream filter to the list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param lst List to append to
|
||||
* @param bsf Filter context to be appended
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_list_append(AVBSFList *lst, AVBSFContext *bsf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Construct new bitstream filter context given it's name and options
|
||||
* and append it to the list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param lst List to append to
|
||||
* @param bsf_name Name of the bitstream filter
|
||||
* @param options Options for the bitstream filter, can be set to NULL
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_list_append2(AVBSFList *lst, const char * bsf_name, AVDictionary **options);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize list of bitstream filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function will transform @ref AVBSFList to single @ref AVBSFContext,
|
||||
* so the whole chain of bitstream filters can be treated as single filter
|
||||
* freshly allocated by av_bsf_alloc().
|
||||
* If the call is successful, @ref AVBSFList structure is freed and lst
|
||||
* will be set to NULL. In case of failure, caller is responsible for
|
||||
* freeing the structure by av_bsf_list_free()
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param lst Filter list structure to be transformed
|
||||
* @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to newly created @ref AVBSFContext structure
|
||||
* representing the chain of bitstream filters
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_list_finalize(AVBSFList **lst, AVBSFContext **bsf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse string describing list of bitstream filters and create single
|
||||
* @ref AVBSFContext describing the whole chain of bitstream filters.
|
||||
* Resulting @ref AVBSFContext can be treated as any other @ref AVBSFContext freshly
|
||||
* allocated by av_bsf_alloc().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param str String describing chain of bitstream filters in format
|
||||
* `bsf1[=opt1=val1:opt2=val2][,bsf2]`
|
||||
* @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to newly created @ref AVBSFContext structure
|
||||
* representing the chain of bitstream filters
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_list_parse_str(const char *str, AVBSFContext **bsf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get null/pass-through bitstream filter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to new instance of pass-through bitstream filter
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bsf_get_null_filter(AVBSFContext **bsf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_BSF_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,371 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* AVCodec public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_CODEC_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_CODEC_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avutil.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/hwcontext.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/log.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/samplefmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavcodec/codec_id.h"
|
||||
#include "libavcodec/version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavc_core
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Decoder can use draw_horiz_band callback.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DRAW_HORIZ_BAND (1 << 0)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec uses get_buffer() or get_encode_buffer() for allocating buffers and
|
||||
* supports custom allocators.
|
||||
* If not set, it might not use get_buffer() or get_encode_buffer() at all, or
|
||||
* use operations that assume the buffer was allocated by
|
||||
* avcodec_default_get_buffer2 or avcodec_default_get_encode_buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 (1 << 1)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encoder or decoder requires flushing with NULL input at the end in order to
|
||||
* give the complete and correct output.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* NOTE: If this flag is not set, the codec is guaranteed to never be fed with
|
||||
* with NULL data. The user can still send NULL data to the public encode
|
||||
* or decode function, but libavcodec will not pass it along to the codec
|
||||
* unless this flag is set.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Decoders:
|
||||
* The decoder has a non-zero delay and needs to be fed with avpkt->data=NULL,
|
||||
* avpkt->size=0 at the end to get the delayed data until the decoder no longer
|
||||
* returns frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Encoders:
|
||||
* The encoder needs to be fed with NULL data at the end of encoding until the
|
||||
* encoder no longer returns data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* NOTE: For encoders implementing the AVCodec.encode2() function, setting this
|
||||
* flag also means that the encoder must set the pts and duration for
|
||||
* each output packet. If this flag is not set, the pts and duration will
|
||||
* be determined by libavcodec from the input frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY (1 << 5)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec can be fed a final frame with a smaller size.
|
||||
* This can be used to prevent truncation of the last audio samples.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SMALL_LAST_FRAME (1 << 6)
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_SUBFRAMES
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec can output multiple frames per AVPacket
|
||||
* Normally demuxers return one frame at a time, demuxers which do not do
|
||||
* are connected to a parser to split what they return into proper frames.
|
||||
* This flag is reserved to the very rare category of codecs which have a
|
||||
* bitstream that cannot be split into frames without timeconsuming
|
||||
* operations like full decoding. Demuxers carrying such bitstreams thus
|
||||
* may return multiple frames in a packet. This has many disadvantages like
|
||||
* prohibiting stream copy in many cases thus it should only be considered
|
||||
* as a last resort.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SUBFRAMES (1 << 8)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec is experimental and is thus avoided in favor of non experimental
|
||||
* encoders
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_EXPERIMENTAL (1 << 9)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec should fill in channel configuration and samplerate instead of container
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_CHANNEL_CONF (1 << 10)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports frame-level multithreading.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_FRAME_THREADS (1 << 12)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports slice-based (or partition-based) multithreading.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SLICE_THREADS (1 << 13)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports changed parameters at any point.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_PARAM_CHANGE (1 << 14)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports multithreading through a method other than slice- or
|
||||
* frame-level multithreading. Typically this marks wrappers around
|
||||
* multithreading-capable external libraries.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_OTHER_THREADS (1 << 15)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio encoder supports receiving a different number of samples in each call.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE (1 << 16)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Decoder is not a preferred choice for probing.
|
||||
* This indicates that the decoder is not a good choice for probing.
|
||||
* It could for example be an expensive to spin up hardware decoder,
|
||||
* or it could simply not provide a lot of useful information about
|
||||
* the stream.
|
||||
* A decoder marked with this flag should only be used as last resort
|
||||
* choice for probing.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_AVOID_PROBING (1 << 17)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec is backed by a hardware implementation. Typically used to
|
||||
* identify a non-hwaccel hardware decoder. For information about hwaccels, use
|
||||
* avcodec_get_hw_config() instead.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_HARDWARE (1 << 18)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec is potentially backed by a hardware implementation, but not
|
||||
* necessarily. This is used instead of AV_CODEC_CAP_HARDWARE, if the
|
||||
* implementation provides some sort of internal fallback.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_HYBRID (1 << 19)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This encoder can reorder user opaque values from input AVFrames and return
|
||||
* them with corresponding output packets.
|
||||
* @see AV_CODEC_FLAG_COPY_OPAQUE
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_ENCODER_REORDERED_OPAQUE (1 << 20)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This encoder can be flushed using avcodec_flush_buffers(). If this flag is
|
||||
* not set, the encoder must be closed and reopened to ensure that no frames
|
||||
* remain pending.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_ENCODER_FLUSH (1 << 21)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The encoder is able to output reconstructed frame data, i.e. raw frames that
|
||||
* would be produced by decoding the encoded bitstream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Reconstructed frame output is enabled by the AV_CODEC_FLAG_RECON_FRAME flag.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_CAP_ENCODER_RECON_FRAME (1 << 22)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVProfile.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVProfile {
|
||||
int profile;
|
||||
const char *name; ///< short name for the profile
|
||||
} AVProfile;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVCodec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCodec {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Name of the codec implementation.
|
||||
* The name is globally unique among encoders and among decoders (but an
|
||||
* encoder and a decoder can share the same name).
|
||||
* This is the primary way to find a codec from the user perspective.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Descriptive name for the codec, meant to be more human readable than name.
|
||||
* You should use the NULL_IF_CONFIG_SMALL() macro to define it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *long_name;
|
||||
enum AVMediaType type;
|
||||
enum AVCodecID id;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec capabilities.
|
||||
* see AV_CODEC_CAP_*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int capabilities;
|
||||
uint8_t max_lowres; ///< maximum value for lowres supported by the decoder
|
||||
const AVRational *supported_framerates; ///< array of supported framerates, or NULL if any, array is terminated by {0,0}
|
||||
const enum AVPixelFormat *pix_fmts; ///< array of supported pixel formats, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by -1
|
||||
const int *supported_samplerates; ///< array of supported audio samplerates, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by 0
|
||||
const enum AVSampleFormat *sample_fmts; ///< array of supported sample formats, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by -1
|
||||
const AVClass *priv_class; ///< AVClass for the private context
|
||||
const AVProfile *profiles; ///< array of recognized profiles, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by {AV_PROFILE_UNKNOWN}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Group name of the codec implementation.
|
||||
* This is a short symbolic name of the wrapper backing this codec. A
|
||||
* wrapper uses some kind of external implementation for the codec, such
|
||||
* as an external library, or a codec implementation provided by the OS or
|
||||
* the hardware.
|
||||
* If this field is NULL, this is a builtin, libavcodec native codec.
|
||||
* If non-NULL, this will be the suffix in AVCodec.name in most cases
|
||||
* (usually AVCodec.name will be of the form "<codec_name>_<wrapper_name>").
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *wrapper_name;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of supported channel layouts, terminated with a zeroed layout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVChannelLayout *ch_layouts;
|
||||
} AVCodec;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over all registered codecs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param opaque a pointer where libavcodec will store the iteration state. Must
|
||||
* point to NULL to start the iteration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the next registered codec or NULL when the iteration is
|
||||
* finished
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodec *av_codec_iterate(void **opaque);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find a registered decoder with a matching codec ID.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param id AVCodecID of the requested decoder
|
||||
* @return A decoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodec *avcodec_find_decoder(enum AVCodecID id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find a registered decoder with the specified name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param name name of the requested decoder
|
||||
* @return A decoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodec *avcodec_find_decoder_by_name(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find a registered encoder with a matching codec ID.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param id AVCodecID of the requested encoder
|
||||
* @return An encoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodec *avcodec_find_encoder(enum AVCodecID id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find a registered encoder with the specified name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param name name of the requested encoder
|
||||
* @return An encoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodec *avcodec_find_encoder_by_name(const char *name);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return a non-zero number if codec is an encoder, zero otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_codec_is_encoder(const AVCodec *codec);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return a non-zero number if codec is a decoder, zero otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_codec_is_decoder(const AVCodec *codec);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return a name for the specified profile, if available.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param codec the codec that is searched for the given profile
|
||||
* @param profile the profile value for which a name is requested
|
||||
* @return A name for the profile if found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_get_profile_name(const AVCodec *codec, int profile);
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The codec supports this format via the hw_device_ctx interface.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When selecting this format, AVCodecContext.hw_device_ctx should
|
||||
* have been set to a device of the specified type before calling
|
||||
* avcodec_open2().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_DEVICE_CTX = 0x01,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The codec supports this format via the hw_frames_ctx interface.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When selecting this format for a decoder,
|
||||
* AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx should be set to a suitable frames
|
||||
* context inside the get_format() callback. The frames context
|
||||
* must have been created on a device of the specified type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When selecting this format for an encoder,
|
||||
* AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx should be set to the context which
|
||||
* will be used for the input frames before calling avcodec_open2().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_FRAMES_CTX = 0x02,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The codec supports this format by some internal method.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This format can be selected without any additional configuration -
|
||||
* no device or frames context is required.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_INTERNAL = 0x04,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The codec supports this format by some ad-hoc method.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Additional settings and/or function calls are required. See the
|
||||
* codec-specific documentation for details. (Methods requiring
|
||||
* this sort of configuration are deprecated and others should be
|
||||
* used in preference.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_AD_HOC = 0x08,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVCodecHWConfig {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* For decoders, a hardware pixel format which that decoder may be
|
||||
* able to decode to if suitable hardware is available.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For encoders, a pixel format which the encoder may be able to
|
||||
* accept. If set to AV_PIX_FMT_NONE, this applies to all pixel
|
||||
* formats supported by the codec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Bit set of AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_* flags, describing the possible
|
||||
* setup methods which can be used with this configuration.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int methods;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The device type associated with the configuration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be set for AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_DEVICE_CTX and
|
||||
* AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_FRAMES_CTX, otherwise unused.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType device_type;
|
||||
} AVCodecHWConfig;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Retrieve supported hardware configurations for a codec.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Values of index from zero to some maximum return the indexed configuration
|
||||
* descriptor; all other values return NULL. If the codec does not support
|
||||
* any hardware configurations then it will always return NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodecHWConfig *avcodec_get_hw_config(const AVCodec *codec, int index);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_CODEC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,134 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Codec descriptors public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_CODEC_DESC_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_CODEC_DESC_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avutil.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "codec_id.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavc_core
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct describes the properties of a single codec described by an
|
||||
* AVCodecID.
|
||||
* @see avcodec_descriptor_get()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCodecDescriptor {
|
||||
enum AVCodecID id;
|
||||
enum AVMediaType type;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Name of the codec described by this descriptor. It is non-empty and
|
||||
* unique for each codec descriptor. It should contain alphanumeric
|
||||
* characters and '_' only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A more descriptive name for this codec. May be NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *long_name;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec properties, a combination of AV_CODEC_PROP_* flags.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int props;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* MIME type(s) associated with the codec.
|
||||
* May be NULL; if not, a NULL-terminated array of MIME types.
|
||||
* The first item is always non-NULL and is the preferred MIME type.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *const *mime_types;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If non-NULL, an array of profiles recognized for this codec.
|
||||
* Terminated with AV_PROFILE_UNKNOWN.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const struct AVProfile *profiles;
|
||||
} AVCodecDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec uses only intra compression.
|
||||
* Video and audio codecs only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_INTRA_ONLY (1 << 0)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports lossy compression. Audio and video codecs only.
|
||||
* @note a codec may support both lossy and lossless
|
||||
* compression modes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_LOSSY (1 << 1)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports lossless compression. Audio and video codecs only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_LOSSLESS (1 << 2)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec supports frame reordering. That is, the coded order (the order in which
|
||||
* the encoded packets are output by the encoders / stored / input to the
|
||||
* decoders) may be different from the presentation order of the corresponding
|
||||
* frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For codecs that do not have this property set, PTS and DTS should always be
|
||||
* equal.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_REORDER (1 << 3)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video codec supports separate coding of fields in interlaced frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_FIELDS (1 << 4)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtitle codec is bitmap based
|
||||
* Decoded AVSubtitle data can be read from the AVSubtitleRect->pict field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_BITMAP_SUB (1 << 16)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtitle codec is text based.
|
||||
* Decoded AVSubtitle data can be read from the AVSubtitleRect->ass field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_PROP_TEXT_SUB (1 << 17)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return descriptor for given codec ID or NULL if no descriptor exists.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_get(enum AVCodecID id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over all codec descriptors known to libavcodec.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param prev previous descriptor. NULL to get the first descriptor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return next descriptor or NULL after the last descriptor
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_next(const AVCodecDescriptor *prev);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return codec descriptor with the given name or NULL if no such descriptor
|
||||
* exists.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_get_by_name(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_CODEC_DESC_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,667 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Codec IDs
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_CODEC_ID_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_CODEC_ID_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avutil.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/samplefmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavc_core
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Identify the syntax and semantics of the bitstream.
|
||||
* The principle is roughly:
|
||||
* Two decoders with the same ID can decode the same streams.
|
||||
* Two encoders with the same ID can encode compatible streams.
|
||||
* There may be slight deviations from the principle due to implementation
|
||||
* details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If you add a codec ID to this list, add it so that
|
||||
* 1. no value of an existing codec ID changes (that would break ABI),
|
||||
* 2. it is as close as possible to similar codecs
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After adding new codec IDs, do not forget to add an entry to the codec
|
||||
* descriptor list and bump libavcodec minor version.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVCodecID {
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_NONE,
|
||||
|
||||
/* video codecs */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG1VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG2VIDEO, ///< preferred ID for MPEG-1/2 video decoding
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_H261,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_H263,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RV10,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RV20,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MJPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MJPEGB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_LJPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SP5X,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_JPEGLS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RAWVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMV2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_H263P,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_H263I,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FLV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SVQ1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SVQ3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HUFFYUV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CYUV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_H264,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_THEORA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ASV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ASV2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FFV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_4XM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VCR1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CLJR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MDEC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ROQ,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_WC3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_WC4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RPZA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CINEPAK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WS_VQA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSRLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSVIDEO1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IDCIN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_8BPS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FLIC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VMDVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSZH,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ZLIB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QTRLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TSCC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ULTI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QDRAW,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VIXL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PNG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PPM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PBM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PGM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PGMYUV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PAM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FFVHUFF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RV30,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RV40,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VC1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMV3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_LOCO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WNV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AASC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FRAPS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BMP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CSCD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MMVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ZMBV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMACKVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_NUV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_KMVC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FLASHSV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CAVS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_JPEG2000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VMNC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP5,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP6,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP6F,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TARGA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSICINVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TIERTEXSEQVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TIFF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GIF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DXA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DNXHD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_THP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SGI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_C93,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BETHSOFTVID,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PTX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TXD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP6A,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SUNRAST,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO5,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MIMIC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RL2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ESCAPE124,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DIRAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BFI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MOTIONPIXELS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TGV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TGQ,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TQI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AURA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AURA2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_V210X,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_V210,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DPX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MAD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FRWU,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FLASHSV2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CDGRAPHICS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_R210,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ANM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BINKVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_ILBM,
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_BYTERUN1 AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_ILBM
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_KGV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_YOP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP8,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PICTOR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ANSI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_A64_MULTI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_A64_MULTI5,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_R10K,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MXPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_LAGARITH,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PRORES,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_JV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DFA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMV3IMAGE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VC1IMAGE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_UTVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BMV_VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VBLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DXTORY,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_V410,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XWD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CDXL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XBM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ZEROCODEC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSS1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSA1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TSCC2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MTS2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CLLC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSS2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP9,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AIC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ESCAPE130,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_G2M,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WEBP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HNM4_VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HEVC,
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_ID_H265 AV_CODEC_ID_HEVC
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FIC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ALIAS_PIX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BRENDER_PIX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PAF_VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EXR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP7,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SANM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SGIRLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MVC1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MVC2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HQX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TDSC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HQ_HQA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HAP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DDS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DXV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SCREENPRESSO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RSCC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVS2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PGX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVS3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSP2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VVC,
|
||||
#define AV_CODEC_ID_H266 AV_CODEC_ID_VVC
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_Y41P,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVRP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_012V,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVUI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TARGA_Y216,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_V308,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_V408,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_YUV4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AVRN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CPIA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XFACE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SNOW,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMVJPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_APNG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DAALA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CFHD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION2RT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_M101,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MAGICYUV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SHEERVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_YLC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PSD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PIXLET,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SPEEDHQ,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FMVC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SCPR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CLEARVIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XPM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BITPACKED,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSCC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SRGC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SVG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GDV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FITS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IMM4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PROSUMER,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MWSC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WCMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RASC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HYMT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ARBC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AGM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_LSCR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VP4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IMM5,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MVDV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MVHA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CDTOONS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MV30,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_NOTCHLC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PFM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MOBICLIP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PHOTOCD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IPU,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ARGO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CRI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SIMBIOSIS_IMX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SGA_VIDEO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GEM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VBN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_JPEGXL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QOI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PHM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RADIANCE_HDR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WBMP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MEDIA100,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VQC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PDV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EVC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RTV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VMIX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_LEAD,
|
||||
|
||||
/* various PCM "codecs" */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_AUDIO = 0x10000, ///< A dummy id pointing at the start of audio codecs
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16LE = 0x10000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U16LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U16BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S8,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U8,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_MULAW,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_ALAW,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U32LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U32BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U24LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U24BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24DAUD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_ZORK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16LE_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_DVD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F32BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F32LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F64BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F64LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_BLURAY,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_LXF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_S302M,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S8_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24LE_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32LE_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16BE_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S64LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S64BE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F16LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F24LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_VIDC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_SGA,
|
||||
|
||||
/* various ADPCM codecs */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_QT = 0x11000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_WAV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DK3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DK4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_WS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_SMJPEG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_MS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_4XM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_XA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_ADX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G726,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_CT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SWF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_YAMAHA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_THP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_AMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_EA_SEAD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_EA_EACS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_XAS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_MAXIS_XA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_ISS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G722,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_APC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_VIMA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_AFC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_OKI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_DTK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_RAD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G726LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_THP_LE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_PSX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_AICA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DAT4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_MTAF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_AGM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_ARGO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_SSI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_ZORK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_APM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_ALP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_MTF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_CUNNING,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_MOFLEX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_ACORN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_XMD,
|
||||
|
||||
/* AMR */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AMR_NB = 0x12000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AMR_WB,
|
||||
|
||||
/* RealAudio codecs*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RA_144 = 0x13000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RA_288,
|
||||
|
||||
/* various DPCM codecs */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ROQ_DPCM = 0x14000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SOL_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SDX2_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GREMLIN_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DERF_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WADY_DPCM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CBD2_DPCM,
|
||||
|
||||
/* audio codecs */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP2 = 0x15000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP3, ///< preferred ID for decoding MPEG audio layer 1, 2 or 3
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AC3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DTS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VORBIS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVAUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMAV1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMAV2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MACE3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MACE6,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VMDAUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FLAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP3ADU,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP3ON4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SHORTEN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ALAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WESTWOOD_SND1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GSM, ///< as in Berlin toast format
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QDM2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_COOK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TRUESPEECH,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TTA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMACKAUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QCELP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WAVPACK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSICINAUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IMC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MUSEPACK7,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MLP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_GSM_MS, /* as found in WAV */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_APE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_NELLYMOSER,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MUSEPACK8,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SPEEX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMAVOICE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMAPRO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WMALOSSLESS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3P,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EAC3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SIPR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TWINVQ,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEHD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MP4ALS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BINKAUDIO_RDFT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BINKAUDIO_DCT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AAC_LATM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QDMC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CELT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_G723_1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_G729,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_8SVX_EXP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_8SVX_FIB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BMV_AUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RALF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ILBC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_OPUS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_COMFORT_NOISE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TAK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_METASOUND,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PAF_AUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ON2AVC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSS_SP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_CODEC2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FFWAVESYNTH,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SONIC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SONIC_LS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EVRC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_LSBF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_MSBF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_LSBF_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_MSBF_PLANAR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_4GV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_ACM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XMA1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XMA2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DST,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3AL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3PAL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DOLBY_E,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_APTX,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_APTX_HD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SBC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC9,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HCOM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ACELP_KELVIN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEGH_3D_AUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SIREN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HCA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FASTAUDIO,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MSNSIREN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DFPWM,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BONK,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MISC4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_APAC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FTR,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WAVARC,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_RKA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_AC4,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_OSQ,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_QOA,
|
||||
|
||||
/* subtitle codecs */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_SUBTITLE = 0x17000, ///< A dummy ID pointing at the start of subtitle codecs.
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVD_SUBTITLE = 0x17000,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVB_SUBTITLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TEXT, ///< raw UTF-8 text
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XSUB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SSA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MOV_TEXT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HDMV_PGS_SUBTITLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVB_TELETEXT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SRT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MICRODVD,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EIA_608,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_JACOSUB,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SAMI,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_REALTEXT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_STL,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SUBVIEWER1,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SUBVIEWER,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SUBRIP,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WEBVTT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPL2,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VPLAYER,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PJS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ASS,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_HDMV_TEXT_SUBTITLE,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TTML,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ARIB_CAPTION,
|
||||
|
||||
/* other specific kind of codecs (generally used for attachments) */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_UNKNOWN = 0x18000, ///< A dummy ID pointing at the start of various fake codecs.
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TTF = 0x18000,
|
||||
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SCTE_35, ///< Contain timestamp estimated through PCR of program stream.
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_EPG,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BINTEXT,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_XBIN,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_IDF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_OTF,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMPTE_KLV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_DVD_NAV,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_TIMED_ID3,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_BIN_DATA,
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_SMPTE_2038,
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_PROBE = 0x19000, ///< codec_id is not known (like AV_CODEC_ID_NONE) but lavf should attempt to identify it
|
||||
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG2TS = 0x20000, /**< _FAKE_ codec to indicate a raw MPEG-2 TS
|
||||
* stream (only used by libavformat) */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG4SYSTEMS = 0x20001, /**< _FAKE_ codec to indicate a MPEG-4 Systems
|
||||
* stream (only used by libavformat) */
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_FFMETADATA = 0x21000, ///< Dummy codec for streams containing only metadata information.
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_WRAPPED_AVFRAME = 0x21001, ///< Passthrough codec, AVFrames wrapped in AVPacket
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dummy null video codec, useful mainly for development and debugging.
|
||||
* Null encoder/decoder discard all input and never return any output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_VNULL,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dummy null audio codec, useful mainly for development and debugging.
|
||||
* Null encoder/decoder discard all input and never return any output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CODEC_ID_ANULL,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the type of the given codec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVMediaType avcodec_get_type(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the name of a codec.
|
||||
* @return a static string identifying the codec; never NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avcodec_get_name(enum AVCodecID id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return codec bits per sample.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] codec_id the codec
|
||||
* @return Number of bits per sample or zero if unknown for the given codec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_get_bits_per_sample(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return codec bits per sample.
|
||||
* Only return non-zero if the bits per sample is exactly correct, not an
|
||||
* approximation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] codec_id the codec
|
||||
* @return Number of bits per sample or zero if unknown for the given codec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_get_exact_bits_per_sample(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return a name for the specified profile, if available.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param codec_id the ID of the codec to which the requested profile belongs
|
||||
* @param profile the profile value for which a name is requested
|
||||
* @return A name for the profile if found, NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note unlike av_get_profile_name(), which searches a list of profiles
|
||||
* supported by a specific decoder or encoder implementation, this
|
||||
* function searches the list of profiles from the AVCodecDescriptor
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avcodec_profile_name(enum AVCodecID codec_id, int profile);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the PCM codec associated with a sample format.
|
||||
* @param be endianness, 0 for little, 1 for big,
|
||||
* -1 (or anything else) for native
|
||||
* @return AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_* or AV_CODEC_ID_NONE
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVCodecID av_get_pcm_codec(enum AVSampleFormat fmt, int be);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_CODEC_ID_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,248 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Codec parameters public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_CODEC_PAR_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_CODEC_PAR_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avutil.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/channel_layout.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/pixfmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "codec_id.h"
|
||||
#include "defs.h"
|
||||
#include "packet.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavc_core
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct describes the properties of an encoded stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* sizeof(AVCodecParameters) is not a part of the public ABI, this struct must
|
||||
* be allocated with avcodec_parameters_alloc() and freed with
|
||||
* avcodec_parameters_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCodecParameters {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* General type of the encoded data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVMediaType codec_type;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specific type of the encoded data (the codec used).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVCodecID codec_id;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Additional information about the codec (corresponds to the AVI FOURCC).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t codec_tag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extra binary data needed for initializing the decoder, codec-dependent.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be allocated with av_malloc() and will be freed by
|
||||
* avcodec_parameters_free(). The allocated size of extradata must be at
|
||||
* least extradata_size + AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE, with the padding
|
||||
* bytes zeroed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *extradata;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Size of the extradata content in bytes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int extradata_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Additional data associated with the entire stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Should be allocated with av_packet_side_data_new() or
|
||||
* av_packet_side_data_add(), and will be freed by avcodec_parameters_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacketSideData *coded_side_data;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Amount of entries in @ref coded_side_data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_coded_side_data;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* - video: the pixel format, the value corresponds to enum AVPixelFormat.
|
||||
* - audio: the sample format, the value corresponds to enum AVSampleFormat.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int format;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The average bitrate of the encoded data (in bits per second).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t bit_rate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of bits per sample in the codedwords.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is basically the bitrate per sample. It is mandatory for a bunch of
|
||||
* formats to actually decode them. It's the number of bits for one sample in
|
||||
* the actual coded bitstream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This could be for example 4 for ADPCM
|
||||
* For PCM formats this matches bits_per_raw_sample
|
||||
* Can be 0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int bits_per_coded_sample;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This is the number of valid bits in each output sample. If the
|
||||
* sample format has more bits, the least significant bits are additional
|
||||
* padding bits, which are always 0. Use right shifts to reduce the sample
|
||||
* to its actual size. For example, audio formats with 24 bit samples will
|
||||
* have bits_per_raw_sample set to 24, and format set to AV_SAMPLE_FMT_S32.
|
||||
* To get the original sample use "(int32_t)sample >> 8"."
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For ADPCM this might be 12 or 16 or similar
|
||||
* Can be 0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int bits_per_raw_sample;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Codec-specific bitstream restrictions that the stream conforms to.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int profile;
|
||||
int level;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. The dimensions of the video frame in pixels.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int width;
|
||||
int height;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. The aspect ratio (width / height) which a single pixel
|
||||
* should have when displayed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When the aspect ratio is unknown / undefined, the numerator should be
|
||||
* set to 0 (the denominator may have any value).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational sample_aspect_ratio;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. Number of frames per second, for streams with constant frame
|
||||
* durations. Should be set to { 0, 1 } when some frames have differing
|
||||
* durations or if the value is not known.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This field correponds to values that are stored in codec-level
|
||||
* headers and is typically overridden by container/transport-layer
|
||||
* timestamps, when available. It should thus be used only as a last resort,
|
||||
* when no higher-level timing information is available.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational framerate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. The order of the fields in interlaced video.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVFieldOrder field_order;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. Additional colorspace characteristics.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
enum AVColorPrimaries color_primaries;
|
||||
enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace color_space;
|
||||
enum AVChromaLocation chroma_location;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only. Number of delayed frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int video_delay;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. The channel layout and number of channels.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVChannelLayout ch_layout;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. The number of audio samples per second.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int sample_rate;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. The number of bytes per coded audio frame, required by some
|
||||
* formats.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Corresponds to nBlockAlign in WAVEFORMATEX.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int block_align;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. Audio frame size, if known. Required by some formats to be static.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int frame_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. The amount of padding (in samples) inserted by the encoder at
|
||||
* the beginning of the audio. I.e. this number of leading decoded samples
|
||||
* must be discarded by the caller to get the original audio without leading
|
||||
* padding.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int initial_padding;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. The amount of padding (in samples) appended by the encoder to
|
||||
* the end of the audio. I.e. this number of decoded samples must be
|
||||
* discarded by the caller from the end of the stream to get the original
|
||||
* audio without any trailing padding.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int trailing_padding;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only. Number of samples to skip after a discontinuity.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int seek_preroll;
|
||||
} AVCodecParameters;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new AVCodecParameters and set its fields to default values
|
||||
* (unknown/invalid/0). The returned struct must be freed with
|
||||
* avcodec_parameters_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVCodecParameters *avcodec_parameters_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVCodecParameters instance and everything associated with it and
|
||||
* write NULL to the supplied pointer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avcodec_parameters_free(AVCodecParameters **par);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy the contents of src to dst. Any allocated fields in dst are freed and
|
||||
* replaced with newly allocated duplicates of the corresponding fields in src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avcodec_parameters_copy(AVCodecParameters *dst, const AVCodecParameters *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This function is the same as av_get_audio_frame_duration(), except it works
|
||||
* with AVCodecParameters instead of an AVCodecContext.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_get_audio_frame_duration2(AVCodecParameters *par, int frame_bytes);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_CODEC_PAR_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Direct3D11 HW acceleration
|
||||
*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2009 Laurent Aimar
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2015 Steve Lhomme
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_D3D11VA_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_D3D11VA_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_d3d11va
|
||||
* Public libavcodec D3D11VA header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined(_WIN32_WINNT) || _WIN32_WINNT < 0x0602
|
||||
#undef _WIN32_WINNT
|
||||
#define _WIN32_WINNT 0x0602
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <d3d11.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_d3d11va Direct3D11
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure is used to provides the necessary configurations and data
|
||||
* to the Direct3D11 FFmpeg HWAccel implementation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The application must make it available as AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Use av_d3d11va_alloc_context() exclusively to allocate an AVD3D11VAContext.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D11VAContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11 decoder object
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11VideoDecoder *decoder;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11 VideoContext
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11VideoContext *video_context;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11 configuration used to create the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
D3D11_VIDEO_DECODER_CONFIG *cfg;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of surface in the surface array
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned surface_count;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The array of Direct3D surfaces used to create the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11VideoDecoderOutputView **surface;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A bit field configuring the workarounds needed for using the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t workaround;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Private to the FFmpeg AVHWAccel implementation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned report_id;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mutex to access video_context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
HANDLE context_mutex;
|
||||
} AVD3D11VAContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVD3D11VAContext.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Newly-allocated AVD3D11VAContext or NULL on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVD3D11VAContext *av_d3d11va_alloc_context(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_D3D11VA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,335 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_DEFS_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_DEFS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup libavc
|
||||
* Misc types and constants that do not belong anywhere else.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_decoding
|
||||
* Required number of additionally allocated bytes at the end of the input bitstream for decoding.
|
||||
* This is mainly needed because some optimized bitstream readers read
|
||||
* 32 or 64 bit at once and could read over the end.<br>
|
||||
* Note: If the first 23 bits of the additional bytes are not 0, then damaged
|
||||
* MPEG bitstreams could cause overread and segfault.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE 64
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Verify checksums embedded in the bitstream (could be of either encoded or
|
||||
* decoded data, depending on the format) and print an error message on mismatch.
|
||||
* If AV_EF_EXPLODE is also set, a mismatching checksum will result in the
|
||||
* decoder/demuxer returning an error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_EF_CRCCHECK (1<<0)
|
||||
#define AV_EF_BITSTREAM (1<<1) ///< detect bitstream specification deviations
|
||||
#define AV_EF_BUFFER (1<<2) ///< detect improper bitstream length
|
||||
#define AV_EF_EXPLODE (1<<3) ///< abort decoding on minor error detection
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_EF_IGNORE_ERR (1<<15) ///< ignore errors and continue
|
||||
#define AV_EF_CAREFUL (1<<16) ///< consider things that violate the spec, are fast to calculate and have not been seen in the wild as errors
|
||||
#define AV_EF_COMPLIANT (1<<17) ///< consider all spec non compliances as errors
|
||||
#define AV_EF_AGGRESSIVE (1<<18) ///< consider things that a sane encoder/muxer should not do as an error
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_COMPLIANCE_VERY_STRICT 2 ///< Strictly conform to an older more strict version of the spec or reference software.
|
||||
#define FF_COMPLIANCE_STRICT 1 ///< Strictly conform to all the things in the spec no matter what consequences.
|
||||
#define FF_COMPLIANCE_NORMAL 0
|
||||
#define FF_COMPLIANCE_UNOFFICIAL -1 ///< Allow unofficial extensions
|
||||
#define FF_COMPLIANCE_EXPERIMENTAL -2 ///< Allow nonstandardized experimental things.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_UNKNOWN -99
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_RESERVED -100
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_MAIN 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_LOW 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_SSR 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_LTP 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_HE 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_HE_V2 28
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_LD 22
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AAC_ELD 38
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_AAC_LOW 128
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_AAC_HE 131
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHD 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHR_LB 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHR_SQ 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHR_HQ 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHR_HQX 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DNXHR_444 5
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS 20
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_ES 30
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_96_24 40
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_HD_HRA 50
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_HD_MA 60
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_EXPRESS 70
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_HD_MA_X 61
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_DTS_HD_MA_X_IMAX 62
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_EAC3_DDP_ATMOS 30
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_TRUEHD_ATMOS 30
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_422 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_HIGH 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_SS 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_SNR_SCALABLE 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_MAIN 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG2_SIMPLE 5
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED (1<<9) // 8+1; constraint_set1_flag
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_INTRA (1<<11) // 8+3; constraint_set3_flag
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_BASELINE 66
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED_BASELINE (66|AV_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED)
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_MAIN 77
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_EXTENDED 88
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH 100
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_10 110
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_10_INTRA (110|AV_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_MULTIVIEW_HIGH 118
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_422 122
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_422_INTRA (122|AV_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_STEREO_HIGH 128
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444 144
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444_PREDICTIVE 244
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444_INTRA (244|AV_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_H264_CAVLC_444 44
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VC1_SIMPLE 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VC1_MAIN 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VC1_COMPLEX 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VC1_ADVANCED 3
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_SCALABLE 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_CORE 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_MAIN 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_N_BIT 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_SCALABLE_TEXTURE 5
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_FACE_ANIMATION 6
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_BASIC_ANIMATED_TEXTURE 7
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_HYBRID 8
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_REAL_TIME 9
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_CORE_SCALABLE 10
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_CODING 11
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_CORE 12
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_SCALABLE_TEXTURE 13
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_STUDIO 14
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_SIMPLE 15
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_RESTRICTION_0 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_RESTRICTION_1 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_NO_RESTRICTION 32768
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_JPEG2000_DCINEMA_2K 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_JPEG2000_DCINEMA_4K 4
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VP9_0 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VP9_1 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VP9_2 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VP9_3 3
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN_10 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN_STILL_PICTURE 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_HEVC_REXT 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_HEVC_SCC 9
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VVC_MAIN_10 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_VVC_MAIN_10_444 33
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AV1_MAIN 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AV1_HIGH 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_AV1_PROFESSIONAL 2
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_BASELINE_DCT 0xc0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_EXTENDED_SEQUENTIAL_DCT 0xc1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_PROGRESSIVE_DCT 0xc2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_LOSSLESS 0xc3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_MJPEG_JPEG_LS 0xf7
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_SBC_MSBC 1
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_PROXY 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_LT 1
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_STANDARD 2
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_HQ 3
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_4444 4
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_PRORES_XQ 5
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_ARIB_PROFILE_A 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_ARIB_PROFILE_C 1
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_KLVA_SYNC 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_KLVA_ASYNC 1
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_EVC_BASELINE 0
|
||||
#define AV_PROFILE_EVC_MAIN 1
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_LEVEL_UNKNOWN -99
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVFieldOrder {
|
||||
AV_FIELD_UNKNOWN,
|
||||
AV_FIELD_PROGRESSIVE,
|
||||
AV_FIELD_TT, ///< Top coded_first, top displayed first
|
||||
AV_FIELD_BB, ///< Bottom coded first, bottom displayed first
|
||||
AV_FIELD_TB, ///< Top coded first, bottom displayed first
|
||||
AV_FIELD_BT, ///< Bottom coded first, top displayed first
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_decoding
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVDiscard{
|
||||
/* We leave some space between them for extensions (drop some
|
||||
* keyframes for intra-only or drop just some bidir frames). */
|
||||
AVDISCARD_NONE =-16, ///< discard nothing
|
||||
AVDISCARD_DEFAULT = 0, ///< discard useless packets like 0 size packets in avi
|
||||
AVDISCARD_NONREF = 8, ///< discard all non reference
|
||||
AVDISCARD_BIDIR = 16, ///< discard all bidirectional frames
|
||||
AVDISCARD_NONINTRA= 24, ///< discard all non intra frames
|
||||
AVDISCARD_NONKEY = 32, ///< discard all frames except keyframes
|
||||
AVDISCARD_ALL = 48, ///< discard all
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVAudioServiceType {
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_MAIN = 0,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_EFFECTS = 1,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_VISUALLY_IMPAIRED = 2,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_HEARING_IMPAIRED = 3,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_DIALOGUE = 4,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_COMMENTARY = 5,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_EMERGENCY = 6,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_VOICE_OVER = 7,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_KARAOKE = 8,
|
||||
AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_NB , ///< Not part of ABI
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pan Scan area.
|
||||
* This specifies the area which should be displayed.
|
||||
* Note there may be multiple such areas for one frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVPanScan {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* id
|
||||
* - encoding: Set by user.
|
||||
* - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int id;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* width and height in 1/16 pel
|
||||
* - encoding: Set by user.
|
||||
* - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int width;
|
||||
int height;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* position of the top left corner in 1/16 pel for up to 3 fields/frames
|
||||
* - encoding: Set by user.
|
||||
* - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int16_t position[3][2];
|
||||
} AVPanScan;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure describes the bitrate properties of an encoded bitstream. It
|
||||
* roughly corresponds to a subset the VBV parameters for MPEG-2 or HRD
|
||||
* parameters for H.264/HEVC.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCPBProperties {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Maximum bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
|
||||
* Zero if unknown or unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t max_bitrate;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Minimum bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
|
||||
* Zero if unknown or unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t min_bitrate;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Average bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
|
||||
* Zero if unknown or unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t avg_bitrate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The size of the buffer to which the ratecontrol is applied, in bits.
|
||||
* Zero if unknown or unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t buffer_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The delay between the time the packet this structure is associated with
|
||||
* is received and the time when it should be decoded, in periods of a 27MHz
|
||||
* clock.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* UINT64_MAX when unknown or unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t vbv_delay;
|
||||
} AVCPBProperties;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a CPB properties structure and initialize its fields to default
|
||||
* values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size if non-NULL, the size of the allocated struct will be written
|
||||
* here. This is useful for embedding it in side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the newly allocated struct or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVCPBProperties *av_cpb_properties_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure supplies correlation between a packet timestamp and a wall clock
|
||||
* production time. The definition follows the Producer Reference Time ('prft')
|
||||
* as defined in ISO/IEC 14496-12
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVProducerReferenceTime {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A UTC timestamp, in microseconds, since Unix epoch (e.g, av_gettime()).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t wallclock;
|
||||
int flags;
|
||||
} AVProducerReferenceTime;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encode extradata length to a buffer. Used by xiph codecs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s buffer to write to; must be at least (v/255+1) bytes long
|
||||
* @param v size of extradata in bytes
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written to the buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int av_xiphlacing(unsigned char *s, unsigned int v);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_DEFS_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Marco Gerards <marco@gnu.org>
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2009 David Conrad
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2011 Jordi Ortiz
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_DIRAC_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_DIRAC_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Interface to Dirac Decoder/Encoder
|
||||
* @author Marco Gerards <marco@gnu.org>
|
||||
* @author David Conrad
|
||||
* @author Jordi Ortiz
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The spec limits the number of wavelet decompositions to 4 for both
|
||||
* level 1 (VC-2) and 128 (long-gop default).
|
||||
* 5 decompositions is the maximum before >16-bit buffers are needed.
|
||||
* Schroedinger allows this for DD 9,7 and 13,7 wavelets only, limiting
|
||||
* the others to 4 decompositions (or 3 for the fidelity filter).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* We use this instead of MAX_DECOMPOSITIONS to save some memory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define MAX_DWT_LEVELS 5
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse code values:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Dirac Specification ->
|
||||
* 9.6.1 Table 9.1
|
||||
*
|
||||
* VC-2 Specification ->
|
||||
* 10.4.1 Table 10.1
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum DiracParseCodes {
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_SEQ_HEADER = 0x00,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_END_SEQ = 0x10,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_AUX = 0x20,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_PAD = 0x30,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_PICTURE_CODED = 0x08,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_PICTURE_RAW = 0x48,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_PICTURE_LOW_DEL = 0xC8,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_PICTURE_HQ = 0xE8,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTER_NOREF_CO1 = 0x0A,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTER_NOREF_CO2 = 0x09,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTER_REF_CO1 = 0x0D,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTER_REF_CO2 = 0x0E,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTRA_REF_CO = 0x0C,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTRA_REF_RAW = 0x4C,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_INTRA_REF_PICT = 0xCC,
|
||||
DIRAC_PCODE_MAGIC = 0x42424344,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct DiracVersionInfo {
|
||||
int major;
|
||||
int minor;
|
||||
} DiracVersionInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDiracSeqHeader {
|
||||
unsigned width;
|
||||
unsigned height;
|
||||
uint8_t chroma_format; ///< 0: 444 1: 422 2: 420
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t interlaced;
|
||||
uint8_t top_field_first;
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t frame_rate_index; ///< index into dirac_frame_rate[]
|
||||
uint8_t aspect_ratio_index; ///< index into dirac_aspect_ratio[]
|
||||
|
||||
uint16_t clean_width;
|
||||
uint16_t clean_height;
|
||||
uint16_t clean_left_offset;
|
||||
uint16_t clean_right_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t pixel_range_index; ///< index into dirac_pixel_range_presets[]
|
||||
uint8_t color_spec_index; ///< index into dirac_color_spec_presets[]
|
||||
|
||||
int profile;
|
||||
int level;
|
||||
|
||||
AVRational framerate;
|
||||
AVRational sample_aspect_ratio;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt;
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
enum AVColorPrimaries color_primaries;
|
||||
enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace colorspace;
|
||||
|
||||
DiracVersionInfo version;
|
||||
int bit_depth;
|
||||
} AVDiracSeqHeader;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse a Dirac sequence header.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dsh this function will allocate and fill an AVDiracSeqHeader struct
|
||||
* and write it into this pointer. The caller must free it with
|
||||
* av_free().
|
||||
* @param buf the data buffer
|
||||
* @param buf_size the size of the data buffer in bytes
|
||||
* @param log_ctx if non-NULL, this function will log errors here
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dirac_parse_sequence_header(AVDiracSeqHeader **dsh,
|
||||
const uint8_t *buf, size_t buf_size,
|
||||
void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_DIRAC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_DV_PROFILE_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_DV_PROFILE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* minimum number of bytes to read from a DV stream in order to
|
||||
* determine the profile */
|
||||
#define DV_PROFILE_BYTES (6 * 80) /* 6 DIF blocks */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* AVDVProfile is used to express the differences between various
|
||||
* DV flavors. For now it's primarily used for differentiating
|
||||
* 525/60 and 625/50, but the plans are to use it for various
|
||||
* DV specs as well (e.g. SMPTE314M vs. IEC 61834).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDVProfile {
|
||||
int dsf; /* value of the dsf in the DV header */
|
||||
int video_stype; /* stype for VAUX source pack */
|
||||
int frame_size; /* total size of one frame in bytes */
|
||||
int difseg_size; /* number of DIF segments per DIF channel */
|
||||
int n_difchan; /* number of DIF channels per frame */
|
||||
AVRational time_base; /* 1/framerate */
|
||||
int ltc_divisor; /* FPS from the LTS standpoint */
|
||||
int height; /* picture height in pixels */
|
||||
int width; /* picture width in pixels */
|
||||
AVRational sar[2]; /* sample aspect ratios for 4:3 and 16:9 */
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt; /* picture pixel format */
|
||||
int bpm; /* blocks per macroblock */
|
||||
const uint8_t *block_sizes; /* AC block sizes, in bits */
|
||||
int audio_stride; /* size of audio_shuffle table */
|
||||
int audio_min_samples[3]; /* min amount of audio samples */
|
||||
/* for 48kHz, 44.1kHz and 32kHz */
|
||||
int audio_samples_dist[5]; /* how many samples are supposed to be */
|
||||
/* in each frame in a 5 frames window */
|
||||
const uint8_t (*audio_shuffle)[9]; /* PCM shuffling table */
|
||||
} AVDVProfile;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a DV profile for the provided compressed frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sys the profile used for the previous frame, may be NULL
|
||||
* @param frame the compressed data buffer
|
||||
* @param buf_size size of the buffer in bytes
|
||||
* @return the DV profile for the supplied data or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVDVProfile *av_dv_frame_profile(const AVDVProfile *sys,
|
||||
const uint8_t *frame, unsigned buf_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a DV profile for the provided stream parameters.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVDVProfile *av_dv_codec_profile(int width, int height, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a DV profile for the provided stream parameters.
|
||||
* The frame rate is used as a best-effort parameter.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVDVProfile *av_dv_codec_profile2(int width, int height, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, AVRational frame_rate);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_DV_PROFILE_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,90 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* DXVA2 HW acceleration
|
||||
*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2009 Laurent Aimar
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_DXVA2_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_DXVA2_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_dxva2
|
||||
* Public libavcodec DXVA2 header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined(_WIN32_WINNT) || _WIN32_WINNT < 0x0602
|
||||
#undef _WIN32_WINNT
|
||||
#define _WIN32_WINNT 0x0602
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <d3d9.h>
|
||||
#include <dxva2api.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_dxva2 DXVA2
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure is used to provides the necessary configurations and data
|
||||
* to the DXVA2 FFmpeg HWAccel implementation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The application must make it available as AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct dxva_context {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DXVA2 decoder object
|
||||
*/
|
||||
IDirectXVideoDecoder *decoder;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DXVA2 configuration used to create the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const DXVA2_ConfigPictureDecode *cfg;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of surface in the surface array
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned surface_count;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The array of Direct3D surfaces used to create the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
LPDIRECT3DSURFACE9 *surface;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A bit field configuring the workarounds needed for using the decoder
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t workaround;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Private to the FFmpeg AVHWAccel implementation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned report_id;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_DXVA2_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,67 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* JNI public API functions
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2015-2016 Matthieu Bouron <matthieu.bouron stupeflix.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_JNI_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_JNI_H
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Manually set a Java virtual machine which will be used to retrieve the JNI
|
||||
* environment. Once a Java VM is set it cannot be changed afterwards, meaning
|
||||
* you can call multiple times av_jni_set_java_vm with the same Java VM pointer
|
||||
* however it will error out if you try to set a different Java VM.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param vm Java virtual machine
|
||||
* @param log_ctx context used for logging, can be NULL
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_jni_set_java_vm(void *vm, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Get the Java virtual machine which has been set with av_jni_set_java_vm.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param vm Java virtual machine
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the Java virtual machine
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *av_jni_get_java_vm(void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Set the Android application context which will be used to retrieve the Android
|
||||
* content resolver to handle content uris.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is only available on Android.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param app_ctx global JNI reference to the Android application context
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_jni_set_android_app_ctx(void *app_ctx, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Get the Android application context that has been set with
|
||||
* av_jni_set_android_app_ctx.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is only available on Android.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer the the Android application context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *av_jni_get_android_app_ctx(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_JNI_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Android MediaCodec public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2016 Matthieu Bouron <matthieu.bouron stupeflix.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_MEDIACODEC_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_MEDIACODEC_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavcodec/avcodec.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure holds a reference to a android/view/Surface object that will
|
||||
* be used as output by the decoder.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVMediaCodecContext {
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* android/view/Surface object reference.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *surface;
|
||||
|
||||
} AVMediaCodecContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize a MediaCodec context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When decoding with MediaCodec is finished, the caller must free the
|
||||
* MediaCodec context with av_mediacodec_default_free.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer to a newly allocated AVMediaCodecContext on success, NULL otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVMediaCodecContext *av_mediacodec_alloc_context(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenience function that sets up the MediaCodec context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avctx codec context
|
||||
* @param ctx MediaCodec context to initialize
|
||||
* @param surface reference to an android/view/Surface
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_mediacodec_default_init(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVMediaCodecContext *ctx, void *surface);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This function must be called to free the MediaCodec context initialized with
|
||||
* av_mediacodec_default_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avctx codec context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_mediacodec_default_free(AVCodecContext *avctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Opaque structure representing a MediaCodec buffer to render.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct MediaCodecBuffer AVMediaCodecBuffer;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Release a MediaCodec buffer and render it to the surface that is associated
|
||||
* with the decoder. This function should only be called once on a given
|
||||
* buffer, once released the underlying buffer returns to the codec, thus
|
||||
* subsequent calls to this function will have no effect.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buffer the buffer to render
|
||||
* @param render 1 to release and render the buffer to the surface or 0 to
|
||||
* discard the buffer
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_mediacodec_release_buffer(AVMediaCodecBuffer *buffer, int render);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Release a MediaCodec buffer and render it at the given time to the surface
|
||||
* that is associated with the decoder. The timestamp must be within one second
|
||||
* of the current `java/lang/System#nanoTime()` (which is implemented using
|
||||
* `CLOCK_MONOTONIC` on Android). See the Android MediaCodec documentation
|
||||
* of [`android/media/MediaCodec#releaseOutputBuffer(int,long)`][0] for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buffer the buffer to render
|
||||
* @param time timestamp in nanoseconds of when to render the buffer
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 otherwise
|
||||
*
|
||||
* [0]: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/media/MediaCodec#releaseOutputBuffer(int,%20long)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_mediacodec_render_buffer_at_time(AVMediaCodecBuffer *buffer, int64_t time);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_MEDIACODEC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,870 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* AVPacket public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_PACKET_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_PACKET_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/buffer.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/dict.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/rational.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavcodec/version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_packet_side_data AVPacketSideData
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Types and functions for working with AVPacketSideData.
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AV_PKT_DATA_PALETTE side data packet contains exactly AVPALETTE_SIZE
|
||||
* bytes worth of palette. This side data signals that a new palette is
|
||||
* present.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_PALETTE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The AV_PKT_DATA_NEW_EXTRADATA is used to notify the codec or the format
|
||||
* that the extradata buffer was changed and the receiving side should
|
||||
* act upon it appropriately. The new extradata is embedded in the side
|
||||
* data buffer and should be immediately used for processing the current
|
||||
* frame or packet.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_NEW_EXTRADATA,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AV_PKT_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE side data packet is laid out as follows:
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u32le param_flags
|
||||
* if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_COUNT)
|
||||
* s32le channel_count
|
||||
* if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_LAYOUT)
|
||||
* u64le channel_layout
|
||||
* if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_SAMPLE_RATE)
|
||||
* s32le sample_rate
|
||||
* if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_DIMENSIONS)
|
||||
* s32le width
|
||||
* s32le height
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AV_PKT_DATA_H263_MB_INFO side data packet contains a number of
|
||||
* structures with info about macroblocks relevant to splitting the
|
||||
* packet into smaller packets on macroblock edges (e.g. as for RFC 2190).
|
||||
* That is, it does not necessarily contain info about all macroblocks,
|
||||
* as long as the distance between macroblocks in the info is smaller
|
||||
* than the target payload size.
|
||||
* Each MB info structure is 12 bytes, and is laid out as follows:
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u32le bit offset from the start of the packet
|
||||
* u8 current quantizer at the start of the macroblock
|
||||
* u8 GOB number
|
||||
* u16le macroblock address within the GOB
|
||||
* u8 horizontal MV predictor
|
||||
* u8 vertical MV predictor
|
||||
* u8 horizontal MV predictor for block number 3
|
||||
* u8 vertical MV predictor for block number 3
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_H263_MB_INFO,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data should be associated with an audio stream and contains
|
||||
* ReplayGain information in form of the AVReplayGain struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_REPLAYGAIN,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data contains a 3x3 transformation matrix describing an affine
|
||||
* transformation that needs to be applied to the decoded video frames for
|
||||
* correct presentation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* See libavutil/display.h for a detailed description of the data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_DISPLAYMATRIX,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data should be associated with a video stream and contains
|
||||
* Stereoscopic 3D information in form of the AVStereo3D struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_STEREO3D,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data should be associated with an audio stream and corresponds
|
||||
* to enum AVAudioServiceType.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data contains quality related information from the encoder.
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u32le quality factor of the compressed frame. Allowed range is between 1 (good) and FF_LAMBDA_MAX (bad).
|
||||
* u8 picture type
|
||||
* u8 error count
|
||||
* u16 reserved
|
||||
* u64le[error count] sum of squared differences between encoder in and output
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_STATS,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data contains an integer value representing the stream index
|
||||
* of a "fallback" track. A fallback track indicates an alternate
|
||||
* track to use when the current track can not be decoded for some reason.
|
||||
* e.g. no decoder available for codec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_FALLBACK_TRACK,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data corresponds to the AVCPBProperties struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_CPB_PROPERTIES,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Recommmends skipping the specified number of samples
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u32le number of samples to skip from start of this packet
|
||||
* u32le number of samples to skip from end of this packet
|
||||
* u8 reason for start skip
|
||||
* u8 reason for end skip (0=padding silence, 1=convergence)
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_SKIP_SAMPLES,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AV_PKT_DATA_JP_DUALMONO side data packet indicates that
|
||||
* the packet may contain "dual mono" audio specific to Japanese DTV
|
||||
* and if it is true, recommends only the selected channel to be used.
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u8 selected channels (0=main/left, 1=sub/right, 2=both)
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_JP_DUALMONO,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A list of zero terminated key/value strings. There is no end marker for
|
||||
* the list, so it is required to rely on the side data size to stop.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_STRINGS_METADATA,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtitle event position
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* u32le x1
|
||||
* u32le y1
|
||||
* u32le x2
|
||||
* u32le y2
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_SUBTITLE_POSITION,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Data found in BlockAdditional element of matroska container. There is
|
||||
* no end marker for the data, so it is required to rely on the side data
|
||||
* size to recognize the end. 8 byte id (as found in BlockAddId) followed
|
||||
* by data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_MATROSKA_BLOCKADDITIONAL,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The optional first identifier line of a WebVTT cue.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_WEBVTT_IDENTIFIER,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The optional settings (rendering instructions) that immediately
|
||||
* follow the timestamp specifier of a WebVTT cue.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_WEBVTT_SETTINGS,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A list of zero terminated key/value strings. There is no end marker for
|
||||
* the list, so it is required to rely on the side data size to stop. This
|
||||
* side data includes updated metadata which appeared in the stream.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_METADATA_UPDATE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* MPEGTS stream ID as uint8_t, this is required to pass the stream ID
|
||||
* information from the demuxer to the corresponding muxer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_MPEGTS_STREAM_ID,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mastering display metadata (based on SMPTE-2086:2014). This metadata
|
||||
* should be associated with a video stream and contains data in the form
|
||||
* of the AVMasteringDisplayMetadata struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_MASTERING_DISPLAY_METADATA,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data should be associated with a video stream and corresponds
|
||||
* to the AVSphericalMapping structure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_SPHERICAL,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Content light level (based on CTA-861.3). This metadata should be
|
||||
* associated with a video stream and contains data in the form of the
|
||||
* AVContentLightMetadata struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_CONTENT_LIGHT_LEVEL,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ATSC A53 Part 4 Closed Captions. This metadata should be associated with
|
||||
* a video stream. A53 CC bitstream is stored as uint8_t in AVPacketSideData.data.
|
||||
* The number of bytes of CC data is AVPacketSideData.size.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_A53_CC,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data is encryption initialization data.
|
||||
* The format is not part of ABI, use av_encryption_init_info_* methods to
|
||||
* access.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_ENCRYPTION_INIT_INFO,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This side data contains encryption info for how to decrypt the packet.
|
||||
* The format is not part of ABI, use av_encryption_info_* methods to access.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_ENCRYPTION_INFO,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Active Format Description data consisting of a single byte as specified
|
||||
* in ETSI TS 101 154 using AVActiveFormatDescription enum.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_AFD,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Producer Reference Time data corresponding to the AVProducerReferenceTime struct,
|
||||
* usually exported by some encoders (on demand through the prft flag set in the
|
||||
* AVCodecContext export_side_data field).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_PRFT,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ICC profile data consisting of an opaque octet buffer following the
|
||||
* format described by ISO 15076-1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_ICC_PROFILE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DOVI configuration
|
||||
* ref:
|
||||
* dolby-vision-bitstreams-within-the-iso-base-media-file-format-v2.1.2, section 2.2
|
||||
* dolby-vision-bitstreams-in-mpeg-2-transport-stream-multiplex-v1.2, section 3.3
|
||||
* Tags are stored in struct AVDOVIDecoderConfigurationRecord.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_DOVI_CONF,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Timecode which conforms to SMPTE ST 12-1:2014. The data is an array of 4 uint32_t
|
||||
* where the first uint32_t describes how many (1-3) of the other timecodes are used.
|
||||
* The timecode format is described in the documentation of av_timecode_get_smpte_from_framenum()
|
||||
* function in libavutil/timecode.h.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_S12M_TIMECODE,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* HDR10+ dynamic metadata associated with a video frame. The metadata is in
|
||||
* the form of the AVDynamicHDRPlus struct and contains
|
||||
* information for color volume transform - application 4 of
|
||||
* SMPTE 2094-40:2016 standard.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_DYNAMIC_HDR10_PLUS,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* IAMF Mix Gain Parameter Data associated with the audio frame. This metadata
|
||||
* is in the form of the AVIAMFParamDefinition struct and contains information
|
||||
* defined in sections 3.6.1 and 3.8.1 of the Immersive Audio Model and
|
||||
* Formats standard.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_IAMF_MIX_GAIN_PARAM,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* IAMF Demixing Info Parameter Data associated with the audio frame. This
|
||||
* metadata is in the form of the AVIAMFParamDefinition struct and contains
|
||||
* information defined in sections 3.6.1 and 3.8.2 of the Immersive Audio Model
|
||||
* and Formats standard.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_IAMF_DEMIXING_INFO_PARAM,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* IAMF Recon Gain Info Parameter Data associated with the audio frame. This
|
||||
* metadata is in the form of the AVIAMFParamDefinition struct and contains
|
||||
* information defined in sections 3.6.1 and 3.8.3 of the Immersive Audio Model
|
||||
* and Formats standard.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_IAMF_RECON_GAIN_INFO_PARAM,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Ambient viewing environment metadata, as defined by H.274. This metadata
|
||||
* should be associated with a video stream and contains data in the form
|
||||
* of the AVAmbientViewingEnvironment struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_AMBIENT_VIEWING_ENVIRONMENT,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of side data types.
|
||||
* This is not part of the public API/ABI in the sense that it may
|
||||
* change when new side data types are added.
|
||||
* This must stay the last enum value.
|
||||
* If its value becomes huge, some code using it
|
||||
* needs to be updated as it assumes it to be smaller than other limits.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_PKT_DATA_NB
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_FACTOR AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_STATS //DEPRECATED
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure stores auxiliary information for decoding, presenting, or
|
||||
* otherwise processing the coded stream. It is typically exported by demuxers
|
||||
* and encoders and can be fed to decoders and muxers either in a per packet
|
||||
* basis, or as global side data (applying to the entire coded stream).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Global side data is handled as follows:
|
||||
* - During demuxing, it may be exported through
|
||||
* @ref AVStream.codecpar.side_data "AVStream's codec parameters", which can
|
||||
* then be passed as input to decoders through the
|
||||
* @ref AVCodecContext.coded_side_data "decoder context's side data", for
|
||||
* initialization.
|
||||
* - For muxing, it can be fed through @ref AVStream.codecpar.side_data
|
||||
* "AVStream's codec parameters", typically the output of encoders through
|
||||
* the @ref AVCodecContext.coded_side_data "encoder context's side data", for
|
||||
* initialization.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Packet specific side data is handled as follows:
|
||||
* - During demuxing, it may be exported through @ref AVPacket.side_data
|
||||
* "AVPacket's side data", which can then be passed as input to decoders.
|
||||
* - For muxing, it can be fed through @ref AVPacket.side_data "AVPacket's
|
||||
* side data", typically the output of encoders.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Different modules may accept or export different types of side data
|
||||
* depending on media type and codec. Refer to @ref AVPacketSideDataType for a
|
||||
* list of defined types and where they may be found or used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVPacketSideData {
|
||||
uint8_t *data;
|
||||
size_t size;
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType type;
|
||||
} AVPacketSideData;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new packet side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sd pointer to an array of side data to which the side data should
|
||||
* be added. *sd may be NULL, in which case the array will be
|
||||
* initialized.
|
||||
* @param nb_sd pointer to an integer containing the number of entries in
|
||||
* the array. The integer value will be increased by 1 on success.
|
||||
* @param type side data type
|
||||
* @param size desired side data size
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused. Must be zero
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return pointer to freshly allocated side data on success, or NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacketSideData *av_packet_side_data_new(AVPacketSideData **psd, int *pnb_sd,
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
size_t size, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Wrap existing data as packet side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sd pointer to an array of side data to which the side data should
|
||||
* be added. *sd may be NULL, in which case the array will be
|
||||
* initialized
|
||||
* @param nb_sd pointer to an integer containing the number of entries in
|
||||
* the array. The integer value will be increased by 1 on success.
|
||||
* @param type side data type
|
||||
* @param data a data array. It must be allocated with the av_malloc() family
|
||||
* of functions. The ownership of the data is transferred to the
|
||||
* side data array on success
|
||||
* @param size size of the data array
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused. Must be zero
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return pointer to freshly allocated side data on success, or NULL otherwise
|
||||
* On failure, the side data array is unchanged and the data remains
|
||||
* owned by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacketSideData *av_packet_side_data_add(AVPacketSideData **sd, int *nb_sd,
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
void *data, size_t size, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get side information from a side data array.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sd the array from which the side data should be fetched
|
||||
* @param nb_sd value containing the number of entries in the array.
|
||||
* @param type desired side information type
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return pointer to side data if present or NULL otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVPacketSideData *av_packet_side_data_get(const AVPacketSideData *sd,
|
||||
int nb_sd,
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Remove side data of the given type from a side data array.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sd the array from which the side data should be removed
|
||||
* @param nb_sd pointer to an integer containing the number of entries in
|
||||
* the array. Will be reduced by the amount of entries removed
|
||||
* upon return
|
||||
* @param type side information type
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_side_data_remove(AVPacketSideData *sd, int *nb_sd,
|
||||
enum AVPacketSideDataType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenience function to free all the side data stored in an array, and
|
||||
* the array itself.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sd pointer to array of side data to free. Will be set to NULL
|
||||
* upon return.
|
||||
* @param nb_sd pointer to an integer containing the number of entries in
|
||||
* the array. Will be set to 0 upon return.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_side_data_free(AVPacketSideData **sd, int *nb_sd);
|
||||
|
||||
const char *av_packet_side_data_name(enum AVPacketSideDataType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_packet AVPacket
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Types and functions for working with AVPacket.
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure stores compressed data. It is typically exported by demuxers
|
||||
* and then passed as input to decoders, or received as output from encoders and
|
||||
* then passed to muxers.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For video, it should typically contain one compressed frame. For audio it may
|
||||
* contain several compressed frames. Encoders are allowed to output empty
|
||||
* packets, with no compressed data, containing only side data
|
||||
* (e.g. to update some stream parameters at the end of encoding).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The semantics of data ownership depends on the buf field.
|
||||
* If it is set, the packet data is dynamically allocated and is
|
||||
* valid indefinitely until a call to av_packet_unref() reduces the
|
||||
* reference count to 0.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the buf field is not set av_packet_ref() would make a copy instead
|
||||
* of increasing the reference count.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The side data is always allocated with av_malloc(), copied by
|
||||
* av_packet_ref() and freed by av_packet_unref().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* sizeof(AVPacket) being a part of the public ABI is deprecated. once
|
||||
* av_init_packet() is removed, new packets will only be able to be allocated
|
||||
* with av_packet_alloc(), and new fields may be added to the end of the struct
|
||||
* with a minor bump.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_alloc
|
||||
* @see av_packet_ref
|
||||
* @see av_packet_unref
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVPacket {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A reference to the reference-counted buffer where the packet data is
|
||||
* stored.
|
||||
* May be NULL, then the packet data is not reference-counted.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *buf;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Presentation timestamp in AVStream->time_base units; the time at which
|
||||
* the decompressed packet will be presented to the user.
|
||||
* Can be AV_NOPTS_VALUE if it is not stored in the file.
|
||||
* pts MUST be larger or equal to dts as presentation cannot happen before
|
||||
* decompression, unless one wants to view hex dumps. Some formats misuse
|
||||
* the terms dts and pts/cts to mean something different. Such timestamps
|
||||
* must be converted to true pts/dts before they are stored in AVPacket.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t pts;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Decompression timestamp in AVStream->time_base units; the time at which
|
||||
* the packet is decompressed.
|
||||
* Can be AV_NOPTS_VALUE if it is not stored in the file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t dts;
|
||||
uint8_t *data;
|
||||
int size;
|
||||
int stream_index;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A combination of AV_PKT_FLAG values
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int flags;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Additional packet data that can be provided by the container.
|
||||
* Packet can contain several types of side information.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacketSideData *side_data;
|
||||
int side_data_elems;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Duration of this packet in AVStream->time_base units, 0 if unknown.
|
||||
* Equals next_pts - this_pts in presentation order.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t duration;
|
||||
|
||||
int64_t pos; ///< byte position in stream, -1 if unknown
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* for some private data of the user
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *opaque;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVBufferRef for free use by the API user. FFmpeg will never check the
|
||||
* contents of the buffer ref. FFmpeg calls av_buffer_unref() on it when
|
||||
* the packet is unreferenced. av_packet_copy_props() calls create a new
|
||||
* reference with av_buffer_ref() for the target packet's opaque_ref field.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is unrelated to the opaque field, although it serves a similar
|
||||
* purpose.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *opaque_ref;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Time base of the packet's timestamps.
|
||||
* In the future, this field may be set on packets output by encoders or
|
||||
* demuxers, but its value will be by default ignored on input to decoders
|
||||
* or muxers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational time_base;
|
||||
} AVPacket;
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_INIT_PACKET
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
typedef struct AVPacketList {
|
||||
AVPacket pkt;
|
||||
struct AVPacketList *next;
|
||||
} AVPacketList;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_FLAG_KEY 0x0001 ///< The packet contains a keyframe
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_FLAG_CORRUPT 0x0002 ///< The packet content is corrupted
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Flag is used to discard packets which are required to maintain valid
|
||||
* decoder state but are not required for output and should be dropped
|
||||
* after decoding.
|
||||
**/
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_FLAG_DISCARD 0x0004
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The packet comes from a trusted source.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Otherwise-unsafe constructs such as arbitrary pointers to data
|
||||
* outside the packet may be followed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_FLAG_TRUSTED 0x0008
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Flag is used to indicate packets that contain frames that can
|
||||
* be discarded by the decoder. I.e. Non-reference frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_PKT_FLAG_DISPOSABLE 0x0010
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVSideDataParamChangeFlags {
|
||||
AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_SAMPLE_RATE = 0x0004,
|
||||
AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_DIMENSIONS = 0x0008,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVPacket and set its fields to default values. The resulting
|
||||
* struct must be freed using av_packet_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return An AVPacket filled with default values or NULL on failure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note this only allocates the AVPacket itself, not the data buffers. Those
|
||||
* must be allocated through other means such as av_new_packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_new_packet
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacket *av_packet_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a new packet that references the same data as src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is a shortcut for av_packet_alloc()+av_packet_ref().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return newly created AVPacket on success, NULL on error.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_alloc
|
||||
* @see av_packet_ref
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVPacket *av_packet_clone(const AVPacket *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free the packet, if the packet is reference counted, it will be
|
||||
* unreferenced first.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet to be freed. The pointer will be set to NULL.
|
||||
* @note passing NULL is a no-op.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_free(AVPacket **pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_INIT_PACKET
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize optional fields of a packet with default values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note, this does not touch the data and size members, which have to be
|
||||
* initialized separately.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_alloc
|
||||
* @see av_packet_unref
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated This function is deprecated. Once it's removed,
|
||||
sizeof(AVPacket) will not be a part of the ABI anymore.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_init_packet(AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate the payload of a packet and initialize its fields with
|
||||
* default values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param size wanted payload size
|
||||
* @return 0 if OK, AVERROR_xxx otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_new_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reduce packet size, correctly zeroing padding
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param size new size
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_shrink_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Increase packet size, correctly zeroing padding
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param grow_by number of bytes by which to increase the size of the packet
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_grow_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int grow_by);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a reference-counted packet from av_malloc()ed data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet to be initialized. This function will set the data, size,
|
||||
* and buf fields, all others are left untouched.
|
||||
* @param data Data allocated by av_malloc() to be used as packet data. If this
|
||||
* function returns successfully, the data is owned by the underlying AVBuffer.
|
||||
* The caller may not access the data through other means.
|
||||
* @param size size of data in bytes, without the padding. I.e. the full buffer
|
||||
* size is assumed to be size + AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_from_data(AVPacket *pkt, uint8_t *data, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate new information of a packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param type side information type
|
||||
* @param size side information size
|
||||
* @return pointer to fresh allocated data or NULL otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t* av_packet_new_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Wrap an existing array as a packet side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param type side information type
|
||||
* @param data the side data array. It must be allocated with the av_malloc()
|
||||
* family of functions. The ownership of the data is transferred to
|
||||
* pkt.
|
||||
* @param size side information size
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative AVERROR code on
|
||||
* failure. On failure, the packet is unchanged and the data remains
|
||||
* owned by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_add_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
uint8_t *data, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Shrink the already allocated side data buffer
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param type side information type
|
||||
* @param size new side information size
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_shrink_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get side information from packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
* @param type desired side information type
|
||||
* @param size If supplied, *size will be set to the size of the side data
|
||||
* or to zero if the desired side data is not present.
|
||||
* @return pointer to data if present or NULL otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t* av_packet_get_side_data(const AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
|
||||
size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pack a dictionary for use in side_data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dict The dictionary to pack.
|
||||
* @param size pointer to store the size of the returned data
|
||||
* @return pointer to data if successful, NULL otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *av_packet_pack_dictionary(AVDictionary *dict, size_t *size);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Unpack a dictionary from side_data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param data data from side_data
|
||||
* @param size size of the data
|
||||
* @param dict the metadata storage dictionary
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, < 0 on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_unpack_dictionary(const uint8_t *data, size_t size,
|
||||
AVDictionary **dict);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenience function to free all the side data stored.
|
||||
* All the other fields stay untouched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_free_side_data(AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Setup a new reference to the data described by a given packet
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If src is reference-counted, setup dst as a new reference to the
|
||||
* buffer in src. Otherwise allocate a new buffer in dst and copy the
|
||||
* data from src into it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* All the other fields are copied from src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_unref
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst Destination packet. Will be completely overwritten.
|
||||
* @param src Source packet
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error. On error, dst
|
||||
* will be blank (as if returned by av_packet_alloc()).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_ref(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Wipe the packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Unreference the buffer referenced by the packet and reset the
|
||||
* remaining packet fields to their default values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt The packet to be unreferenced.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_unref(AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Move every field in src to dst and reset src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_unref
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param src Source packet, will be reset
|
||||
* @param dst Destination packet
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_move_ref(AVPacket *dst, AVPacket *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy only "properties" fields from src to dst.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Properties for the purpose of this function are all the fields
|
||||
* beside those related to the packet data (buf, data, size)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst Destination packet
|
||||
* @param src Source packet
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success AVERROR on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_copy_props(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Ensure the data described by a given packet is reference counted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This function does not ensure that the reference will be writable.
|
||||
* Use av_packet_make_writable instead for that purpose.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_packet_ref
|
||||
* @see av_packet_make_writable
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet whose data should be made reference counted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error. On failure, the
|
||||
* packet is unchanged.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_make_refcounted(AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a writable reference for the data described by a given packet,
|
||||
* avoiding data copy if possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt Packet whose data should be made writable.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure. On failure, the
|
||||
* packet is unchanged.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_packet_make_writable(AVPacket *pkt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert valid timing fields (timestamps / durations) in a packet from one
|
||||
* timebase to another. Timestamps with unknown values (AV_NOPTS_VALUE) will be
|
||||
* ignored.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pkt packet on which the conversion will be performed
|
||||
* @param tb_src source timebase, in which the timing fields in pkt are
|
||||
* expressed
|
||||
* @param tb_dst destination timebase, to which the timing fields will be
|
||||
* converted
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_packet_rescale_ts(AVPacket *pkt, AVRational tb_src, AVRational tb_dst);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // AVCODEC_PACKET_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Intel MediaSDK QSV public API
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_QSV_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_QSV_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <mfxvideo.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/buffer.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is used for communicating QSV parameters between libavcodec and
|
||||
* the caller. It is managed by the caller and must be assigned to
|
||||
* AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context.
|
||||
* - decoding: hwaccel_context must be set on return from the get_format()
|
||||
* callback
|
||||
* - encoding: hwaccel_context must be set before avcodec_open2()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVQSVContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If non-NULL, the session to use for encoding or decoding.
|
||||
* Otherwise, libavcodec will try to create an internal session.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
mfxSession session;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The IO pattern to use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int iopattern;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extra buffers to pass to encoder or decoder initialization.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
mfxExtBuffer **ext_buffers;
|
||||
int nb_ext_buffers;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encoding only. If this field is set to non-zero by the caller, libavcodec
|
||||
* will create an mfxExtOpaqueSurfaceAlloc extended buffer and pass it to
|
||||
* the encoder initialization. This only makes sense if iopattern is also
|
||||
* set to MFX_IOPATTERN_IN_OPAQUE_MEMORY.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The number of allocated opaque surfaces will be the sum of the number
|
||||
* required by the encoder and the user-provided value nb_opaque_surfaces.
|
||||
* The array of the opaque surfaces will be exported to the caller through
|
||||
* the opaque_surfaces field.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The caller must set this field to zero for oneVPL (MFX_VERSION >= 2.0)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int opaque_alloc;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encoding only, and only if opaque_alloc is set to non-zero. Before
|
||||
* calling avcodec_open2(), the caller should set this field to the number
|
||||
* of extra opaque surfaces to allocate beyond what is required by the
|
||||
* encoder.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* On return from avcodec_open2(), this field will be set by libavcodec to
|
||||
* the total number of allocated opaque surfaces.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_opaque_surfaces;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encoding only, and only if opaque_alloc is set to non-zero. On return
|
||||
* from avcodec_open2(), this field will be used by libavcodec to export the
|
||||
* array of the allocated opaque surfaces to the caller, so they can be
|
||||
* passed to other parts of the pipeline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The buffer reference exported here is owned and managed by libavcodec,
|
||||
* the callers should make their own reference with av_buffer_ref() and free
|
||||
* it with av_buffer_unref() when it is no longer needed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The buffer data is an nb_opaque_surfaces-sized array of mfxFrameSurface1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *opaque_surfaces;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encoding only, and only if opaque_alloc is set to non-zero. On return
|
||||
* from avcodec_open2(), this field will be set to the surface type used in
|
||||
* the opaque allocation request.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int opaque_alloc_type;
|
||||
} AVQSVContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It must be freed by the caller with av_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVQSVContext *av_qsv_alloc_context(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_QSV_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,171 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* The Video Decode and Presentation API for UNIX (VDPAU) is used for
|
||||
* hardware-accelerated decoding of MPEG-1/2, H.264 and VC-1.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2008 NVIDIA
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_VDPAU_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_VDPAU_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vdpau
|
||||
* Public libavcodec VDPAU header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vdpau VDPAU Decoder and Renderer
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
|
||||
*
|
||||
* VDPAU hardware acceleration has two modules
|
||||
* - VDPAU decoding
|
||||
* - VDPAU presentation
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The VDPAU decoding module parses all headers using FFmpeg
|
||||
* parsing mechanisms and uses VDPAU for the actual decoding.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* As per the current implementation, the actual decoding
|
||||
* and rendering (API calls) are done as part of the VDPAU
|
||||
* presentation (vo_vdpau.c) module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <vdpau/vdpau.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avconfig.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "avcodec.h"
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVCodecContext;
|
||||
struct AVFrame;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef int (*AVVDPAU_Render2)(struct AVCodecContext *, struct AVFrame *,
|
||||
const VdpPictureInfo *, uint32_t,
|
||||
const VdpBitstreamBuffer *);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure is used to share data between the libavcodec library and
|
||||
* the client video application.
|
||||
* This structure will be allocated and stored in AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context
|
||||
* by av_vdpau_bind_context(). Members can be set by the user once
|
||||
* during initialization or through each AVCodecContext.get_buffer()
|
||||
* function call. In any case, they must be valid prior to calling
|
||||
* decoding functions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The size of this structure is not a part of the public ABI and must not
|
||||
* be used outside of libavcodec.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVDPAUContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* VDPAU decoder handle
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by user.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VdpDecoder decoder;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* VDPAU decoder render callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by the user.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VdpDecoderRender *render;
|
||||
|
||||
AVVDPAU_Render2 render2;
|
||||
} AVVDPAUContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_VDPAU_ALLOC_GET_SET
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief allocation function for AVVDPAUContext
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allows extending the struct without breaking API/ABI
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_vdpau_bind_context() instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVVDPAUContext *av_alloc_vdpaucontext(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @deprecated render2 is public and can be accessed directly
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVVDPAU_Render2 av_vdpau_hwaccel_get_render2(const AVVDPAUContext *);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @deprecated render2 is public and can be accessed directly
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
void av_vdpau_hwaccel_set_render2(AVVDPAUContext *, AVVDPAU_Render2);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Associate a VDPAU device with a codec context for hardware acceleration.
|
||||
* This function is meant to be called from the get_format() codec callback,
|
||||
* or earlier. It can also be called after avcodec_flush_buffers() to change
|
||||
* the underlying VDPAU device mid-stream (e.g. to recover from non-transparent
|
||||
* display preemption).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note get_format() must return AV_PIX_FMT_VDPAU if this function completes
|
||||
* successfully.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avctx decoding context whose get_format() callback is invoked
|
||||
* @param device VDPAU device handle to use for hardware acceleration
|
||||
* @param get_proc_address VDPAU device driver
|
||||
* @param flags zero of more OR'd AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_* flags
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, an AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_vdpau_bind_context(AVCodecContext *avctx, VdpDevice device,
|
||||
VdpGetProcAddress *get_proc_address, unsigned flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Gets the parameters to create an adequate VDPAU video surface for the codec
|
||||
* context using VDPAU hardware decoding acceleration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note Behavior is undefined if the context was not successfully bound to a
|
||||
* VDPAU device using av_vdpau_bind_context().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avctx the codec context being used for decoding the stream
|
||||
* @param type storage space for the VDPAU video surface chroma type
|
||||
* (or NULL to ignore)
|
||||
* @param width storage space for the VDPAU video surface pixel width
|
||||
* (or NULL to ignore)
|
||||
* @param height storage space for the VDPAU video surface pixel height
|
||||
* (or NULL to ignore)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_vdpau_get_surface_parameters(AVCodecContext *avctx, VdpChromaType *type,
|
||||
uint32_t *width, uint32_t *height);
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_VDPAU_ALLOC_GET_SET
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVVDPAUContext.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Newly-allocated AVVDPAUContext or NULL on failure.
|
||||
* @deprecated use av_vdpau_bind_context() instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVVDPAUContext *av_vdpau_alloc_context(void);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_VDPAU_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_VERSION_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_VERSION_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup libavc
|
||||
* Libavcodec version macros.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR 3
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO 100
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_INT AV_VERSION_INT(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION AV_VERSION(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_BUILD LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_INT
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_IDENT "Lavc" AV_STRINGIFY(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_VERSION_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,51 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup libavc
|
||||
* Libavcodec version macros.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR 61
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* FF_API_* defines may be placed below to indicate public API that will be
|
||||
* dropped at a future version bump. The defines themselves are not part of
|
||||
* the public API and may change, break or disappear at any time.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note, when bumping the major version it is recommended to manually
|
||||
* disable each FF_API_* in its own commit instead of disabling them all
|
||||
* at once through the bump. This improves the git bisect-ability of the change.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_API_INIT_PACKET (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_SUBFRAMES (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_TICKS_PER_FRAME (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_DROPCHANGED (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_API_AVFFT (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_FF_PROFILE_LEVEL (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_AVCODEC_CLOSE (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_BUFFER_MIN_SIZE (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_VDPAU_ALLOC_GET_SET (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,85 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Videotoolbox hardware acceleration
|
||||
*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2012 Sebastien Zwickert
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_videotoolbox
|
||||
* Public libavcodec Videotoolbox header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_videotoolbox VideoToolbox Decoder
|
||||
* @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Hardware accelerated decoding using VideoToolbox on Apple Platforms
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define Picture QuickdrawPicture
|
||||
#include <VideoToolbox/VideoToolbox.h>
|
||||
#undef Picture
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavcodec/avcodec.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct holds all the information that needs to be passed
|
||||
* between the caller and libavcodec for initializing Videotoolbox decoding.
|
||||
* Its size is not a part of the public ABI, it must be allocated with
|
||||
* av_videotoolbox_alloc_context() and freed with av_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVideotoolboxContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Videotoolbox decompression session object.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VTDecompressionSessionRef session;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* CVPixelBuffer Format Type that Videotoolbox will use for decoded frames.
|
||||
* set by the caller. If this is set to 0, then no specific format is
|
||||
* requested from the decoder, and its native format is output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
OSType cv_pix_fmt_type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* CoreMedia Format Description that Videotoolbox will use to create the decompression session.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CMVideoFormatDescriptionRef cm_fmt_desc;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* CoreMedia codec type that Videotoolbox will use to create the decompression session.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int cm_codec_type;
|
||||
} AVVideotoolboxContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* A public API for Vorbis parsing
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Determines the duration for each packet.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVCODEC_VORBIS_PARSER_H
|
||||
#define AVCODEC_VORBIS_PARSER_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVVorbisParseContext AVVorbisParseContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize the Vorbis parser using headers in the extradata.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVVorbisParseContext *av_vorbis_parse_init(const uint8_t *extradata,
|
||||
int extradata_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free the parser and everything associated with it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_vorbis_parse_free(AVVorbisParseContext **s);
|
||||
|
||||
#define VORBIS_FLAG_HEADER 0x00000001
|
||||
#define VORBIS_FLAG_COMMENT 0x00000002
|
||||
#define VORBIS_FLAG_SETUP 0x00000004
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the duration for a Vorbis packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If @p flags is @c NULL,
|
||||
* special frames are considered invalid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s Vorbis parser context
|
||||
* @param buf buffer containing a Vorbis frame
|
||||
* @param buf_size size of the buffer
|
||||
* @param flags flags for special frames
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_vorbis_parse_frame_flags(AVVorbisParseContext *s, const uint8_t *buf,
|
||||
int buf_size, int *flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the duration for a Vorbis packet.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s Vorbis parser context
|
||||
* @param buf buffer containing a Vorbis frame
|
||||
* @param buf_size size of the buffer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_vorbis_parse_frame(AVVorbisParseContext *s, const uint8_t *buf,
|
||||
int buf_size);
|
||||
|
||||
void av_vorbis_parse_reset(AVVorbisParseContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVCODEC_VORBIS_PARSER_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,397 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVDEVICE_AVDEVICE_H
|
||||
#define AVDEVICE_AVDEVICE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
#ifndef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
|
||||
/* When included as part of the ffmpeg build, only include the major version
|
||||
* to avoid unnecessary rebuilds. When included externally, keep including
|
||||
* the full version information. */
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavd
|
||||
* Main libavdevice API header
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavd libavdevice
|
||||
* Special devices muxing/demuxing library.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Libavdevice is a complementary library to @ref libavf "libavformat". It
|
||||
* provides various "special" platform-specific muxers and demuxers, e.g. for
|
||||
* grabbing devices, audio capture and playback etc. As a consequence, the
|
||||
* (de)muxers in libavdevice are of the AVFMT_NOFILE type (they use their own
|
||||
* I/O functions). The filename passed to avformat_open_input() often does not
|
||||
* refer to an actually existing file, but has some special device-specific
|
||||
* meaning - e.g. for xcbgrab it is the display name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To use libavdevice, simply call avdevice_register_all() to register all
|
||||
* compiled muxers and demuxers. They all use standard libavformat API.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/log.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/opt.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/dict.h"
|
||||
#include "libavformat/avformat.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_INT constant.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned avdevice_version(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the libavdevice build-time configuration.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avdevice_configuration(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the libavdevice license.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avdevice_license(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize libavdevice and register all the input and output devices.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avdevice_register_all(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio input devices iterator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If d is NULL, returns the first registered input audio/video device,
|
||||
* if d is non-NULL, returns the next registered input audio/video device after d
|
||||
* or NULL if d is the last one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVInputFormat *av_input_audio_device_next(const AVInputFormat *d);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video input devices iterator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If d is NULL, returns the first registered input audio/video device,
|
||||
* if d is non-NULL, returns the next registered input audio/video device after d
|
||||
* or NULL if d is the last one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVInputFormat *av_input_video_device_next(const AVInputFormat *d);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio output devices iterator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If d is NULL, returns the first registered output audio/video device,
|
||||
* if d is non-NULL, returns the next registered output audio/video device after d
|
||||
* or NULL if d is the last one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVOutputFormat *av_output_audio_device_next(const AVOutputFormat *d);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video output devices iterator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If d is NULL, returns the first registered output audio/video device,
|
||||
* if d is non-NULL, returns the next registered output audio/video device after d
|
||||
* or NULL if d is the last one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVOutputFormat *av_output_video_device_next(const AVOutputFormat *d);
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDeviceRect {
|
||||
int x; /**< x coordinate of top left corner */
|
||||
int y; /**< y coordinate of top left corner */
|
||||
int width; /**< width */
|
||||
int height; /**< height */
|
||||
} AVDeviceRect;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Message types used by avdevice_app_to_dev_control_message().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVAppToDevMessageType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dummy message.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_NONE = MKBETAG('N','O','N','E'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Window size change message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Message is sent to the device every time the application changes the size
|
||||
* of the window device renders to.
|
||||
* Message should also be sent right after window is created.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: AVDeviceRect: new window size.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_WINDOW_SIZE = MKBETAG('G','E','O','M'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Repaint request message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Message is sent to the device when window has to be repainted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: AVDeviceRect: area required to be repainted.
|
||||
* NULL: whole area is required to be repainted.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_WINDOW_REPAINT = MKBETAG('R','E','P','A'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Request pause/play.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Application requests pause/unpause playback.
|
||||
* Mostly usable with devices that have internal buffer.
|
||||
* By default devices are not paused.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_PAUSE = MKBETAG('P', 'A', 'U', ' '),
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_PLAY = MKBETAG('P', 'L', 'A', 'Y'),
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_TOGGLE_PAUSE = MKBETAG('P', 'A', 'U', 'T'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Volume control message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set volume level. It may be device-dependent if volume
|
||||
* is changed per stream or system wide. Per stream volume
|
||||
* change is expected when possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: double: new volume with range of 0.0 - 1.0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_SET_VOLUME = MKBETAG('S', 'V', 'O', 'L'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mute control messages.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Change mute state. It may be device-dependent if mute status
|
||||
* is changed per stream or system wide. Per stream mute status
|
||||
* change is expected when possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_MUTE = MKBETAG(' ', 'M', 'U', 'T'),
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_UNMUTE = MKBETAG('U', 'M', 'U', 'T'),
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_TOGGLE_MUTE = MKBETAG('T', 'M', 'U', 'T'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get volume/mute messages.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Force the device to send AV_DEV_TO_APP_VOLUME_LEVEL_CHANGED or
|
||||
* AV_DEV_TO_APP_MUTE_STATE_CHANGED command respectively.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_GET_VOLUME = MKBETAG('G', 'V', 'O', 'L'),
|
||||
AV_APP_TO_DEV_GET_MUTE = MKBETAG('G', 'M', 'U', 'T'),
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Message types used by avdevice_dev_to_app_control_message().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVDevToAppMessageType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dummy message.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_NONE = MKBETAG('N','O','N','E'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create window buffer message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device requests to create a window buffer. Exact meaning is device-
|
||||
* and application-dependent. Message is sent before rendering first
|
||||
* frame and all one-shot initializations should be done here.
|
||||
* Application is allowed to ignore preferred window buffer size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note: Application is obligated to inform about window buffer size
|
||||
* with AV_APP_TO_DEV_WINDOW_SIZE message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: AVDeviceRect: preferred size of the window buffer.
|
||||
* NULL: no preferred size of the window buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_CREATE_WINDOW_BUFFER = MKBETAG('B','C','R','E'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Prepare window buffer message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device requests to prepare a window buffer for rendering.
|
||||
* Exact meaning is device- and application-dependent.
|
||||
* Message is sent before rendering of each frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_PREPARE_WINDOW_BUFFER = MKBETAG('B','P','R','E'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Display window buffer message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device requests to display a window buffer.
|
||||
* Message is sent when new frame is ready to be displayed.
|
||||
* Usually buffers need to be swapped in handler of this message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_DISPLAY_WINDOW_BUFFER = MKBETAG('B','D','I','S'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Destroy window buffer message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device requests to destroy a window buffer.
|
||||
* Message is sent when device is about to be destroyed and window
|
||||
* buffer is not required anymore.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_DESTROY_WINDOW_BUFFER = MKBETAG('B','D','E','S'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Buffer fullness status messages.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device signals buffer overflow/underflow.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_BUFFER_OVERFLOW = MKBETAG('B','O','F','L'),
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_BUFFER_UNDERFLOW = MKBETAG('B','U','F','L'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Buffer readable/writable.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device informs that buffer is readable/writable.
|
||||
* When possible, device informs how many bytes can be read/write.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning Device may not inform when number of bytes than can be read/write changes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: int64_t: amount of bytes available to read/write.
|
||||
* NULL: amount of bytes available to read/write is not known.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_BUFFER_READABLE = MKBETAG('B','R','D',' '),
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_BUFFER_WRITABLE = MKBETAG('B','W','R',' '),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mute state change message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device informs that mute state has changed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: int: 0 for not muted state, non-zero for muted state.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_MUTE_STATE_CHANGED = MKBETAG('C','M','U','T'),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Volume level change message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Device informs that volume level has changed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data: double: new volume with range of 0.0 - 1.0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DEV_TO_APP_VOLUME_LEVEL_CHANGED = MKBETAG('C','V','O','L'),
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Send control message from application to device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s device context.
|
||||
* @param type message type.
|
||||
* @param data message data. Exact type depends on message type.
|
||||
* @param data_size size of message data.
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success, negative on error.
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOSYS) when device doesn't implement handler of the message.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avdevice_app_to_dev_control_message(struct AVFormatContext *s,
|
||||
enum AVAppToDevMessageType type,
|
||||
void *data, size_t data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Send control message from device to application.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s device context.
|
||||
* @param type message type.
|
||||
* @param data message data. Can be NULL.
|
||||
* @param data_size size of message data.
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success, negative on error.
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOSYS) when application doesn't implement handler of the message.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avdevice_dev_to_app_control_message(struct AVFormatContext *s,
|
||||
enum AVDevToAppMessageType type,
|
||||
void *data, size_t data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Structure describes basic parameters of the device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDeviceInfo {
|
||||
char *device_name; /**< device name, format depends on device */
|
||||
char *device_description; /**< human friendly name */
|
||||
enum AVMediaType *media_types; /**< array indicating what media types(s), if any, a device can provide. If null, cannot provide any */
|
||||
int nb_media_types; /**< length of media_types array, 0 if device cannot provide any media types */
|
||||
} AVDeviceInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* List of devices.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDeviceInfoList {
|
||||
AVDeviceInfo **devices; /**< list of autodetected devices */
|
||||
int nb_devices; /**< number of autodetected devices */
|
||||
int default_device; /**< index of default device or -1 if no default */
|
||||
} AVDeviceInfoList;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* List devices.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Returns available device names and their parameters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note: Some devices may accept system-dependent device names that cannot be
|
||||
* autodetected. The list returned by this function cannot be assumed to
|
||||
* be always completed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s device context.
|
||||
* @param[out] device_list list of autodetected devices.
|
||||
* @return count of autodetected devices, negative on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avdevice_list_devices(struct AVFormatContext *s, AVDeviceInfoList **device_list);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenient function to free result of avdevice_list_devices().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param device_list device list to be freed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avdevice_free_list_devices(AVDeviceInfoList **device_list);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* List devices.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Returns available device names and their parameters.
|
||||
* These are convinient wrappers for avdevice_list_devices().
|
||||
* Device context is allocated and deallocated internally.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param device device format. May be NULL if device name is set.
|
||||
* @param device_name device name. May be NULL if device format is set.
|
||||
* @param device_options An AVDictionary filled with device-private options. May be NULL.
|
||||
* The same options must be passed later to avformat_write_header() for output
|
||||
* devices or avformat_open_input() for input devices, or at any other place
|
||||
* that affects device-private options.
|
||||
* @param[out] device_list list of autodetected devices
|
||||
* @return count of autodetected devices, negative on error.
|
||||
* @note device argument takes precedence over device_name when both are set.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avdevice_list_input_sources(const AVInputFormat *device, const char *device_name,
|
||||
AVDictionary *device_options, AVDeviceInfoList **device_list);
|
||||
int avdevice_list_output_sinks(const AVOutputFormat *device, const char *device_name,
|
||||
AVDictionary *device_options, AVDeviceInfoList **device_list);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVDEVICE_AVDEVICE_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVDEVICE_VERSION_H
|
||||
#define AVDEVICE_VERSION_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavd
|
||||
* Libavdevice version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MINOR 1
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MICRO 100
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_INT AV_VERSION_INT(LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION AV_VERSION(LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_BUILD LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_INT
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_IDENT "Lavd" AV_STRINGIFY(LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVDEVICE_VERSION_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,43 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
#define AVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavd
|
||||
* Libavdevice version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR 61
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* FF_API_* defines may be placed below to indicate public API that will be
|
||||
* dropped at a future version bump. The defines themselves are not part of
|
||||
* the public API and may change, break or disappear at any time.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
// reminder to remove the bktr device on next major bump
|
||||
#define FF_API_BKTR_DEVICE (LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
// reminder to remove the opengl device on next major bump
|
||||
#define FF_API_OPENGL_DEVICE (LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
// reminder to remove the sdl2 device on next major bump
|
||||
#define FF_API_SDL2_DEVICE (LIBAVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVDEVICE_VERSION_MAJOR_H */
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -0,0 +1,173 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFILTER_BUFFERSINK_H
|
||||
#define AVFILTER_BUFFERSINK_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi_buffersink
|
||||
* memory buffer sink API for audio and video
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "avfilter.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavfi_buffersink Buffer sink API
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The buffersink and abuffersink filters are there to connect filter graphs
|
||||
* to applications. They have a single input, connected to the graph, and no
|
||||
* output. Frames must be extracted using av_buffersink_get_frame() or
|
||||
* av_buffersink_get_samples().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The format negotiated by the graph during configuration can be obtained
|
||||
* using the accessor functions:
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_time_base(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_format(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_frame_rate(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_w(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_h(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_sample_aspect_ratio(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_channels(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_ch_layout(),
|
||||
* - av_buffersink_get_sample_rate().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The layout returned by av_buffersink_get_ch_layout() must de uninitialized
|
||||
* by the caller.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The format can be constrained by setting options, using av_opt_set() and
|
||||
* related functions with the AV_OPT_SEARCH_CHILDREN flag.
|
||||
* - pix_fmts (int list),
|
||||
* - color_spaces (int list),
|
||||
* - color_ranges (int list),
|
||||
* - sample_fmts (int list),
|
||||
* - sample_rates (int list),
|
||||
* - ch_layouts (string),
|
||||
* - channel_counts (int list),
|
||||
* - all_channel_counts (bool).
|
||||
* Most of these options are of type binary, and should be set using
|
||||
* av_opt_set_int_list() or av_opt_set_bin(). If they are not set, all
|
||||
* corresponding formats are accepted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* As a special case, if ch_layouts is not set, all valid channel layouts are
|
||||
* accepted except for UNSPEC layouts, unless all_channel_counts is set.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a frame with filtered data from sink and put it in frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx pointer to a buffersink or abuffersink filter context.
|
||||
* @param frame pointer to an allocated frame that will be filled with data.
|
||||
* The data must be freed using av_frame_unref() / av_frame_free()
|
||||
* @param flags a combination of AV_BUFFERSINK_FLAG_* flags
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in for success, a negative AVERROR code for failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_frame_flags(AVFilterContext *ctx, AVFrame *frame, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Tell av_buffersink_get_buffer_ref() to read video/samples buffer
|
||||
* reference, but not remove it from the buffer. This is useful if you
|
||||
* need only to read a video/samples buffer, without to fetch it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BUFFERSINK_FLAG_PEEK 1
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Tell av_buffersink_get_buffer_ref() not to request a frame from its input.
|
||||
* If a frame is already buffered, it is read (and removed from the buffer),
|
||||
* but if no frame is present, return AVERROR(EAGAIN).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BUFFERSINK_FLAG_NO_REQUEST 2
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the frame size for an audio buffer sink.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* All calls to av_buffersink_get_buffer_ref will return a buffer with
|
||||
* exactly the specified number of samples, or AVERROR(EAGAIN) if there is
|
||||
* not enough. The last buffer at EOF will be padded with 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_buffersink_set_frame_size(AVFilterContext *ctx, unsigned frame_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavfi_buffersink_accessors Buffer sink accessors
|
||||
* Get the properties of the stream
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVMediaType av_buffersink_get_type (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
AVRational av_buffersink_get_time_base (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_format (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
AVRational av_buffersink_get_frame_rate (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_w (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_h (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
AVRational av_buffersink_get_sample_aspect_ratio (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace av_buffersink_get_colorspace (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
enum AVColorRange av_buffersink_get_color_range (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_channels (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_ch_layout (const AVFilterContext *ctx,
|
||||
AVChannelLayout *ch_layout);
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_sample_rate (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
AVBufferRef * av_buffersink_get_hw_frames_ctx (const AVFilterContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a frame with filtered data from sink and put it in frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx pointer to a context of a buffersink or abuffersink AVFilter.
|
||||
* @param frame pointer to an allocated frame that will be filled with data.
|
||||
* The data must be freed using av_frame_unref() / av_frame_free()
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return
|
||||
* - >= 0 if a frame was successfully returned.
|
||||
* - AVERROR(EAGAIN) if no frames are available at this point; more
|
||||
* input frames must be added to the filtergraph to get more output.
|
||||
* - AVERROR_EOF if there will be no more output frames on this sink.
|
||||
* - A different negative AVERROR code in other failure cases.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_frame(AVFilterContext *ctx, AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Same as av_buffersink_get_frame(), but with the ability to specify the number
|
||||
* of samples read. This function is less efficient than
|
||||
* av_buffersink_get_frame(), because it copies the data around.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx pointer to a context of the abuffersink AVFilter.
|
||||
* @param frame pointer to an allocated frame that will be filled with data.
|
||||
* The data must be freed using av_frame_unref() / av_frame_free()
|
||||
* frame will contain exactly nb_samples audio samples, except at
|
||||
* the end of stream, when it can contain less than nb_samples.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The return codes have the same meaning as for
|
||||
* av_buffersink_get_frame().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning do not mix this function with av_buffersink_get_frame(). Use only one or
|
||||
* the other with a single sink, not both.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffersink_get_samples(AVFilterContext *ctx, AVFrame *frame, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFILTER_BUFFERSINK_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,215 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFILTER_BUFFERSRC_H
|
||||
#define AVFILTER_BUFFERSRC_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi_buffersrc
|
||||
* Memory buffer source API.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "avfilter.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavfi_buffersrc Buffer source API
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Do not check for format changes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_NO_CHECK_FORMAT = 1,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Immediately push the frame to the output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_PUSH = 4,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Keep a reference to the frame.
|
||||
* If the frame if reference-counted, create a new reference; otherwise
|
||||
* copy the frame data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_KEEP_REF = 8,
|
||||
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the number of failed requests.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A failed request is when the request_frame method is called while no
|
||||
* frame is present in the buffer.
|
||||
* The number is reset when a frame is added.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned av_buffersrc_get_nb_failed_requests(AVFilterContext *buffer_src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure contains the parameters describing the frames that will be
|
||||
* passed to this filter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It should be allocated with av_buffersrc_parameters_alloc() and freed with
|
||||
* av_free(). All the allocated fields in it remain owned by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBufferSrcParameters {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* video: the pixel format, value corresponds to enum AVPixelFormat
|
||||
* audio: the sample format, value corresponds to enum AVSampleFormat
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int format;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The timebase to be used for the timestamps on the input frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational time_base;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only, the display dimensions of the input frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int width, height;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only, the sample (pixel) aspect ratio.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational sample_aspect_ratio;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only, the frame rate of the input video. This field must only be
|
||||
* set to a non-zero value if input stream has a known constant framerate
|
||||
* and should be left at its initial value if the framerate is variable or
|
||||
* unknown.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational frame_rate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video with a hwaccel pixel format only. This should be a reference to an
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext instance describing the input frames.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *hw_frames_ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only, the audio sampling rate in samples per second.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int sample_rate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio only, the audio channel layout
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVChannelLayout ch_layout;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Video only, the YUV colorspace and range.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace color_space;
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
} AVBufferSrcParameters;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new AVBufferSrcParameters instance. It should be freed by the
|
||||
* caller with av_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferSrcParameters *av_buffersrc_parameters_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize the buffersrc or abuffersrc filter with the provided parameters.
|
||||
* This function may be called multiple times, the later calls override the
|
||||
* previous ones. Some of the parameters may also be set through AVOptions, then
|
||||
* whatever method is used last takes precedence.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an instance of the buffersrc or abuffersrc filter
|
||||
* @param param the stream parameters. The frames later passed to this filter
|
||||
* must conform to those parameters. All the allocated fields in
|
||||
* param remain owned by the caller, libavfilter will make internal
|
||||
* copies or references when necessary.
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffersrc_parameters_set(AVFilterContext *ctx, AVBufferSrcParameters *param);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add a frame to the buffer source.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an instance of the buffersrc filter
|
||||
* @param frame frame to be added. If the frame is reference counted, this
|
||||
* function will make a new reference to it. Otherwise the frame data will be
|
||||
* copied.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is equivalent to av_buffersrc_add_frame_flags() with the
|
||||
* AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_KEEP_REF flag.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_buffersrc_write_frame(AVFilterContext *ctx, const AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add a frame to the buffer source.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an instance of the buffersrc filter
|
||||
* @param frame frame to be added. If the frame is reference counted, this
|
||||
* function will take ownership of the reference(s) and reset the frame.
|
||||
* Otherwise the frame data will be copied. If this function returns an error,
|
||||
* the input frame is not touched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the difference between this function and av_buffersrc_write_frame() is
|
||||
* that av_buffersrc_write_frame() creates a new reference to the input frame,
|
||||
* while this function takes ownership of the reference passed to it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is equivalent to av_buffersrc_add_frame_flags() without the
|
||||
* AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_KEEP_REF flag.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_buffersrc_add_frame(AVFilterContext *ctx, AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add a frame to the buffer source.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* By default, if the frame is reference-counted, this function will take
|
||||
* ownership of the reference(s) and reset the frame. This can be controlled
|
||||
* using the flags.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this function returns an error, the input frame is not touched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buffer_src pointer to a buffer source context
|
||||
* @param frame a frame, or NULL to mark EOF
|
||||
* @param flags a combination of AV_BUFFERSRC_FLAG_*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative AVERROR code
|
||||
* in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_buffersrc_add_frame_flags(AVFilterContext *buffer_src,
|
||||
AVFrame *frame, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Close the buffer source after EOF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is similar to passing NULL to av_buffersrc_add_frame_flags()
|
||||
* except it takes the timestamp of the EOF, i.e. the timestamp of the end
|
||||
* of the last frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffersrc_close(AVFilterContext *ctx, int64_t pts, unsigned flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFILTER_BUFFERSRC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Version macros.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFILTER_VERSION_H
|
||||
#define AVFILTER_VERSION_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi
|
||||
* Libavfilter version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MINOR 1
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MICRO 100
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_INT AV_VERSION_INT(LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_VERSION AV_VERSION(LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_BUILD LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_INT
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_IDENT "Lavfi" AV_STRINGIFY(LIBAVFILTER_VERSION)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFILTER_VERSION_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Version macros.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
#define AVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavfi
|
||||
* Libavfilter version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR 10
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* FF_API_* defines may be placed below to indicate public API that will be
|
||||
* dropped at a future version bump. The defines themselves are not part of
|
||||
* the public API and may change, break or disappear at any time.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_API_LINK_PUBLIC (LIBAVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR < 11)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFILTER_VERSION_MAJOR_H */
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -0,0 +1,831 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2001 Fabrice Bellard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef AVFORMAT_AVIO_H
|
||||
#define AVFORMAT_AVIO_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavf_io
|
||||
* Buffered I/O operations
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/dict.h"
|
||||
#include "libavutil/log.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavformat/version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seeking works like for a local file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVIO_SEEKABLE_NORMAL (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seeking by timestamp with avio_seek_time() is possible.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVIO_SEEKABLE_TIME (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callback for checking whether to abort blocking functions.
|
||||
* AVERROR_EXIT is returned in this case by the interrupted
|
||||
* function. During blocking operations, callback is called with
|
||||
* opaque as parameter. If the callback returns 1, the
|
||||
* blocking operation will be aborted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* No members can be added to this struct without a major bump, if
|
||||
* new elements have been added after this struct in AVFormatContext
|
||||
* or AVIOContext.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIOInterruptCB {
|
||||
int (*callback)(void*);
|
||||
void *opaque;
|
||||
} AVIOInterruptCB;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Directory entry types.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIODirEntryType {
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_UNKNOWN,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_BLOCK_DEVICE,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_CHARACTER_DEVICE,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_DIRECTORY,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_NAMED_PIPE,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_SYMBOLIC_LINK,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_SOCKET,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_FILE,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_SERVER,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_SHARE,
|
||||
AVIO_ENTRY_WORKGROUP,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Describes single entry of the directory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Only name and type fields are guaranteed be set.
|
||||
* Rest of fields are protocol or/and platform dependent and might be unknown.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIODirEntry {
|
||||
char *name; /**< Filename */
|
||||
int type; /**< Type of the entry */
|
||||
int utf8; /**< Set to 1 when name is encoded with UTF-8, 0 otherwise.
|
||||
Name can be encoded with UTF-8 even though 0 is set. */
|
||||
int64_t size; /**< File size in bytes, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t modification_timestamp; /**< Time of last modification in microseconds since unix
|
||||
epoch, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t access_timestamp; /**< Time of last access in microseconds since unix epoch,
|
||||
-1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t status_change_timestamp; /**< Time of last status change in microseconds since unix
|
||||
epoch, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t user_id; /**< User ID of owner, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t group_id; /**< Group ID of owner, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
int64_t filemode; /**< Unix file mode, -1 if unknown. */
|
||||
} AVIODirEntry;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVIODirContext AVIODirContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Different data types that can be returned via the AVIO
|
||||
* write_data_type callback.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIODataMarkerType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Header data; this needs to be present for the stream to be decodeable.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_HEADER,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A point in the output bytestream where a decoder can start decoding
|
||||
* (i.e. a keyframe). A demuxer/decoder given the data flagged with
|
||||
* AVIO_DATA_MARKER_HEADER, followed by any AVIO_DATA_MARKER_SYNC_POINT,
|
||||
* should give decodeable results.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_SYNC_POINT,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A point in the output bytestream where a demuxer can start parsing
|
||||
* (for non self synchronizing bytestream formats). That is, any
|
||||
* non-keyframe packet start point.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_BOUNDARY_POINT,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This is any, unlabelled data. It can either be a muxer not marking
|
||||
* any positions at all, it can be an actual boundary/sync point
|
||||
* that the muxer chooses not to mark, or a later part of a packet/fragment
|
||||
* that is cut into multiple write callbacks due to limited IO buffer size.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_UNKNOWN,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Trailer data, which doesn't contain actual content, but only for
|
||||
* finalizing the output file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_TRAILER,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A point in the output bytestream where the underlying AVIOContext might
|
||||
* flush the buffer depending on latency or buffering requirements. Typically
|
||||
* means the end of a packet.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIO_DATA_MARKER_FLUSH_POINT,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Bytestream IO Context.
|
||||
* New public fields can be added with minor version bumps.
|
||||
* Removal, reordering and changes to existing public fields require
|
||||
* a major version bump.
|
||||
* sizeof(AVIOContext) must not be used outside libav*.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note None of the function pointers in AVIOContext should be called
|
||||
* directly, they should only be set by the client application
|
||||
* when implementing custom I/O. Normally these are set to the
|
||||
* function pointers specified in avio_alloc_context()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIOContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A class for private options.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this AVIOContext is created by avio_open2(), av_class is set and
|
||||
* passes the options down to protocols.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this AVIOContext is manually allocated, then av_class may be set by
|
||||
* the caller.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* warning -- this field can be NULL, be sure to not pass this AVIOContext
|
||||
* to any av_opt_* functions in that case.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The following shows the relationship between buffer, buf_ptr,
|
||||
* buf_ptr_max, buf_end, buf_size, and pos, when reading and when writing
|
||||
* (since AVIOContext is used for both):
|
||||
*
|
||||
**********************************************************************************
|
||||
* READING
|
||||
**********************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* | buffer_size |
|
||||
* |---------------------------------------|
|
||||
* | |
|
||||
*
|
||||
* buffer buf_ptr buf_end
|
||||
* +---------------+-----------------------+
|
||||
* |/ / / / / / / /|/ / / / / / /| |
|
||||
* read buffer: |/ / consumed / | to be read /| |
|
||||
* |/ / / / / / / /|/ / / / / / /| |
|
||||
* +---------------+-----------------------+
|
||||
*
|
||||
* pos
|
||||
* +-------------------------------------------+-----------------+
|
||||
* input file: | | |
|
||||
* +-------------------------------------------+-----------------+
|
||||
*
|
||||
*
|
||||
**********************************************************************************
|
||||
* WRITING
|
||||
**********************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* | buffer_size |
|
||||
* |--------------------------------------|
|
||||
* | |
|
||||
*
|
||||
* buf_ptr_max
|
||||
* buffer (buf_ptr) buf_end
|
||||
* +-----------------------+--------------+
|
||||
* |/ / / / / / / / / / / /| |
|
||||
* write buffer: | / / to be flushed / / | |
|
||||
* |/ / / / / / / / / / / /| |
|
||||
* +-----------------------+--------------+
|
||||
* buf_ptr can be in this
|
||||
* due to a backward seek
|
||||
*
|
||||
* pos
|
||||
* +-------------+----------------------------------------------+
|
||||
* output file: | | |
|
||||
* +-------------+----------------------------------------------+
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned char *buffer; /**< Start of the buffer. */
|
||||
int buffer_size; /**< Maximum buffer size */
|
||||
unsigned char *buf_ptr; /**< Current position in the buffer */
|
||||
unsigned char *buf_end; /**< End of the data, may be less than
|
||||
buffer+buffer_size if the read function returned
|
||||
less data than requested, e.g. for streams where
|
||||
no more data has been received yet. */
|
||||
void *opaque; /**< A private pointer, passed to the read/write/seek/...
|
||||
functions. */
|
||||
int (*read_packet)(void *opaque, uint8_t *buf, int buf_size);
|
||||
int (*write_packet)(void *opaque, const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size);
|
||||
int64_t (*seek)(void *opaque, int64_t offset, int whence);
|
||||
int64_t pos; /**< position in the file of the current buffer */
|
||||
int eof_reached; /**< true if was unable to read due to error or eof */
|
||||
int error; /**< contains the error code or 0 if no error happened */
|
||||
int write_flag; /**< true if open for writing */
|
||||
int max_packet_size;
|
||||
int min_packet_size; /**< Try to buffer at least this amount of data
|
||||
before flushing it. */
|
||||
unsigned long checksum;
|
||||
unsigned char *checksum_ptr;
|
||||
unsigned long (*update_checksum)(unsigned long checksum, const uint8_t *buf, unsigned int size);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pause or resume playback for network streaming protocols - e.g. MMS.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int (*read_pause)(void *opaque, int pause);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seek to a given timestamp in stream with the specified stream_index.
|
||||
* Needed for some network streaming protocols which don't support seeking
|
||||
* to byte position.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t (*read_seek)(void *opaque, int stream_index,
|
||||
int64_t timestamp, int flags);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A combination of AVIO_SEEKABLE_ flags or 0 when the stream is not seekable.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int seekable;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* avio_read and avio_write should if possible be satisfied directly
|
||||
* instead of going through a buffer, and avio_seek will always
|
||||
* call the underlying seek function directly.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int direct;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ',' separated list of allowed protocols.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *protocol_whitelist;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ',' separated list of disallowed protocols.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *protocol_blacklist;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A callback that is used instead of write_packet.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int (*write_data_type)(void *opaque, const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size,
|
||||
enum AVIODataMarkerType type, int64_t time);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If set, don't call write_data_type separately for AVIO_DATA_MARKER_BOUNDARY_POINT,
|
||||
* but ignore them and treat them as AVIO_DATA_MARKER_UNKNOWN (to avoid needlessly
|
||||
* small chunks of data returned from the callback).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int ignore_boundary_point;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Maximum reached position before a backward seek in the write buffer,
|
||||
* used keeping track of already written data for a later flush.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned char *buf_ptr_max;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read-only statistic of bytes read for this AVIOContext.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t bytes_read;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read-only statistic of bytes written for this AVIOContext.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t bytes_written;
|
||||
} AVIOContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the name of the protocol that will handle the passed URL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* NULL is returned if no protocol could be found for the given URL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Name of the protocol or NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avio_find_protocol_name(const char *url);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return AVIO_FLAG_* access flags corresponding to the access permissions
|
||||
* of the resource in url, or a negative value corresponding to an
|
||||
* AVERROR code in case of failure. The returned access flags are
|
||||
* masked by the value in flags.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This function is intrinsically unsafe, in the sense that the
|
||||
* checked resource may change its existence or permission status from
|
||||
* one call to another. Thus you should not trust the returned value,
|
||||
* unless you are sure that no other processes are accessing the
|
||||
* checked resource.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_check(const char *url, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Open directory for reading.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s directory read context. Pointer to a NULL pointer must be passed.
|
||||
* @param url directory to be listed.
|
||||
* @param options A dictionary filled with protocol-private options. On return
|
||||
* this parameter will be destroyed and replaced with a dictionary
|
||||
* containing options that were not found. May be NULL.
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success or negative on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_open_dir(AVIODirContext **s, const char *url, AVDictionary **options);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get next directory entry.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Returned entry must be freed with avio_free_directory_entry(). In particular
|
||||
* it may outlive AVIODirContext.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s directory read context.
|
||||
* @param[out] next next entry or NULL when no more entries.
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success or negative on error. End of list is not considered an
|
||||
* error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_read_dir(AVIODirContext *s, AVIODirEntry **next);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Close directory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note Entries created using avio_read_dir() are not deleted and must be
|
||||
* freeded with avio_free_directory_entry().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s directory read context.
|
||||
* @return >=0 on success or negative on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_close_dir(AVIODirContext **s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free entry allocated by avio_read_dir().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param entry entry to be freed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avio_free_directory_entry(AVIODirEntry **entry);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize an AVIOContext for buffered I/O. It must be later
|
||||
* freed with avio_context_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buffer Memory block for input/output operations via AVIOContext.
|
||||
* The buffer must be allocated with av_malloc() and friends.
|
||||
* It may be freed and replaced with a new buffer by libavformat.
|
||||
* AVIOContext.buffer holds the buffer currently in use,
|
||||
* which must be later freed with av_free().
|
||||
* @param buffer_size The buffer size is very important for performance.
|
||||
* For protocols with fixed blocksize it should be set to this blocksize.
|
||||
* For others a typical size is a cache page, e.g. 4kb.
|
||||
* @param write_flag Set to 1 if the buffer should be writable, 0 otherwise.
|
||||
* @param opaque An opaque pointer to user-specific data.
|
||||
* @param read_packet A function for refilling the buffer, may be NULL.
|
||||
* For stream protocols, must never return 0 but rather
|
||||
* a proper AVERROR code.
|
||||
* @param write_packet A function for writing the buffer contents, may be NULL.
|
||||
* The function may not change the input buffers content.
|
||||
* @param seek A function for seeking to specified byte position, may be NULL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Allocated AVIOContext or NULL on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIOContext *avio_alloc_context(
|
||||
unsigned char *buffer,
|
||||
int buffer_size,
|
||||
int write_flag,
|
||||
void *opaque,
|
||||
int (*read_packet)(void *opaque, uint8_t *buf, int buf_size),
|
||||
int (*write_packet)(void *opaque, const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size),
|
||||
int64_t (*seek)(void *opaque, int64_t offset, int whence));
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free the supplied IO context and everything associated with it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s Double pointer to the IO context. This function will write NULL
|
||||
* into s.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avio_context_free(AVIOContext **s);
|
||||
|
||||
void avio_w8(AVIOContext *s, int b);
|
||||
void avio_write(AVIOContext *s, const unsigned char *buf, int size);
|
||||
void avio_wl64(AVIOContext *s, uint64_t val);
|
||||
void avio_wb64(AVIOContext *s, uint64_t val);
|
||||
void avio_wl32(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
void avio_wb32(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
void avio_wl24(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
void avio_wb24(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
void avio_wl16(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
void avio_wb16(AVIOContext *s, unsigned int val);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write a NULL-terminated string.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_put_str(AVIOContext *s, const char *str);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an UTF-8 string to UTF-16LE and write it.
|
||||
* @param s the AVIOContext
|
||||
* @param str NULL-terminated UTF-8 string
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_put_str16le(AVIOContext *s, const char *str);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an UTF-8 string to UTF-16BE and write it.
|
||||
* @param s the AVIOContext
|
||||
* @param str NULL-terminated UTF-8 string
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_put_str16be(AVIOContext *s, const char *str);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mark the written bytestream as a specific type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Zero-length ranges are omitted from the output.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s the AVIOContext
|
||||
* @param time the stream time the current bytestream pos corresponds to
|
||||
* (in AV_TIME_BASE units), or AV_NOPTS_VALUE if unknown or not
|
||||
* applicable
|
||||
* @param type the kind of data written starting at the current pos
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avio_write_marker(AVIOContext *s, int64_t time, enum AVIODataMarkerType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ORing this as the "whence" parameter to a seek function causes it to
|
||||
* return the filesize without seeking anywhere. Supporting this is optional.
|
||||
* If it is not supported then the seek function will return <0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVSEEK_SIZE 0x10000
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Passing this flag as the "whence" parameter to a seek function causes it to
|
||||
* seek by any means (like reopening and linear reading) or other normally unreasonable
|
||||
* means that can be extremely slow.
|
||||
* This may be ignored by the seek code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVSEEK_FORCE 0x20000
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* fseek() equivalent for AVIOContext.
|
||||
* @return new position or AVERROR.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t avio_seek(AVIOContext *s, int64_t offset, int whence);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Skip given number of bytes forward
|
||||
* @return new position or AVERROR.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t avio_skip(AVIOContext *s, int64_t offset);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ftell() equivalent for AVIOContext.
|
||||
* @return position or AVERROR.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int64_t avio_tell(AVIOContext *s)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return avio_seek(s, 0, SEEK_CUR);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the filesize.
|
||||
* @return filesize or AVERROR
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t avio_size(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Similar to feof() but also returns nonzero on read errors.
|
||||
* @return non zero if and only if at end of file or a read error happened when reading.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_feof(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Writes a formatted string to the context taking a va_list.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written, < 0 on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_vprintf(AVIOContext *s, const char *fmt, va_list ap);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Writes a formatted string to the context.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written, < 0 on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_printf(AVIOContext *s, const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(2, 3);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write a NULL terminated array of strings to the context.
|
||||
* Usually you don't need to use this function directly but its macro wrapper,
|
||||
* avio_print.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avio_print_string_array(AVIOContext *s, const char * const strings[]);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write strings (const char *) to the context.
|
||||
* This is a convenience macro around avio_print_string_array and it
|
||||
* automatically creates the string array from the variable argument list.
|
||||
* For simple string concatenations this function is more performant than using
|
||||
* avio_printf since it does not need a temporary buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define avio_print(s, ...) \
|
||||
avio_print_string_array(s, (const char*[]){__VA_ARGS__, NULL})
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Force flushing of buffered data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For write streams, force the buffered data to be immediately written to the output,
|
||||
* without to wait to fill the internal buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For read streams, discard all currently buffered data, and advance the
|
||||
* reported file position to that of the underlying stream. This does not
|
||||
* read new data, and does not perform any seeks.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void avio_flush(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read size bytes from AVIOContext into buf.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes read or AVERROR
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_read(AVIOContext *s, unsigned char *buf, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read size bytes from AVIOContext into buf. Unlike avio_read(), this is allowed
|
||||
* to read fewer bytes than requested. The missing bytes can be read in the next
|
||||
* call. This always tries to read at least 1 byte.
|
||||
* Useful to reduce latency in certain cases.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes read or AVERROR
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_read_partial(AVIOContext *s, unsigned char *buf, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @name Functions for reading from AVIOContext
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note return 0 if EOF, so you cannot use it if EOF handling is
|
||||
* necessary
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_r8 (AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rl16(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rl24(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rl32(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
uint64_t avio_rl64(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rb16(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rb24(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
unsigned int avio_rb32(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
uint64_t avio_rb64(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read a string from pb into buf. The reading will terminate when either
|
||||
* a NULL character was encountered, maxlen bytes have been read, or nothing
|
||||
* more can be read from pb. The result is guaranteed to be NULL-terminated, it
|
||||
* will be truncated if buf is too small.
|
||||
* Note that the string is not interpreted or validated in any way, it
|
||||
* might get truncated in the middle of a sequence for multi-byte encodings.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return number of bytes read (is always <= maxlen).
|
||||
* If reading ends on EOF or error, the return value will be one more than
|
||||
* bytes actually read.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_get_str(AVIOContext *pb, int maxlen, char *buf, int buflen);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read a UTF-16 string from pb and convert it to UTF-8.
|
||||
* The reading will terminate when either a null or invalid character was
|
||||
* encountered or maxlen bytes have been read.
|
||||
* @return number of bytes read (is always <= maxlen)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_get_str16le(AVIOContext *pb, int maxlen, char *buf, int buflen);
|
||||
int avio_get_str16be(AVIOContext *pb, int maxlen, char *buf, int buflen);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @name URL open modes
|
||||
* The flags argument to avio_open must be one of the following
|
||||
* constants, optionally ORed with other flags.
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVIO_FLAG_READ 1 /**< read-only */
|
||||
#define AVIO_FLAG_WRITE 2 /**< write-only */
|
||||
#define AVIO_FLAG_READ_WRITE (AVIO_FLAG_READ|AVIO_FLAG_WRITE) /**< read-write pseudo flag */
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Use non-blocking mode.
|
||||
* If this flag is set, operations on the context will return
|
||||
* AVERROR(EAGAIN) if they can not be performed immediately.
|
||||
* If this flag is not set, operations on the context will never return
|
||||
* AVERROR(EAGAIN).
|
||||
* Note that this flag does not affect the opening/connecting of the
|
||||
* context. Connecting a protocol will always block if necessary (e.g. on
|
||||
* network protocols) but never hang (e.g. on busy devices).
|
||||
* Warning: non-blocking protocols is work-in-progress; this flag may be
|
||||
* silently ignored.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVIO_FLAG_NONBLOCK 8
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Use direct mode.
|
||||
* avio_read and avio_write should if possible be satisfied directly
|
||||
* instead of going through a buffer, and avio_seek will always
|
||||
* call the underlying seek function directly.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVIO_FLAG_DIRECT 0x8000
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create and initialize a AVIOContext for accessing the
|
||||
* resource indicated by url.
|
||||
* @note When the resource indicated by url has been opened in
|
||||
* read+write mode, the AVIOContext can be used only for writing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s Used to return the pointer to the created AVIOContext.
|
||||
* In case of failure the pointed to value is set to NULL.
|
||||
* @param url resource to access
|
||||
* @param flags flags which control how the resource indicated by url
|
||||
* is to be opened
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative value corresponding to an
|
||||
* AVERROR code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_open(AVIOContext **s, const char *url, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create and initialize a AVIOContext for accessing the
|
||||
* resource indicated by url.
|
||||
* @note When the resource indicated by url has been opened in
|
||||
* read+write mode, the AVIOContext can be used only for writing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s Used to return the pointer to the created AVIOContext.
|
||||
* In case of failure the pointed to value is set to NULL.
|
||||
* @param url resource to access
|
||||
* @param flags flags which control how the resource indicated by url
|
||||
* is to be opened
|
||||
* @param int_cb an interrupt callback to be used at the protocols level
|
||||
* @param options A dictionary filled with protocol-private options. On return
|
||||
* this parameter will be destroyed and replaced with a dict containing options
|
||||
* that were not found. May be NULL.
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative value corresponding to an
|
||||
* AVERROR code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_open2(AVIOContext **s, const char *url, int flags,
|
||||
const AVIOInterruptCB *int_cb, AVDictionary **options);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Close the resource accessed by the AVIOContext s and free it.
|
||||
* This function can only be used if s was opened by avio_open().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The internal buffer is automatically flushed before closing the
|
||||
* resource.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, an AVERROR < 0 on error.
|
||||
* @see avio_closep
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_close(AVIOContext *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Close the resource accessed by the AVIOContext *s, free it
|
||||
* and set the pointer pointing to it to NULL.
|
||||
* This function can only be used if s was opened by avio_open().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The internal buffer is automatically flushed before closing the
|
||||
* resource.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, an AVERROR < 0 on error.
|
||||
* @see avio_close
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_closep(AVIOContext **s);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Open a write only memory stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s new IO context
|
||||
* @return zero if no error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_open_dyn_buf(AVIOContext **s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the written size and a pointer to the buffer.
|
||||
* The AVIOContext stream is left intact.
|
||||
* The buffer must NOT be freed.
|
||||
* No padding is added to the buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s IO context
|
||||
* @param pbuffer pointer to a byte buffer
|
||||
* @return the length of the byte buffer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_get_dyn_buf(AVIOContext *s, uint8_t **pbuffer);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the written size and a pointer to the buffer. The buffer
|
||||
* must be freed with av_free().
|
||||
* Padding of AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE is added to the buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s IO context
|
||||
* @param pbuffer pointer to a byte buffer
|
||||
* @return the length of the byte buffer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_close_dyn_buf(AVIOContext *s, uint8_t **pbuffer);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate through names of available protocols.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param opaque A private pointer representing current protocol.
|
||||
* It must be a pointer to NULL on first iteration and will
|
||||
* be updated by successive calls to avio_enum_protocols.
|
||||
* @param output If set to 1, iterate over output protocols,
|
||||
* otherwise over input protocols.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return A static string containing the name of current protocol or NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avio_enum_protocols(void **opaque, int output);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get AVClass by names of available protocols.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return A AVClass of input protocol name or NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *avio_protocol_get_class(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pause and resume playing - only meaningful if using a network streaming
|
||||
* protocol (e.g. MMS).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param h IO context from which to call the read_pause function pointer
|
||||
* @param pause 1 for pause, 0 for resume
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_pause(AVIOContext *h, int pause);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seek to a given timestamp relative to some component stream.
|
||||
* Only meaningful if using a network streaming protocol (e.g. MMS.).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param h IO context from which to call the seek function pointers
|
||||
* @param stream_index The stream index that the timestamp is relative to.
|
||||
* If stream_index is (-1) the timestamp should be in AV_TIME_BASE
|
||||
* units from the beginning of the presentation.
|
||||
* If a stream_index >= 0 is used and the protocol does not support
|
||||
* seeking based on component streams, the call will fail.
|
||||
* @param timestamp timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
|
||||
* or if there is no stream specified then in AV_TIME_BASE units.
|
||||
* @param flags Optional combination of AVSEEK_FLAG_BACKWARD, AVSEEK_FLAG_BYTE
|
||||
* and AVSEEK_FLAG_ANY. The protocol may silently ignore
|
||||
* AVSEEK_FLAG_BACKWARD and AVSEEK_FLAG_ANY, but AVSEEK_FLAG_BYTE will
|
||||
* fail if used and not supported.
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success
|
||||
* @see AVInputFormat::read_seek
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int64_t avio_seek_time(AVIOContext *h, int stream_index,
|
||||
int64_t timestamp, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Avoid a warning. The header can not be included because it breaks c++. */
|
||||
struct AVBPrint;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read contents of h into print buffer, up to max_size bytes, or up to EOF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 for success (max_size bytes read or EOF reached), negative error
|
||||
* code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_read_to_bprint(AVIOContext *h, struct AVBPrint *pb, size_t max_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Accept and allocate a client context on a server context.
|
||||
* @param s the server context
|
||||
* @param c the client context, must be unallocated
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success or a negative value corresponding
|
||||
* to an AVERROR on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_accept(AVIOContext *s, AVIOContext **c);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Perform one step of the protocol handshake to accept a new client.
|
||||
* This function must be called on a client returned by avio_accept() before
|
||||
* using it as a read/write context.
|
||||
* It is separate from avio_accept() because it may block.
|
||||
* A step of the handshake is defined by places where the application may
|
||||
* decide to change the proceedings.
|
||||
* For example, on a protocol with a request header and a reply header, each
|
||||
* one can constitute a step because the application may use the parameters
|
||||
* from the request to change parameters in the reply; or each individual
|
||||
* chunk of the request can constitute a step.
|
||||
* If the handshake is already finished, avio_handshake() does nothing and
|
||||
* returns 0 immediately.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param c the client context to perform the handshake on
|
||||
* @return 0 on a complete and successful handshake
|
||||
* > 0 if the handshake progressed, but is not complete
|
||||
* < 0 for an AVERROR code
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int avio_handshake(AVIOContext *c);
|
||||
#endif /* AVFORMAT_AVIO_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Version macros.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFORMAT_VERSION_H
|
||||
#define AVFORMAT_VERSION_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup libavf
|
||||
* Libavformat version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libavutil/version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version_major.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MINOR 1
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MICRO 100
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_INT AV_VERSION_INT(LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION AV_VERSION(LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MINOR, \
|
||||
LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MICRO)
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_BUILD LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_INT
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_IDENT "Lavf" AV_STRINGIFY(LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFORMAT_VERSION_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,53 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Version macros.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
#define AVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup libavf
|
||||
* Libavformat version macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
// Major bumping may affect Ticket5467, 5421, 5451(compatibility with Chromium)
|
||||
// Also please add any ticket numbers that you believe might be affected here
|
||||
#define LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR 61
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* FF_API_* defines may be placed below to indicate public API that will be
|
||||
* dropped at a future version bump. The defines themselves are not part of
|
||||
* the public API and may change, break or disappear at any time.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note, when bumping the major version it is recommended to manually
|
||||
* disable each FF_API_* in its own commit instead of disabling them all
|
||||
* at once through the bump. This improves the git bisect-ability of the change.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FF_API_COMPUTE_PKT_FIELDS2 (LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_LAVF_SHORTEST (LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_ALLOW_FLUSH (LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
#define FF_API_AVSTREAM_SIDE_DATA (LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_API_GET_DUR_ESTIMATE_METHOD (LIBAVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR < 62)
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_API_R_FRAME_RATE 1
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVFORMAT_VERSION_MAJOR_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Mans Rullgard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_adler32
|
||||
* Public header for Adler-32 hash function implementation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_ADLER32_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_ADLER32_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_adler32 Adler-32
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_hash
|
||||
* Adler-32 hash function implementation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef uint32_t AVAdler;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Calculate the Adler32 checksum of a buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Passing the return value to a subsequent av_adler32_update() call
|
||||
* allows the checksum of multiple buffers to be calculated as though
|
||||
* they were concatenated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param adler initial checksum value
|
||||
* @param buf pointer to input buffer
|
||||
* @param len size of input buffer
|
||||
* @return updated checksum
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVAdler av_adler32_update(AVAdler adler, const uint8_t *buf,
|
||||
size_t len) av_pure;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_ADLER32_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,69 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2007 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AES_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AES_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_aes AES
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern const int av_aes_size;
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVAES;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVAES context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVAES *av_aes_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVAES context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a The AVAES context
|
||||
* @param key Pointer to the key
|
||||
* @param key_bits 128, 192 or 256
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_aes_init(struct AVAES *a, const uint8_t *key, int key_bits, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a The AVAES context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param count number of 16 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param iv initialization vector for CBC mode, if NULL then ECB will be used
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_crypt(struct AVAES *a, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count, uint8_t *iv, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AES_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* AES-CTR cipher
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2015 Eran Kornblau <erankor at gmail dot com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AES_CTR_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AES_CTR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_aes_ctr AES-CTR
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define AES_CTR_KEY_SIZE (16)
|
||||
#define AES_CTR_IV_SIZE (8)
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVAESCTR;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVAESCTR context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVAESCTR *av_aes_ctr_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVAESCTR context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a The AVAESCTR context to initialize
|
||||
* @param key encryption key, must have a length of AES_CTR_KEY_SIZE
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_aes_ctr_init(struct AVAESCTR *a, const uint8_t *key);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Release an AVAESCTR context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a The AVAESCTR context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_free(struct AVAESCTR *a);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Process a buffer using a previously initialized context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a The AVAESCTR context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param size the size of src and dst
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_crypt(struct AVAESCTR *a, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the current iv
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const uint8_t* av_aes_ctr_get_iv(struct AVAESCTR *a);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Generate a random iv
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_set_random_iv(struct AVAESCTR *a);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Forcefully change the 8-byte iv
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_set_iv(struct AVAESCTR *a, const uint8_t* iv);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Forcefully change the "full" 16-byte iv, including the counter
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_set_full_iv(struct AVAESCTR *a, const uint8_t* iv);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Increment the top 64 bit of the iv (performed after each frame)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_aes_ctr_increment_iv(struct AVAESCTR *a);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AES_CTR_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2023 Jan Ekström <jeebjp@gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AMBIENT_VIEWING_ENVIRONMENT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AMBIENT_VIEWING_ENVIRONMENT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Ambient viewing environment metadata as defined by H.274. The values are
|
||||
* saved in AVRationals so that they keep their exactness, while allowing for
|
||||
* easy access to a double value with f.ex. av_q2d.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note sizeof(AVAmbientViewingEnvironment) is not part of the public ABI, and
|
||||
* it must be allocated using av_ambient_viewing_environment_alloc.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVAmbientViewingEnvironment {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Environmental illuminance of the ambient viewing environment in lux.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational ambient_illuminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Normalized x chromaticity coordinate of the environmental ambient light
|
||||
* in the nominal viewing environment according to the CIE 1931 definition
|
||||
* of x and y as specified in ISO/CIE 11664-1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational ambient_light_x;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Normalized y chromaticity coordinate of the environmental ambient light
|
||||
* in the nominal viewing environment according to the CIE 1931 definition
|
||||
* of x and y as specified in ISO/CIE 11664-1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational ambient_light_y;
|
||||
} AVAmbientViewingEnvironment;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVAmbientViewingEnvironment structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the newly allocated struct or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVAmbientViewingEnvironment *av_ambient_viewing_environment_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and add an AVAmbientViewingEnvironment structure to an existing
|
||||
* AVFrame as side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the newly allocated struct, or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVAmbientViewingEnvironment *av_ambient_viewing_environment_create_side_data(AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AMBIENT_VIEWING_ENVIRONMENT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,173 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Macro definitions for various function/variable attributes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __GNUC__
|
||||
# define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(x,y) (__GNUC__ > (x) || __GNUC__ == (x) && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= (y))
|
||||
# define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_MOST(x,y) (__GNUC__ < (x) || __GNUC__ == (x) && __GNUC_MINOR__ <= (y))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(x,y) 0
|
||||
# define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_MOST(x,y) 0
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __has_builtin
|
||||
# define AV_HAS_BUILTIN(x) __has_builtin(x)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_HAS_BUILTIN(x) 0
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_always_inline
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
|
||||
# define av_always_inline __attribute__((always_inline)) inline
|
||||
#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
|
||||
# define av_always_inline __forceinline
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_always_inline inline
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_extern_inline
|
||||
#if defined(__ICL) && __ICL >= 1210 || defined(__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__)
|
||||
# define av_extern_inline extern inline
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_extern_inline inline
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,4)
|
||||
# define av_warn_unused_result __attribute__((warn_unused_result))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
|
||||
# define av_noinline __attribute__((noinline))
|
||||
#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
|
||||
# define av_noinline __declspec(noinline)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_noinline
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_pure __attribute__((pure))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_pure
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(2,6) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_const __attribute__((const))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_const
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,3) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_cold __attribute__((cold))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_cold
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,1) && !defined(__llvm__)
|
||||
# define av_flatten __attribute__((flatten))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_flatten
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
|
||||
# define attribute_deprecated __attribute__((deprecated))
|
||||
#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
|
||||
# define attribute_deprecated __declspec(deprecated)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define attribute_deprecated
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Disable warnings about deprecated features
|
||||
* This is useful for sections of code kept for backward compatibility and
|
||||
* scheduled for removal.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,6) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) \
|
||||
_Pragma("GCC diagnostic push") \
|
||||
_Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wdeprecated-declarations\"") \
|
||||
code \
|
||||
_Pragma("GCC diagnostic pop")
|
||||
#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
|
||||
# define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) \
|
||||
__pragma(warning(push)) \
|
||||
__pragma(warning(disable : 4996)) \
|
||||
code; \
|
||||
__pragma(warning(pop))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) code
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_unused __attribute__((unused))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_unused
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mark a variable as used and prevent the compiler from optimizing it
|
||||
* away. This is useful for variables accessed only from inline
|
||||
* assembler without the compiler being aware.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_used __attribute__((used))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_used
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,3) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_alias __attribute__((may_alias))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_alias
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)) && !defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)
|
||||
# define av_uninit(x) x=x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_uninit(x) x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_builtin_constant_p __builtin_constant_p
|
||||
# define av_printf_format(fmtpos, attrpos) __attribute__((__format__(__printf__, fmtpos, attrpos)))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_builtin_constant_p(x) 0
|
||||
# define av_printf_format(fmtpos, attrpos)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(2,5) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
# define av_noreturn __attribute__((noreturn))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define av_noreturn
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,187 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Audio FIFO
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2012 Justin Ruggles <justin.ruggles@gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Audio FIFO Buffer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AUDIO_FIFO_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AUDIO_FIFO_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "samplefmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_audio
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_audiofifo Audio FIFO Buffer
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Context for an Audio FIFO Buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* - Operates at the sample level rather than the byte level.
|
||||
* - Supports multiple channels with either planar or packed sample format.
|
||||
* - Automatic reallocation when writing to a full buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVAudioFifo AVAudioFifo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to free
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_audio_fifo_free(AVAudioFifo *af);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param sample_fmt sample format
|
||||
* @param channels number of channels
|
||||
* @param nb_samples initial allocation size, in samples
|
||||
* @return newly allocated AVAudioFifo, or NULL on error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVAudioFifo *av_audio_fifo_alloc(enum AVSampleFormat sample_fmt, int channels,
|
||||
int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reallocate an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to reallocate
|
||||
* @param nb_samples new allocation size, in samples
|
||||
* @return 0 if OK, or negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_realloc(AVAudioFifo *af, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write data to an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The AVAudioFifo will be reallocated automatically if the available space
|
||||
* is less than nb_samples.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see enum AVSampleFormat
|
||||
* The documentation for AVSampleFormat describes the data layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to write to
|
||||
* @param data audio data plane pointers
|
||||
* @param nb_samples number of samples to write
|
||||
* @return number of samples actually written, or negative AVERROR
|
||||
* code on failure. If successful, the number of samples
|
||||
* actually written will always be nb_samples.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_write(AVAudioFifo *af, void * const *data, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Peek data from an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see enum AVSampleFormat
|
||||
* The documentation for AVSampleFormat describes the data layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to read from
|
||||
* @param data audio data plane pointers
|
||||
* @param nb_samples number of samples to peek
|
||||
* @return number of samples actually peek, or negative AVERROR code
|
||||
* on failure. The number of samples actually peek will not
|
||||
* be greater than nb_samples, and will only be less than
|
||||
* nb_samples if av_audio_fifo_size is less than nb_samples.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_peek(const AVAudioFifo *af, void * const *data, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Peek data from an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see enum AVSampleFormat
|
||||
* The documentation for AVSampleFormat describes the data layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to read from
|
||||
* @param data audio data plane pointers
|
||||
* @param nb_samples number of samples to peek
|
||||
* @param offset offset from current read position
|
||||
* @return number of samples actually peek, or negative AVERROR code
|
||||
* on failure. The number of samples actually peek will not
|
||||
* be greater than nb_samples, and will only be less than
|
||||
* nb_samples if av_audio_fifo_size is less than nb_samples.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_peek_at(const AVAudioFifo *af, void * const *data,
|
||||
int nb_samples, int offset);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read data from an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see enum AVSampleFormat
|
||||
* The documentation for AVSampleFormat describes the data layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to read from
|
||||
* @param data audio data plane pointers
|
||||
* @param nb_samples number of samples to read
|
||||
* @return number of samples actually read, or negative AVERROR code
|
||||
* on failure. The number of samples actually read will not
|
||||
* be greater than nb_samples, and will only be less than
|
||||
* nb_samples if av_audio_fifo_size is less than nb_samples.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_read(AVAudioFifo *af, void * const *data, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Drain data from an AVAudioFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Removes the data without reading it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to drain
|
||||
* @param nb_samples number of samples to drain
|
||||
* @return 0 if OK, or negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_drain(AVAudioFifo *af, int nb_samples);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reset the AVAudioFifo buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This empties all data in the buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af AVAudioFifo to reset
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_audio_fifo_reset(AVAudioFifo *af);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the current number of samples in the AVAudioFifo available for reading.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af the AVAudioFifo to query
|
||||
* @return number of samples available for reading
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_size(AVAudioFifo *af);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the current number of samples in the AVAudioFifo available for writing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param af the AVAudioFifo to query
|
||||
* @return number of samples available for writing
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_audio_fifo_space(AVAudioFifo *af);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AUDIO_FIFO_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2010 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* simple assert() macros that are a bit more flexible than ISO C assert().
|
||||
* @author Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AVASSERT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AVASSERT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "log.h"
|
||||
#include "macros.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* assert() equivalent, that is always enabled.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define av_assert0(cond) do { \
|
||||
if (!(cond)) { \
|
||||
av_log(NULL, AV_LOG_PANIC, "Assertion %s failed at %s:%d\n", \
|
||||
AV_STRINGIFY(cond), __FILE__, __LINE__); \
|
||||
abort(); \
|
||||
} \
|
||||
} while (0)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* assert() equivalent, that does not lie in speed critical code.
|
||||
* These asserts() thus can be enabled without fearing speed loss.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL > 0
|
||||
#define av_assert1(cond) av_assert0(cond)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define av_assert1(cond) ((void)0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* assert() equivalent, that does lie in speed critical code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL > 1
|
||||
#define av_assert2(cond) av_assert0(cond)
|
||||
#define av_assert2_fpu() av_assert0_fpu()
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define av_assert2(cond) ((void)0)
|
||||
#define av_assert2_fpu() ((void)0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Assert that floating point operations can be executed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This will av_assert0() that the cpu is not in MMX state on X86
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_assert0_fpu(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AVASSERT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
|
|||
/* Generated by ffmpeg configure */
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H
|
||||
#define AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN 0
|
||||
#define AV_HAVE_FAST_UNALIGNED 1
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,428 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Mans Rullgard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AVSTRING_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AVSTRING_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_string
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return non-zero if pfx is a prefix of str. If it is, *ptr is set to
|
||||
* the address of the first character in str after the prefix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param str input string
|
||||
* @param pfx prefix to test
|
||||
* @param ptr updated if the prefix is matched inside str
|
||||
* @return non-zero if the prefix matches, zero otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_strstart(const char *str, const char *pfx, const char **ptr);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return non-zero if pfx is a prefix of str independent of case. If
|
||||
* it is, *ptr is set to the address of the first character in str
|
||||
* after the prefix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param str input string
|
||||
* @param pfx prefix to test
|
||||
* @param ptr updated if the prefix is matched inside str
|
||||
* @return non-zero if the prefix matches, zero otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_stristart(const char *str, const char *pfx, const char **ptr);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locate the first case-independent occurrence in the string haystack
|
||||
* of the string needle. A zero-length string needle is considered to
|
||||
* match at the start of haystack.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is a case-insensitive version of the standard strstr().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param haystack string to search in
|
||||
* @param needle string to search for
|
||||
* @return pointer to the located match within haystack
|
||||
* or a null pointer if no match
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_stristr(const char *haystack, const char *needle);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locate the first occurrence of the string needle in the string haystack
|
||||
* where not more than hay_length characters are searched. A zero-length
|
||||
* string needle is considered to match at the start of haystack.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is a length-limited version of the standard strstr().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param haystack string to search in
|
||||
* @param needle string to search for
|
||||
* @param hay_length length of string to search in
|
||||
* @return pointer to the located match within haystack
|
||||
* or a null pointer if no match
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_strnstr(const char *haystack, const char *needle, size_t hay_length);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy the string src to dst, but no more than size - 1 bytes, and
|
||||
* null-terminate dst.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is the same as BSD strlcpy().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst destination buffer
|
||||
* @param src source string
|
||||
* @param size size of destination buffer
|
||||
* @return the length of src
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning since the return value is the length of src, src absolutely
|
||||
* _must_ be a properly 0-terminated string, otherwise this will read beyond
|
||||
* the end of the buffer and possibly crash.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append the string src to the string dst, but to a total length of
|
||||
* no more than size - 1 bytes, and null-terminate dst.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is similar to BSD strlcat(), but differs when
|
||||
* size <= strlen(dst).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst destination buffer
|
||||
* @param src source string
|
||||
* @param size size of destination buffer
|
||||
* @return the total length of src and dst
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning since the return value use the length of src and dst, these
|
||||
* absolutely _must_ be a properly 0-terminated strings, otherwise this
|
||||
* will read beyond the end of the buffer and possibly crash.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_strlcat(char *dst, const char *src, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append output to a string, according to a format. Never write out of
|
||||
* the destination buffer, and always put a terminating 0 within
|
||||
* the buffer.
|
||||
* @param dst destination buffer (string to which the output is
|
||||
* appended)
|
||||
* @param size total size of the destination buffer
|
||||
* @param fmt printf-compatible format string, specifying how the
|
||||
* following parameters are used
|
||||
* @return the length of the string that would have been generated
|
||||
* if enough space had been available
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_strlcatf(char *dst, size_t size, const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(3, 4);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the count of continuous non zero chars starting from the beginning.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s the string whose length to count
|
||||
* @param len maximum number of characters to check in the string, that
|
||||
* is the maximum value which is returned by the function
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline size_t av_strnlen(const char *s, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < len && s[i]; i++)
|
||||
;
|
||||
return i;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Print arguments following specified format into a large enough auto
|
||||
* allocated buffer. It is similar to GNU asprintf().
|
||||
* @param fmt printf-compatible format string, specifying how the
|
||||
* following parameters are used.
|
||||
* @return the allocated string
|
||||
* @note You have to free the string yourself with av_free().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_asprintf(const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(1, 2);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Unescape the given string until a non escaped terminating char,
|
||||
* and return the token corresponding to the unescaped string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The normal \ and ' escaping is supported. Leading and trailing
|
||||
* whitespaces are removed, unless they are escaped with '\' or are
|
||||
* enclosed between ''.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf the buffer to parse, buf will be updated to point to the
|
||||
* terminating char
|
||||
* @param term a 0-terminated list of terminating chars
|
||||
* @return the malloced unescaped string, which must be av_freed by
|
||||
* the user, NULL in case of allocation failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_get_token(const char **buf, const char *term);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Split the string into several tokens which can be accessed by
|
||||
* successive calls to av_strtok().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A token is defined as a sequence of characters not belonging to the
|
||||
* set specified in delim.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* On the first call to av_strtok(), s should point to the string to
|
||||
* parse, and the value of saveptr is ignored. In subsequent calls, s
|
||||
* should be NULL, and saveptr should be unchanged since the previous
|
||||
* call.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is similar to strtok_r() defined in POSIX.1.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param s the string to parse, may be NULL
|
||||
* @param delim 0-terminated list of token delimiters, must be non-NULL
|
||||
* @param saveptr user-provided pointer which points to stored
|
||||
* information necessary for av_strtok() to continue scanning the same
|
||||
* string. saveptr is updated to point to the next character after the
|
||||
* first delimiter found, or to NULL if the string was terminated
|
||||
* @return the found token, or NULL when no token is found
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_strtok(char *s, const char *delim, char **saveptr);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII isdigit.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_isdigit(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return c >= '0' && c <= '9';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII isgraph.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_isgraph(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return c > 32 && c < 127;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII isspace.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_isspace(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return c == ' ' || c == '\f' || c == '\n' || c == '\r' || c == '\t' ||
|
||||
c == '\v';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII characters to uppercase.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_toupper(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z')
|
||||
c ^= 0x20;
|
||||
return c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII characters to lowercase.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_tolower(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (c >= 'A' && c <= 'Z')
|
||||
c ^= 0x20;
|
||||
return c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent conversion of ASCII isxdigit.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline av_const int av_isxdigit(int c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
c = av_tolower(c);
|
||||
return av_isdigit(c) || (c >= 'a' && c <= 'f');
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent case-insensitive compare.
|
||||
* @note This means only ASCII-range characters are case-insensitive
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_strcasecmp(const char *a, const char *b);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent case-insensitive compare.
|
||||
* @note This means only ASCII-range characters are case-insensitive
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_strncasecmp(const char *a, const char *b, size_t n);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locale-independent strings replace.
|
||||
* @note This means only ASCII-range characters are replaced.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_strireplace(const char *str, const char *from, const char *to);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Thread safe basename.
|
||||
* @param path the string to parse, on DOS both \ and / are considered separators.
|
||||
* @return pointer to the basename substring.
|
||||
* If path does not contain a slash, the function returns a copy of path.
|
||||
* If path is a NULL pointer or points to an empty string, a pointer
|
||||
* to a string "." is returned.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_basename(const char *path);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Thread safe dirname.
|
||||
* @param path the string to parse, on DOS both \ and / are considered separators.
|
||||
* @return A pointer to a string that's the parent directory of path.
|
||||
* If path is a NULL pointer or points to an empty string, a pointer
|
||||
* to a string "." is returned.
|
||||
* @note the function may modify the contents of the path, so copies should be passed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_dirname(char *path);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Match instances of a name in a comma-separated list of names.
|
||||
* List entries are checked from the start to the end of the names list,
|
||||
* the first match ends further processing. If an entry prefixed with '-'
|
||||
* matches, then 0 is returned. The "ALL" list entry is considered to
|
||||
* match all names.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param name Name to look for.
|
||||
* @param names List of names.
|
||||
* @return 1 on match, 0 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_match_name(const char *name, const char *names);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append path component to the existing path.
|
||||
* Path separator '/' is placed between when needed.
|
||||
* Resulting string have to be freed with av_free().
|
||||
* @param path base path
|
||||
* @param component component to be appended
|
||||
* @return new path or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_append_path_component(const char *path, const char *component);
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVEscapeMode {
|
||||
AV_ESCAPE_MODE_AUTO, ///< Use auto-selected escaping mode.
|
||||
AV_ESCAPE_MODE_BACKSLASH, ///< Use backslash escaping.
|
||||
AV_ESCAPE_MODE_QUOTE, ///< Use single-quote escaping.
|
||||
AV_ESCAPE_MODE_XML, ///< Use XML non-markup character data escaping.
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Consider spaces special and escape them even in the middle of the
|
||||
* string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is equivalent to adding the whitespace characters to the special
|
||||
* characters lists, except it is guaranteed to use the exact same list
|
||||
* of whitespace characters as the rest of libavutil.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_WHITESPACE (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Escape only specified special characters.
|
||||
* Without this flag, escape also any characters that may be considered
|
||||
* special by av_get_token(), such as the single quote.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_STRICT (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Within AV_ESCAPE_MODE_XML, additionally escape single quotes for single
|
||||
* quoted attributes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_XML_SINGLE_QUOTES (1 << 2)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Within AV_ESCAPE_MODE_XML, additionally escape double quotes for double
|
||||
* quoted attributes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_XML_DOUBLE_QUOTES (1 << 3)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Escape string in src, and put the escaped string in an allocated
|
||||
* string in *dst, which must be freed with av_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst pointer where an allocated string is put
|
||||
* @param src string to escape, must be non-NULL
|
||||
* @param special_chars string containing the special characters which
|
||||
* need to be escaped, can be NULL
|
||||
* @param mode escape mode to employ, see AV_ESCAPE_MODE_* macros.
|
||||
* Any unknown value for mode will be considered equivalent to
|
||||
* AV_ESCAPE_MODE_BACKSLASH, but this behaviour can change without
|
||||
* notice.
|
||||
* @param flags flags which control how to escape, see AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_ macros
|
||||
* @return the length of the allocated string, or a negative error code in case of error
|
||||
* @see av_bprint_escape()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_escape(char **dst, const char *src, const char *special_chars,
|
||||
enum AVEscapeMode mode, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_INVALID_BIG_CODES 1 ///< accept codepoints over 0x10FFFF
|
||||
#define AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_NON_CHARACTERS 2 ///< accept non-characters - 0xFFFE and 0xFFFF
|
||||
#define AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_SURROGATES 4 ///< accept UTF-16 surrogates codes
|
||||
#define AV_UTF8_FLAG_EXCLUDE_XML_INVALID_CONTROL_CODES 8 ///< exclude control codes not accepted by XML
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_ALL \
|
||||
AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_INVALID_BIG_CODES|AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_NON_CHARACTERS|AV_UTF8_FLAG_ACCEPT_SURROGATES
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read and decode a single UTF-8 code point (character) from the
|
||||
* buffer in *buf, and update *buf to point to the next byte to
|
||||
* decode.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In case of an invalid byte sequence, the pointer will be updated to
|
||||
* the next byte after the invalid sequence and the function will
|
||||
* return an error code.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Depending on the specified flags, the function will also fail in
|
||||
* case the decoded code point does not belong to a valid range.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note For speed-relevant code a carefully implemented use of
|
||||
* GET_UTF8() may be preferred.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param codep pointer used to return the parsed code in case of success.
|
||||
* The value in *codep is set even in case the range check fails.
|
||||
* @param bufp pointer to the address the first byte of the sequence
|
||||
* to decode, updated by the function to point to the
|
||||
* byte next after the decoded sequence
|
||||
* @param buf_end pointer to the end of the buffer, points to the next
|
||||
* byte past the last in the buffer. This is used to
|
||||
* avoid buffer overreads (in case of an unfinished
|
||||
* UTF-8 sequence towards the end of the buffer).
|
||||
* @param flags a collection of AV_UTF8_FLAG_* flags
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case a sequence was successfully read, a negative
|
||||
* value in case of invalid sequence
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_utf8_decode(int32_t *codep, const uint8_t **bufp, const uint8_t *buf_end,
|
||||
unsigned int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check if a name is in a list.
|
||||
* @returns 0 if not found, or the 1 based index where it has been found in the
|
||||
* list.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_match_list(const char *name, const char *list, char separator);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* See libc sscanf manual for more information.
|
||||
* Locale-independent sscanf implementation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_sscanf(const char *string, const char *format, ...);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AVSTRING_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,362 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu
|
||||
* Convenience header that includes @ref lavu "libavutil"'s core.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @mainpage
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section ffmpeg_intro Introduction
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This document describes the usage of the different libraries
|
||||
* provided by FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @li @ref libavc "libavcodec" encoding/decoding library
|
||||
* @li @ref lavfi "libavfilter" graph-based frame editing library
|
||||
* @li @ref libavf "libavformat" I/O and muxing/demuxing library
|
||||
* @li @ref lavd "libavdevice" special devices muxing/demuxing library
|
||||
* @li @ref lavu "libavutil" common utility library
|
||||
* @li @ref lswr "libswresample" audio resampling, format conversion and mixing
|
||||
* @li @ref lpp "libpostproc" post processing library
|
||||
* @li @ref libsws "libswscale" color conversion and scaling library
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section ffmpeg_versioning Versioning and compatibility
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Each of the FFmpeg libraries contains a version.h header, which defines a
|
||||
* major, minor and micro version number with the
|
||||
* <em>LIBRARYNAME_VERSION_{MAJOR,MINOR,MICRO}</em> macros. The major version
|
||||
* number is incremented with backward incompatible changes - e.g. removing
|
||||
* parts of the public API, reordering public struct members, etc. The minor
|
||||
* version number is incremented for backward compatible API changes or major
|
||||
* new features - e.g. adding a new public function or a new decoder. The micro
|
||||
* version number is incremented for smaller changes that a calling program
|
||||
* might still want to check for - e.g. changing behavior in a previously
|
||||
* unspecified situation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg guarantees backward API and ABI compatibility for each library as long
|
||||
* as its major version number is unchanged. This means that no public symbols
|
||||
* will be removed or renamed. Types and names of the public struct members and
|
||||
* values of public macros and enums will remain the same (unless they were
|
||||
* explicitly declared as not part of the public API). Documented behavior will
|
||||
* not change.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In other words, any correct program that works with a given FFmpeg snapshot
|
||||
* should work just as well without any changes with any later snapshot with the
|
||||
* same major versions. This applies to both rebuilding the program against new
|
||||
* FFmpeg versions or to replacing the dynamic FFmpeg libraries that a program
|
||||
* links against.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* However, new public symbols may be added and new members may be appended to
|
||||
* public structs whose size is not part of public ABI (most public structs in
|
||||
* FFmpeg). New macros and enum values may be added. Behavior in undocumented
|
||||
* situations may change slightly (and be documented). All those are accompanied
|
||||
* by an entry in doc/APIchanges and incrementing either the minor or micro
|
||||
* version number.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu libavutil
|
||||
* Common code shared across all FFmpeg libraries.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note
|
||||
* libavutil is designed to be modular. In most cases, in order to use the
|
||||
* functions provided by one component of libavutil you must explicitly include
|
||||
* the specific header containing that feature. If you are only using
|
||||
* media-related components, you could simply include libavutil/avutil.h, which
|
||||
* brings in most of the "core" components.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_crypto Crypto and Hashing
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_math Mathematics
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_string String Manipulation
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_mem Memory Management
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_data Data Structures
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_video Video related
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_audio Audio related
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_error Error Codes
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_log Logging Facility
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_misc Other
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup preproc_misc Preprocessor String Macros
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup version_utils Library Version Macros
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_ver
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the LIBAVUTIL_VERSION_INT constant.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned avutil_version(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return an informative version string. This usually is the actual release
|
||||
* version number or a git commit description. This string has no fixed format
|
||||
* and can change any time. It should never be parsed by code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_version_info(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the libavutil build-time configuration.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avutil_configuration(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the libavutil license.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *avutil_license(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_media Media Type
|
||||
* @brief Media Type
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVMediaType {
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_UNKNOWN = -1, ///< Usually treated as AVMEDIA_TYPE_DATA
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_VIDEO,
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_AUDIO,
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_DATA, ///< Opaque data information usually continuous
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_SUBTITLE,
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_ATTACHMENT, ///< Opaque data information usually sparse
|
||||
AVMEDIA_TYPE_NB
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return a string describing the media_type enum, NULL if media_type
|
||||
* is unknown.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_get_media_type_string(enum AVMediaType media_type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_const Constants
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_enc Encoding specific
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note those definition should move to avcodec
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_LAMBDA_SHIFT 7
|
||||
#define FF_LAMBDA_SCALE (1<<FF_LAMBDA_SHIFT)
|
||||
#define FF_QP2LAMBDA 118 ///< factor to convert from H.263 QP to lambda
|
||||
#define FF_LAMBDA_MAX (256*128-1)
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_QUALITY_SCALE FF_LAMBDA_SCALE //FIXME maybe remove
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_time Timestamp specific
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg internal timebase and timestamp definitions
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief Undefined timestamp value
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Usually reported by demuxer that work on containers that do not provide
|
||||
* either pts or dts.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_NOPTS_VALUE ((int64_t)UINT64_C(0x8000000000000000))
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Internal time base represented as integer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_TIME_BASE 1000000
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Internal time base represented as fractional value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
/* ISO C++ forbids compound-literals. */
|
||||
#define AV_TIME_BASE_Q av_make_q(1, AV_TIME_BASE)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define AV_TIME_BASE_Q (AVRational){1, AV_TIME_BASE}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_picture Image related
|
||||
*
|
||||
* AVPicture types, pixel formats and basic image planes manipulation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVPictureType {
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_NONE = 0, ///< Undefined
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_I, ///< Intra
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_P, ///< Predicted
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_B, ///< Bi-dir predicted
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_S, ///< S(GMC)-VOP MPEG-4
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_SI, ///< Switching Intra
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_SP, ///< Switching Predicted
|
||||
AV_PICTURE_TYPE_BI, ///< BI type
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return a single letter to describe the given picture type
|
||||
* pict_type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] pict_type the picture type @return a single character
|
||||
* representing the picture type, '?' if pict_type is unknown
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char av_get_picture_type_char(enum AVPictureType pict_type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "common.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
#include "macros.h"
|
||||
#include "mathematics.h"
|
||||
#include "log.h"
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return x default pointer in case p is NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline void *av_x_if_null(const void *p, const void *x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (void *)(intptr_t)(p ? p : x);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Compute the length of an integer list.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param elsize size in bytes of each list element (only 1, 2, 4 or 8)
|
||||
* @param term list terminator (usually 0 or -1)
|
||||
* @param list pointer to the list
|
||||
* @return length of the list, in elements, not counting the terminator
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned av_int_list_length_for_size(unsigned elsize,
|
||||
const void *list, uint64_t term) av_pure;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Compute the length of an integer list.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param term list terminator (usually 0 or -1)
|
||||
* @param list pointer to the list
|
||||
* @return length of the list, in elements, not counting the terminator
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define av_int_list_length(list, term) \
|
||||
av_int_list_length_for_size(sizeof(*(list)), list, term)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the fractional representation of the internal time base.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational av_get_time_base_q(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE 32
|
||||
|
||||
#define av_fourcc2str(fourcc) av_fourcc_make_string((char[AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE]){0}, fourcc)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Fill the provided buffer with a string containing a FourCC (four-character
|
||||
* code) representation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf a buffer with size in bytes of at least AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE
|
||||
* @param fourcc the fourcc to represent
|
||||
* @return the buffer in input
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_fourcc_make_string(char *buf, uint32_t fourcc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2006 Ryan Martell. (rdm4@martellventures.com)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_BASE64_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_BASE64_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_base64 Base64
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Decode a base64-encoded string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param out buffer for decoded data
|
||||
* @param in null-terminated input string
|
||||
* @param out_size size in bytes of the out buffer, must be at
|
||||
* least 3/4 of the length of in, that is AV_BASE64_DECODE_SIZE(strlen(in))
|
||||
* @return number of bytes written, or a negative value in case of
|
||||
* invalid input
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_base64_decode(uint8_t *out, const char *in, int out_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Calculate the output size in bytes needed to decode a base64 string
|
||||
* with length x to a data buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BASE64_DECODE_SIZE(x) ((x) * 3LL / 4)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encode data to base64 and null-terminate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param out buffer for encoded data
|
||||
* @param out_size size in bytes of the out buffer (including the
|
||||
* null terminator), must be at least AV_BASE64_SIZE(in_size)
|
||||
* @param in input buffer containing the data to encode
|
||||
* @param in_size size in bytes of the in buffer
|
||||
* @return out or NULL in case of error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *av_base64_encode(char *out, int out_size, const uint8_t *in, int in_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Calculate the output size needed to base64-encode x bytes to a
|
||||
* null-terminated string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BASE64_SIZE(x) (((x)+2) / 3 * 4 + 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_BASE64_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Blowfish algorithm
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2012 Samuel Pitoiset
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_BLOWFISH_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_BLOWFISH_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_blowfish Blowfish
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_BF_ROUNDS 16
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVBlowfish {
|
||||
uint32_t p[AV_BF_ROUNDS + 2];
|
||||
uint32_t s[4][256];
|
||||
} AVBlowfish;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVBlowfish context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBlowfish *av_blowfish_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVBlowfish context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVBlowfish context
|
||||
* @param key a key
|
||||
* @param key_len length of the key
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_blowfish_init(struct AVBlowfish *ctx, const uint8_t *key, int key_len);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVBlowfish context
|
||||
* @param xl left four bytes halves of input to be encrypted
|
||||
* @param xr right four bytes halves of input to be encrypted
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_blowfish_crypt_ecb(struct AVBlowfish *ctx, uint32_t *xl, uint32_t *xr,
|
||||
int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVBlowfish context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param count number of 8 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param iv initialization vector for CBC mode, if NULL ECB will be used
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_blowfish_crypt(struct AVBlowfish *ctx, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src,
|
||||
int count, uint8_t *iv, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_BLOWFISH_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,254 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2012 Nicolas George
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_avbprint
|
||||
* AVBPrint public header
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_BPRINT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_BPRINT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "avstring.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_avbprint AVBPrint
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_data
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A buffer to print data progressively
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Define a structure with extra padding to a fixed size
|
||||
* This helps ensuring binary compatibility with future versions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FF_PAD_STRUCTURE(name, size, ...) \
|
||||
struct ff_pad_helper_##name { __VA_ARGS__ }; \
|
||||
typedef struct name { \
|
||||
__VA_ARGS__ \
|
||||
char reserved_padding[size - sizeof(struct ff_pad_helper_##name)]; \
|
||||
} name;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Buffer to print data progressively
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The string buffer grows as necessary and is always 0-terminated.
|
||||
* The content of the string is never accessed, and thus is
|
||||
* encoding-agnostic and can even hold binary data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Small buffers are kept in the structure itself, and thus require no
|
||||
* memory allocation at all (unless the contents of the buffer is needed
|
||||
* after the structure goes out of scope). This is almost as lightweight as
|
||||
* declaring a local `char buf[512]`.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The length of the string can go beyond the allocated size: the buffer is
|
||||
* then truncated, but the functions still keep account of the actual total
|
||||
* length.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In other words, AVBPrint.len can be greater than AVBPrint.size and records
|
||||
* the total length of what would have been to the buffer if there had been
|
||||
* enough memory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Append operations do not need to be tested for failure: if a memory
|
||||
* allocation fails, data stop being appended to the buffer, but the length
|
||||
* is still updated. This situation can be tested with
|
||||
* av_bprint_is_complete().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The AVBPrint.size_max field determines several possible behaviours:
|
||||
* - `size_max = -1` (= `UINT_MAX`) or any large value will let the buffer be
|
||||
* reallocated as necessary, with an amortized linear cost.
|
||||
* - `size_max = 0` prevents writing anything to the buffer: only the total
|
||||
* length is computed. The write operations can then possibly be repeated in
|
||||
* a buffer with exactly the necessary size
|
||||
* (using `size_init = size_max = len + 1`).
|
||||
* - `size_max = 1` is automatically replaced by the exact size available in the
|
||||
* structure itself, thus ensuring no dynamic memory allocation. The
|
||||
* internal buffer is large enough to hold a reasonable paragraph of text,
|
||||
* such as the current paragraph.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
FF_PAD_STRUCTURE(AVBPrint, 1024,
|
||||
char *str; /**< string so far */
|
||||
unsigned len; /**< length so far */
|
||||
unsigned size; /**< allocated memory */
|
||||
unsigned size_max; /**< maximum allocated memory */
|
||||
char reserved_internal_buffer[1];
|
||||
)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @name Max size special values
|
||||
* Convenience macros for special values for av_bprint_init() size_max
|
||||
* parameter.
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Buffer will be reallocated as necessary, with an amortized linear cost.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BPRINT_SIZE_UNLIMITED ((unsigned)-1)
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Use the exact size available in the AVBPrint structure itself.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Thus ensuring no dynamic memory allocation. The internal buffer is large
|
||||
* enough to hold a reasonable paragraph of text, such as the current paragraph.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BPRINT_SIZE_AUTOMATIC 1
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Do not write anything to the buffer, only calculate the total length.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The write operations can then possibly be repeated in a buffer with
|
||||
* exactly the necessary size (using `size_init = size_max = AVBPrint.len + 1`).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BPRINT_SIZE_COUNT_ONLY 0
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Init a print buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf buffer to init
|
||||
* @param size_init initial size (including the final 0)
|
||||
* @param size_max maximum size;
|
||||
* - `0` means do not write anything, just count the length
|
||||
* - `1` is replaced by the maximum value for automatic storage
|
||||
* any large value means that the internal buffer will be
|
||||
* reallocated as needed up to that limit
|
||||
* - `-1` is converted to `UINT_MAX`, the largest limit possible.
|
||||
* Check also `AV_BPRINT_SIZE_*` macros.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_init(AVBPrint *buf, unsigned size_init, unsigned size_max);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Init a print buffer using a pre-existing buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The buffer will not be reallocated.
|
||||
* In case size equals zero, the AVBPrint will be initialized to use
|
||||
* the internal buffer as if using AV_BPRINT_SIZE_COUNT_ONLY with
|
||||
* av_bprint_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf buffer structure to init
|
||||
* @param buffer byte buffer to use for the string data
|
||||
* @param size size of buffer
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_init_for_buffer(AVBPrint *buf, char *buffer, unsigned size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append a formatted string to a print buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprintf(AVBPrint *buf, const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(2, 3);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append a formatted string to a print buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_vbprintf(AVBPrint *buf, const char *fmt, va_list vl_arg);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append char c n times to a print buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_chars(AVBPrint *buf, char c, unsigned n);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append data to a print buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf bprint buffer to use
|
||||
* @param data pointer to data
|
||||
* @param size size of data
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_append_data(AVBPrint *buf, const char *data, unsigned size);
|
||||
|
||||
struct tm;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Append a formatted date and time to a print buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf bprint buffer to use
|
||||
* @param fmt date and time format string, see strftime()
|
||||
* @param tm broken-down time structure to translate
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note due to poor design of the standard strftime function, it may
|
||||
* produce poor results if the format string expands to a very long text and
|
||||
* the bprint buffer is near the limit stated by the size_max option.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_strftime(AVBPrint *buf, const char *fmt, const struct tm *tm);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate bytes in the buffer for external use.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] buf buffer structure
|
||||
* @param[in] size required size
|
||||
* @param[out] mem pointer to the memory area
|
||||
* @param[out] actual_size size of the memory area after allocation;
|
||||
* can be larger or smaller than size
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_get_buffer(AVBPrint *buf, unsigned size,
|
||||
unsigned char **mem, unsigned *actual_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reset the string to "" but keep internal allocated data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_clear(AVBPrint *buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Test if the print buffer is complete (not truncated).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It may have been truncated due to a memory allocation failure
|
||||
* or the size_max limit (compare size and size_max if necessary).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline int av_bprint_is_complete(const AVBPrint *buf)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return buf->len < buf->size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize a print buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The print buffer can no longer be used afterwards,
|
||||
* but the len and size fields are still valid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @arg[out] ret_str if not NULL, used to return a permanent copy of the
|
||||
* buffer contents, or NULL if memory allocation fails;
|
||||
* if NULL, the buffer is discarded and freed
|
||||
* @return 0 for success or error code (probably AVERROR(ENOMEM))
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_bprint_finalize(AVBPrint *buf, char **ret_str);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Escape the content in src and append it to dstbuf.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dstbuf already inited destination bprint buffer
|
||||
* @param src string containing the text to escape
|
||||
* @param special_chars string containing the special characters which
|
||||
* need to be escaped, can be NULL
|
||||
* @param mode escape mode to employ, see AV_ESCAPE_MODE_* macros.
|
||||
* Any unknown value for mode will be considered equivalent to
|
||||
* AV_ESCAPE_MODE_BACKSLASH, but this behaviour can change without
|
||||
* notice.
|
||||
* @param flags flags which control how to escape, see AV_ESCAPE_FLAG_* macros
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bprint_escape(AVBPrint *dstbuf, const char *src, const char *special_chars,
|
||||
enum AVEscapeMode mode, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_BPRINT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* byte swapping routines
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_BSWAP_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_BSWAP_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avconfig.h"
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if ARCH_AARCH64
|
||||
# include "aarch64/bswap.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_ARM
|
||||
# include "arm/bswap.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_AVR32
|
||||
# include "avr32/bswap.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_RISCV
|
||||
# include "riscv/bswap.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_SH4
|
||||
# include "sh4/bswap.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_X86
|
||||
# include "x86/bswap.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H */
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_BSWAP16C(x) (((x) << 8 & 0xff00) | ((x) >> 8 & 0x00ff))
|
||||
#define AV_BSWAP32C(x) (AV_BSWAP16C(x) << 16 | AV_BSWAP16C((x) >> 16))
|
||||
#define AV_BSWAP64C(x) (AV_BSWAP32C(x) << 32 | AV_BSWAP32C((x) >> 32))
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_BSWAPC(s, x) AV_BSWAP##s##C(x)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_bswap16
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const uint16_t av_bswap16(uint16_t x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
x= (x>>8) | (x<<8);
|
||||
return x;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_bswap32
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const uint32_t av_bswap32(uint32_t x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return AV_BSWAP32C(x);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_bswap64
|
||||
static inline uint64_t av_const av_bswap64(uint64_t x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (uint64_t)av_bswap32(x) << 32 | av_bswap32(x >> 32);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
// be2ne ... big-endian to native-endian
|
||||
// le2ne ... little-endian to native-endian
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
|
||||
#define av_be2ne16(x) (x)
|
||||
#define av_be2ne32(x) (x)
|
||||
#define av_be2ne64(x) (x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne16(x) av_bswap16(x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne32(x) av_bswap32(x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne64(x) av_bswap64(x)
|
||||
#define AV_BE2NEC(s, x) (x)
|
||||
#define AV_LE2NEC(s, x) AV_BSWAPC(s, x)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define av_be2ne16(x) av_bswap16(x)
|
||||
#define av_be2ne32(x) av_bswap32(x)
|
||||
#define av_be2ne64(x) av_bswap64(x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne16(x) (x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne32(x) (x)
|
||||
#define av_le2ne64(x) (x)
|
||||
#define AV_BE2NEC(s, x) AV_BSWAPC(s, x)
|
||||
#define AV_LE2NEC(s, x) (x)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_BE2NE16C(x) AV_BE2NEC(16, x)
|
||||
#define AV_BE2NE32C(x) AV_BE2NEC(32, x)
|
||||
#define AV_BE2NE64C(x) AV_BE2NEC(64, x)
|
||||
#define AV_LE2NE16C(x) AV_LE2NEC(16, x)
|
||||
#define AV_LE2NE32C(x) AV_LE2NEC(32, x)
|
||||
#define AV_LE2NE64C(x) AV_LE2NEC(64, x)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_BSWAP_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,322 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_buffer
|
||||
* refcounted data buffer API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_BUFFER_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_BUFFER_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_buffer AVBuffer
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_data
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* AVBuffer is an API for reference-counted data buffers.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* There are two core objects in this API -- AVBuffer and AVBufferRef. AVBuffer
|
||||
* represents the data buffer itself; it is opaque and not meant to be accessed
|
||||
* by the caller directly, but only through AVBufferRef. However, the caller may
|
||||
* e.g. compare two AVBuffer pointers to check whether two different references
|
||||
* are describing the same data buffer. AVBufferRef represents a single
|
||||
* reference to an AVBuffer and it is the object that may be manipulated by the
|
||||
* caller directly.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* There are two functions provided for creating a new AVBuffer with a single
|
||||
* reference -- av_buffer_alloc() to just allocate a new buffer, and
|
||||
* av_buffer_create() to wrap an existing array in an AVBuffer. From an existing
|
||||
* reference, additional references may be created with av_buffer_ref().
|
||||
* Use av_buffer_unref() to free a reference (this will automatically free the
|
||||
* data once all the references are freed).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The convention throughout this API and the rest of FFmpeg is such that the
|
||||
* buffer is considered writable if there exists only one reference to it (and
|
||||
* it has not been marked as read-only). The av_buffer_is_writable() function is
|
||||
* provided to check whether this is true and av_buffer_make_writable() will
|
||||
* automatically create a new writable buffer when necessary.
|
||||
* Of course nothing prevents the calling code from violating this convention,
|
||||
* however that is safe only when all the existing references are under its
|
||||
* control.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note Referencing and unreferencing the buffers is thread-safe and thus
|
||||
* may be done from multiple threads simultaneously without any need for
|
||||
* additional locking.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note Two different references to the same buffer can point to different
|
||||
* parts of the buffer (i.e. their AVBufferRef.data will not be equal).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A reference counted buffer type. It is opaque and is meant to be used through
|
||||
* references (AVBufferRef).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBuffer AVBuffer;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A reference to a data buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The size of this struct is not a part of the public ABI and it is not meant
|
||||
* to be allocated directly.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBufferRef {
|
||||
AVBuffer *buffer;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The data buffer. It is considered writable if and only if
|
||||
* this is the only reference to the buffer, in which case
|
||||
* av_buffer_is_writable() returns 1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *data;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Size of data in bytes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t size;
|
||||
} AVBufferRef;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVBuffer of the given size using av_malloc().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return an AVBufferRef of given size or NULL when out of memory
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_buffer_alloc(size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Same as av_buffer_alloc(), except the returned buffer will be initialized
|
||||
* to zero.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_buffer_allocz(size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Always treat the buffer as read-only, even when it has only one
|
||||
* reference.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_BUFFER_FLAG_READONLY (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create an AVBuffer from an existing array.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this function is successful, data is owned by the AVBuffer. The caller may
|
||||
* only access data through the returned AVBufferRef and references derived from
|
||||
* it.
|
||||
* If this function fails, data is left untouched.
|
||||
* @param data data array
|
||||
* @param size size of data in bytes
|
||||
* @param free a callback for freeing this buffer's data
|
||||
* @param opaque parameter to be got for processing or passed to free
|
||||
* @param flags a combination of AV_BUFFER_FLAG_*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return an AVBufferRef referring to data on success, NULL on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_buffer_create(uint8_t *data, size_t size,
|
||||
void (*free)(void *opaque, uint8_t *data),
|
||||
void *opaque, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Default free callback, which calls av_free() on the buffer data.
|
||||
* This function is meant to be passed to av_buffer_create(), not called
|
||||
* directly.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_buffer_default_free(void *opaque, uint8_t *data);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a new reference to an AVBuffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a new AVBufferRef referring to the same AVBuffer as buf or NULL on
|
||||
* failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_buffer_ref(const AVBufferRef *buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free a given reference and automatically free the buffer if there are no more
|
||||
* references to it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf the reference to be freed. The pointer is set to NULL on return.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_buffer_unref(AVBufferRef **buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return 1 if the caller may write to the data referred to by buf (which is
|
||||
* true if and only if buf is the only reference to the underlying AVBuffer).
|
||||
* Return 0 otherwise.
|
||||
* A positive answer is valid until av_buffer_ref() is called on buf.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffer_is_writable(const AVBufferRef *buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return the opaque parameter set by av_buffer_create.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *av_buffer_get_opaque(const AVBufferRef *buf);
|
||||
|
||||
int av_buffer_get_ref_count(const AVBufferRef *buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a writable reference from a given buffer reference, avoiding data copy
|
||||
* if possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf buffer reference to make writable. On success, buf is either left
|
||||
* untouched, or it is unreferenced and a new writable AVBufferRef is
|
||||
* written in its place. On failure, buf is left untouched.
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffer_make_writable(AVBufferRef **buf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reallocate a given buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf a buffer reference to reallocate. On success, buf will be
|
||||
* unreferenced and a new reference with the required size will be
|
||||
* written in its place. On failure buf will be left untouched. *buf
|
||||
* may be NULL, then a new buffer is allocated.
|
||||
* @param size required new buffer size.
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the buffer is actually reallocated with av_realloc() only if it was
|
||||
* initially allocated through av_buffer_realloc(NULL) and there is only one
|
||||
* reference to it (i.e. the one passed to this function). In all other cases
|
||||
* a new buffer is allocated and the data is copied.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffer_realloc(AVBufferRef **buf, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Ensure dst refers to the same data as src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When *dst is already equivalent to src, do nothing. Otherwise unreference dst
|
||||
* and replace it with a new reference to src.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst Pointer to either a valid buffer reference or NULL. On success,
|
||||
* this will point to a buffer reference equivalent to src. On
|
||||
* failure, dst will be left untouched.
|
||||
* @param src A buffer reference to replace dst with. May be NULL, then this
|
||||
* function is equivalent to av_buffer_unref(dst).
|
||||
* @return 0 on success
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOMEM) on memory allocation failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_buffer_replace(AVBufferRef **dst, const AVBufferRef *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_bufferpool AVBufferPool
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_data
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* AVBufferPool is an API for a lock-free thread-safe pool of AVBuffers.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Frequently allocating and freeing large buffers may be slow. AVBufferPool is
|
||||
* meant to solve this in cases when the caller needs a set of buffers of the
|
||||
* same size (the most obvious use case being buffers for raw video or audio
|
||||
* frames).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* At the beginning, the user must call av_buffer_pool_init() to create the
|
||||
* buffer pool. Then whenever a buffer is needed, call av_buffer_pool_get() to
|
||||
* get a reference to a new buffer, similar to av_buffer_alloc(). This new
|
||||
* reference works in all aspects the same way as the one created by
|
||||
* av_buffer_alloc(). However, when the last reference to this buffer is
|
||||
* unreferenced, it is returned to the pool instead of being freed and will be
|
||||
* reused for subsequent av_buffer_pool_get() calls.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When the caller is done with the pool and no longer needs to allocate any new
|
||||
* buffers, av_buffer_pool_uninit() must be called to mark the pool as freeable.
|
||||
* Once all the buffers are released, it will automatically be freed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocating and releasing buffers with this API is thread-safe as long as
|
||||
* either the default alloc callback is used, or the user-supplied one is
|
||||
* thread-safe.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The buffer pool. This structure is opaque and not meant to be accessed
|
||||
* directly. It is allocated with av_buffer_pool_init() and freed with
|
||||
* av_buffer_pool_uninit().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVBufferPool AVBufferPool;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize a buffer pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size size of each buffer in this pool
|
||||
* @param alloc a function that will be used to allocate new buffers when the
|
||||
* pool is empty. May be NULL, then the default allocator will be used
|
||||
* (av_buffer_alloc()).
|
||||
* @return newly created buffer pool on success, NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferPool *av_buffer_pool_init(size_t size, AVBufferRef* (*alloc)(size_t size));
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize a buffer pool with a more complex allocator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size size of each buffer in this pool
|
||||
* @param opaque arbitrary user data used by the allocator
|
||||
* @param alloc a function that will be used to allocate new buffers when the
|
||||
* pool is empty. May be NULL, then the default allocator will be
|
||||
* used (av_buffer_alloc()).
|
||||
* @param pool_free a function that will be called immediately before the pool
|
||||
* is freed. I.e. after av_buffer_pool_uninit() is called
|
||||
* by the caller and all the frames are returned to the pool
|
||||
* and freed. It is intended to uninitialize the user opaque
|
||||
* data. May be NULL.
|
||||
* @return newly created buffer pool on success, NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferPool *av_buffer_pool_init2(size_t size, void *opaque,
|
||||
AVBufferRef* (*alloc)(void *opaque, size_t size),
|
||||
void (*pool_free)(void *opaque));
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mark the pool as being available for freeing. It will actually be freed only
|
||||
* once all the allocated buffers associated with the pool are released. Thus it
|
||||
* is safe to call this function while some of the allocated buffers are still
|
||||
* in use.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pool pointer to the pool to be freed. It will be set to NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_buffer_pool_uninit(AVBufferPool **pool);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new AVBuffer, reusing an old buffer from the pool when available.
|
||||
* This function may be called simultaneously from multiple threads.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a reference to the new buffer on success, NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_buffer_pool_get(AVBufferPool *pool);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Query the original opaque parameter of an allocated buffer in the pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ref a buffer reference to a buffer returned by av_buffer_pool_get.
|
||||
* @return the opaque parameter set by the buffer allocator function of the
|
||||
* buffer pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the opaque parameter of ref is used by the buffer pool implementation,
|
||||
* therefore you have to use this function to access the original opaque
|
||||
* parameter of an allocated buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *av_buffer_pool_buffer_get_opaque(const AVBufferRef *ref);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_BUFFER_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* An implementation of the CAMELLIA algorithm as mentioned in RFC3713
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2014 Supraja Meedinti
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CAMELLIA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CAMELLIA_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @brief Public header for libavutil CAMELLIA algorithm
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_camellia CAMELLIA
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern const int av_camellia_size;
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVCAMELLIA;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVCAMELLIA context
|
||||
* To free the struct: av_free(ptr)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVCAMELLIA *av_camellia_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVCAMELLIA context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVCAMELLIA context
|
||||
* @param key a key of 16, 24, 32 bytes used for encryption/decryption
|
||||
* @param key_bits number of keybits: possible are 128, 192, 256
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_camellia_init(struct AVCAMELLIA *ctx, const uint8_t *key, int key_bits);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVCAMELLIA context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param count number of 16 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param iv initialization vector for CBC mode, NULL for ECB mode
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_camellia_crypt(struct AVCAMELLIA *ctx, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count, uint8_t* iv, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CAMELLIA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* An implementation of the CAST128 algorithm as mentioned in RFC2144
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2014 Supraja Meedinti
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CAST5_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CAST5_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @brief Public header for libavutil CAST5 algorithm
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_cast5 CAST5
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern const int av_cast5_size;
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVCAST5;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVCAST5 context
|
||||
* To free the struct: av_free(ptr)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVCAST5 *av_cast5_alloc(void);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVCAST5 context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVCAST5 context
|
||||
* @param key a key of 5,6,...16 bytes used for encryption/decryption
|
||||
* @param key_bits number of keybits: possible are 40,48,...,128
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, less than 0 on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_cast5_init(struct AVCAST5 *ctx, const uint8_t *key, int key_bits);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context, ECB mode only
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVCAST5 context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param count number of 8 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_cast5_crypt(struct AVCAST5 *ctx, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Encrypt or decrypt a buffer using a previously initialized context
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx an AVCAST5 context
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst
|
||||
* @param count number of 8 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param iv initialization vector for CBC mode, NULL for ECB mode
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_cast5_crypt2(struct AVCAST5 *ctx, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count, uint8_t *iv, int decrypt);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CAST5_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,733 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Peter Ross
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_audio_channels
|
||||
* Public libavutil channel layout APIs header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_audio_channels Audio channels
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_audio
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Audio channel layout utility functions
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVChannel {
|
||||
///< Invalid channel index
|
||||
AV_CHAN_NONE = -1,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_FRONT_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_FRONT_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_FRONT_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_LOW_FREQUENCY,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BACK_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BACK_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BACK_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_SIDE_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_SIDE_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_RIGHT,
|
||||
/** Stereo downmix. */
|
||||
AV_CHAN_STEREO_LEFT = 29,
|
||||
/** See above. */
|
||||
AV_CHAN_STEREO_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_WIDE_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_WIDE_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_SURROUND_DIRECT_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_SURROUND_DIRECT_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_LOW_FREQUENCY_2,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_SIDE_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_TOP_SIDE_RIGHT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_CENTER,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_LEFT,
|
||||
AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_RIGHT,
|
||||
|
||||
/** Channel is empty can be safely skipped. */
|
||||
AV_CHAN_UNUSED = 0x200,
|
||||
|
||||
/** Channel contains data, but its position is unknown. */
|
||||
AV_CHAN_UNKNOWN = 0x300,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Range of channels between AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE and
|
||||
* AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_END represent Ambisonic components using the ACN system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Given a channel id `<i>` between AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE and
|
||||
* AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_END (inclusive), the ACN index of the channel `<n>` is
|
||||
* `<n> = <i> - AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE`.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note these values are only used for AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_CUSTOM channel
|
||||
* orderings, the AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_AMBISONIC ordering orders the channels
|
||||
* implicitly by their position in the stream.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE = 0x400,
|
||||
// leave space for 1024 ids, which correspond to maximum order-32 harmonics,
|
||||
// which should be enough for the foreseeable use cases
|
||||
AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_END = 0x7ff,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVChannelOrder {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Only the channel count is specified, without any further information
|
||||
* about the channel order.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The native channel order, i.e. the channels are in the same order in
|
||||
* which they are defined in the AVChannel enum. This supports up to 63
|
||||
* different channels.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_NATIVE,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The channel order does not correspond to any other predefined order and
|
||||
* is stored as an explicit map. For example, this could be used to support
|
||||
* layouts with 64 or more channels, or with empty/skipped (AV_CHAN_UNUSED)
|
||||
* channels at arbitrary positions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_CUSTOM,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The audio is represented as the decomposition of the sound field into
|
||||
* spherical harmonics. Each channel corresponds to a single expansion
|
||||
* component. Channels are ordered according to ACN (Ambisonic Channel
|
||||
* Number).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The channel with the index n in the stream contains the spherical
|
||||
* harmonic of degree l and order m given by
|
||||
* @code{.unparsed}
|
||||
* l = floor(sqrt(n)),
|
||||
* m = n - l * (l + 1).
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Conversely given a spherical harmonic of degree l and order m, the
|
||||
* corresponding channel index n is given by
|
||||
* @code{.unparsed}
|
||||
* n = l * (l + 1) + m.
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Normalization is assumed to be SN3D (Schmidt Semi-Normalization)
|
||||
* as defined in AmbiX format $ 2.1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_AMBISONIC,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of channel orders, not part of ABI/API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FF_CHANNEL_ORDER_NB
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup channel_masks Audio channel masks
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A channel layout is a 64-bits integer with a bit set for every channel.
|
||||
* The number of bits set must be equal to the number of channels.
|
||||
* The value 0 means that the channel layout is not known.
|
||||
* @note this data structure is not powerful enough to handle channels
|
||||
* combinations that have the same channel multiple times, such as
|
||||
* dual-mono.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_FRONT_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_FRONT_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_FRONT_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY (1ULL << AV_CHAN_LOW_FREQUENCY )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BACK_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BACK_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BACK_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BACK_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BACK_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_SIDE_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_SIDE_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_BACK_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_STEREO_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_STEREO_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_STEREO_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_STEREO_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_WIDE_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_WIDE_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_WIDE_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_WIDE_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_SURROUND_DIRECT_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_SURROUND_DIRECT_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_SURROUND_DIRECT_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_SURROUND_DIRECT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY_2 (1ULL << AV_CHAN_LOW_FREQUENCY_2 )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_SIDE_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_SIDE_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_TOP_SIDE_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_TOP_SIDE_RIGHT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_CENTER (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_CENTER )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_LEFT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_LEFT )
|
||||
#define AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_RIGHT (1ULL << AV_CHAN_BOTTOM_FRONT_RIGHT )
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @defgroup channel_mask_c Audio channel layouts
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* */
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO (AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO (AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT0 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT0|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_2 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_QUAD (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT (AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_2|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXAGONAL (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1POINT2 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_FRONT (AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0_FRONT (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_CUBE (AV_CH_LAYOUT_QUAD|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT4_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT2 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT4_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT2|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT2POINT3 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT2|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY_2)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_9POINT1POINT4_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT4_BACK|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXADECAGONAL (AV_CH_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL|AV_CH_WIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_WIDE_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO_DOWNMIX (AV_CH_STEREO_LEFT|AV_CH_STEREO_RIGHT)
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_22POINT2 (AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT4_BACK|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY_2|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_SIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_SIDE_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_CENTER|AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_BOTTOM_FRONT_RIGHT)
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_TOP_BACK AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVMatrixEncoding {
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_NONE,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBY,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLII,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLIIX,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLIIZ,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBYEX,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBYHEADPHONE,
|
||||
AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_NB
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AVChannelCustom defines a single channel within a custom order layout
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Unlike most structures in FFmpeg, sizeof(AVChannelCustom) is a part of the
|
||||
* public ABI.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* No new fields may be added to it without a major version bump.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVChannelCustom {
|
||||
enum AVChannel id;
|
||||
char name[16];
|
||||
void *opaque;
|
||||
} AVChannelCustom;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An AVChannelLayout holds information about the channel layout of audio data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A channel layout here is defined as a set of channels ordered in a specific
|
||||
* way (unless the channel order is AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC, in which case an
|
||||
* AVChannelLayout carries only the channel count).
|
||||
* All orders may be treated as if they were AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC by
|
||||
* ignoring everything but the channel count, as long as av_channel_layout_check()
|
||||
* considers they are valid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Unlike most structures in FFmpeg, sizeof(AVChannelLayout) is a part of the
|
||||
* public ABI and may be used by the caller. E.g. it may be allocated on stack
|
||||
* or embedded in caller-defined structs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* AVChannelLayout can be initialized as follows:
|
||||
* - default initialization with {0}, followed by setting all used fields
|
||||
* correctly;
|
||||
* - by assigning one of the predefined AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_* initializers;
|
||||
* - with a constructor function, such as av_channel_layout_default(),
|
||||
* av_channel_layout_from_mask() or av_channel_layout_from_string().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The channel layout must be unitialized with av_channel_layout_uninit()
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copying an AVChannelLayout via assigning is forbidden,
|
||||
* av_channel_layout_copy() must be used instead (and its return value should
|
||||
* be checked)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* No new fields may be added to it without a major version bump, except for
|
||||
* new elements of the union fitting in sizeof(uint64_t).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVChannelLayout {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Channel order used in this layout.
|
||||
* This is a mandatory field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVChannelOrder order;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of channels in this layout. Mandatory field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_channels;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Details about which channels are present in this layout.
|
||||
* For AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC, this field is undefined and must not be
|
||||
* used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
union {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This member must be used for AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_NATIVE, and may be used
|
||||
* for AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_AMBISONIC to signal non-diegetic channels.
|
||||
* It is a bitmask, where the position of each set bit means that the
|
||||
* AVChannel with the corresponding value is present.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* I.e. when (mask & (1 << AV_CHAN_FOO)) is non-zero, then AV_CHAN_FOO
|
||||
* is present in the layout. Otherwise it is not present.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note when a channel layout using a bitmask is constructed or
|
||||
* modified manually (i.e. not using any of the av_channel_layout_*
|
||||
* functions), the code doing it must ensure that the number of set bits
|
||||
* is equal to nb_channels.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t mask;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This member must be used when the channel order is
|
||||
* AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_CUSTOM. It is a nb_channels-sized array, with each
|
||||
* element signalling the presence of the AVChannel with the
|
||||
* corresponding value in map[i].id.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* I.e. when map[i].id is equal to AV_CHAN_FOO, then AV_CH_FOO is the
|
||||
* i-th channel in the audio data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When map[i].id is in the range between AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE and
|
||||
* AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_END (inclusive), the channel contains an ambisonic
|
||||
* component with ACN index (as defined above)
|
||||
* n = map[i].id - AV_CHAN_AMBISONIC_BASE.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* map[i].name may be filled with a 0-terminated string, in which case
|
||||
* it will be used for the purpose of identifying the channel with the
|
||||
* convenience functions below. Otherise it must be zeroed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVChannelCustom *map;
|
||||
} u;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* For some private data of the user.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *opaque;
|
||||
} AVChannelLayout;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Macro to define native channel layouts
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This doesn't use designated initializers for compatibility with C++ 17 and older.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(nb, m) \
|
||||
{ /* .order */ AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_NATIVE, \
|
||||
/* .nb_channels */ (nb), \
|
||||
/* .u.mask */ { m }, \
|
||||
/* .opaque */ NULL }
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @name Common pre-defined channel layouts
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MONO AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(1, AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_STEREO AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(2, AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_2POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(3, AV_CH_LAYOUT_2POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_2_1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(3, AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_SURROUND AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(3, AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_3POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(4, AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_4POINT0 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(4, AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT0)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_4POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(5, AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_2_2 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(4, AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_2)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_QUAD AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(4, AV_CH_LAYOUT_QUAD)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT0 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(5, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(5, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_6POINT0 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_3POINT1POINT2 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1POINT2)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_HEXAGONAL AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(6, AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXAGONAL)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_6POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(7, AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_6POINT1_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(7, AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_6POINT1_FRONT AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(7, AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_FRONT)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT0 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(7, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT0_FRONT AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(7, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0_FRONT)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_CUBE AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(8, AV_CH_LAYOUT_CUBE)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT4_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(10, AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT4_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT2 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(10, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT2)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT4_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(12, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1POINT4_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT2POINT3 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(12, AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT2POINT3)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_9POINT1POINT4_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(14, AV_CH_LAYOUT_9POINT1POINT4_BACK)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_HEXADECAGONAL AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(16, AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXADECAGONAL)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_STEREO_DOWNMIX AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(2, AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO_DOWNMIX)
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_22POINT2 AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_MASK(24, AV_CH_LAYOUT_22POINT2)
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_7POINT1_TOP_BACK AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_5POINT1POINT2_BACK
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_AMBISONIC_FIRST_ORDER \
|
||||
{ /* .order */ AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_AMBISONIC, \
|
||||
/* .nb_channels */ 4, \
|
||||
/* .u.mask */ { 0 }, \
|
||||
/* .opaque */ NULL }
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVBPrint;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a human readable string in an abbreviated form describing a given channel.
|
||||
* This is the inverse function of @ref av_channel_from_string().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf pre-allocated buffer where to put the generated string
|
||||
* @param buf_size size in bytes of the buffer.
|
||||
* @param channel the AVChannel whose name to get
|
||||
* @return amount of bytes needed to hold the output string, or a negative AVERROR
|
||||
* on failure. If the returned value is bigger than buf_size, then the
|
||||
* string was truncated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_name(char *buf, size_t buf_size, enum AVChannel channel);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* bprint variant of av_channel_name().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the string will be appended to the bprint buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_channel_name_bprint(struct AVBPrint *bp, enum AVChannel channel_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a human readable string describing a given channel.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param buf pre-allocated buffer where to put the generated string
|
||||
* @param buf_size size in bytes of the buffer.
|
||||
* @param channel the AVChannel whose description to get
|
||||
* @return amount of bytes needed to hold the output string, or a negative AVERROR
|
||||
* on failure. If the returned value is bigger than buf_size, then the
|
||||
* string was truncated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_description(char *buf, size_t buf_size, enum AVChannel channel);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* bprint variant of av_channel_description().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the string will be appended to the bprint buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_channel_description_bprint(struct AVBPrint *bp, enum AVChannel channel_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This is the inverse function of @ref av_channel_name().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the channel with the given name
|
||||
* AV_CHAN_NONE when name does not identify a known channel
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVChannel av_channel_from_string(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a custom channel layout with the specified number of channels.
|
||||
* The channel map will be allocated and the designation of all channels will
|
||||
* be set to AV_CHAN_UNKNOWN.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is only a convenience helper function, a custom channel layout can also
|
||||
* be constructed without using this.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout the layout structure to be initialized
|
||||
* @param nb_channels the number of channels
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success
|
||||
* AVERROR(EINVAL) if the number of channels <= 0
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOMEM) if the channel map could not be allocated
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_custom_init(AVChannelLayout *channel_layout, int nb_channels);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a native channel layout from a bitmask indicating which channels
|
||||
* are present.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout the layout structure to be initialized
|
||||
* @param mask bitmask describing the channel layout
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success
|
||||
* AVERROR(EINVAL) for invalid mask values
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_from_mask(AVChannelLayout *channel_layout, uint64_t mask);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a channel layout from a given string description.
|
||||
* The input string can be represented by:
|
||||
* - the formal channel layout name (returned by av_channel_layout_describe())
|
||||
* - single or multiple channel names (returned by av_channel_name(), eg. "FL",
|
||||
* or concatenated with "+", each optionally containing a custom name after
|
||||
* a "@", eg. "FL@Left+FR@Right+LFE")
|
||||
* - a decimal or hexadecimal value of a native channel layout (eg. "4" or "0x4")
|
||||
* - the number of channels with default layout (eg. "4c")
|
||||
* - the number of unordered channels (eg. "4C" or "4 channels")
|
||||
* - the ambisonic order followed by optional non-diegetic channels (eg.
|
||||
* "ambisonic 2+stereo")
|
||||
* On error, the channel layout will remain uninitialized, but not necessarily
|
||||
* untouched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout uninitialized channel layout for the result
|
||||
* @param str string describing the channel layout
|
||||
* @return 0 on success parsing the channel layout
|
||||
* AVERROR(EINVAL) if an invalid channel layout string was provided
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOMEM) if there was not enough memory
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_from_string(AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
const char *str);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the default channel layout for a given number of channels.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ch_layout the layout structure to be initialized
|
||||
* @param nb_channels number of channels
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_channel_layout_default(AVChannelLayout *ch_layout, int nb_channels);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over all standard channel layouts.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param opaque a pointer where libavutil will store the iteration state. Must
|
||||
* point to NULL to start the iteration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the standard channel layout or NULL when the iteration is
|
||||
* finished
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVChannelLayout *av_channel_layout_standard(void **opaque);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free any allocated data in the channel layout and reset the channel
|
||||
* count to 0.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout the layout structure to be uninitialized
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_channel_layout_uninit(AVChannelLayout *channel_layout);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Make a copy of a channel layout. This differs from just assigning src to dst
|
||||
* in that it allocates and copies the map for AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_CUSTOM.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the destination channel_layout will be always uninitialized before copy.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst destination channel layout
|
||||
* @param src source channel layout
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_copy(AVChannelLayout *dst, const AVChannelLayout *src);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a human-readable string describing the channel layout properties.
|
||||
* The string will be in the same format that is accepted by
|
||||
* @ref av_channel_layout_from_string(), allowing to rebuild the same
|
||||
* channel layout, except for opaque pointers.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout channel layout to be described
|
||||
* @param buf pre-allocated buffer where to put the generated string
|
||||
* @param buf_size size in bytes of the buffer.
|
||||
* @return amount of bytes needed to hold the output string, or a negative AVERROR
|
||||
* on failure. If the returned value is bigger than buf_size, then the
|
||||
* string was truncated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_describe(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
char *buf, size_t buf_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* bprint variant of av_channel_layout_describe().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the string will be appended to the bprint buffer.
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, or a negative AVERROR value on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_describe_bprint(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
struct AVBPrint *bp);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the channel with the given index in a channel layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @param idx index of the channel
|
||||
* @return channel with the index idx in channel_layout on success or
|
||||
* AV_CHAN_NONE on failure (if idx is not valid or the channel order is
|
||||
* unspecified)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVChannel
|
||||
av_channel_layout_channel_from_index(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout, unsigned int idx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the index of a given channel in a channel layout. In case multiple
|
||||
* channels are found, only the first match will be returned.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @param channel the channel whose index to obtain
|
||||
* @return index of channel in channel_layout on success or a negative number if
|
||||
* channel is not present in channel_layout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_index_from_channel(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
enum AVChannel channel);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the index in a channel layout of a channel described by the given string.
|
||||
* In case multiple channels are found, only the first match will be returned.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function accepts channel names in the same format as
|
||||
* @ref av_channel_from_string().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @param name string describing the channel whose index to obtain
|
||||
* @return a channel index described by the given string, or a negative AVERROR
|
||||
* value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_index_from_string(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a channel described by the given string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function accepts channel names in the same format as
|
||||
* @ref av_channel_from_string().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @param name string describing the channel to obtain
|
||||
* @return a channel described by the given string in channel_layout on success
|
||||
* or AV_CHAN_NONE on failure (if the string is not valid or the channel
|
||||
* order is unspecified)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVChannel
|
||||
av_channel_layout_channel_from_string(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find out what channels from a given set are present in a channel layout,
|
||||
* without regard for their positions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @param mask a combination of AV_CH_* representing a set of channels
|
||||
* @return a bitfield representing all the channels from mask that are present
|
||||
* in channel_layout
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t av_channel_layout_subset(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout,
|
||||
uint64_t mask);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check whether a channel layout is valid, i.e. can possibly describe audio
|
||||
* data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout input channel layout
|
||||
* @return 1 if channel_layout is valid, 0 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_check(const AVChannelLayout *channel_layout);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check whether two channel layouts are semantically the same, i.e. the same
|
||||
* channels are present on the same positions in both.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If one of the channel layouts is AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC, while the other is
|
||||
* not, they are considered to be unequal. If both are AV_CHANNEL_ORDER_UNSPEC,
|
||||
* they are considered equal iff the channel counts are the same in both.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param chl input channel layout
|
||||
* @param chl1 input channel layout
|
||||
* @return 0 if chl and chl1 are equal, 1 if they are not equal. A negative
|
||||
* AVERROR code if one or both are invalid.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_compare(const AVChannelLayout *chl, const AVChannelLayout *chl1);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The conversion must be lossless.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_RETYPE_FLAG_LOSSLESS (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The specified retype target order is ignored and the simplest possible
|
||||
* (canonical) order is used for which the input layout can be losslessy
|
||||
* represented.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_RETYPE_FLAG_CANONICAL (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Change the AVChannelOrder of a channel layout.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Change of AVChannelOrder can be either lossless or lossy. In case of a
|
||||
* lossless conversion all the channel designations and the associated channel
|
||||
* names (if any) are kept. On a lossy conversion the channel names and channel
|
||||
* designations might be lost depending on the capabilities of the desired
|
||||
* AVChannelOrder. Note that some conversions are simply not possible in which
|
||||
* case this function returns AVERROR(ENOSYS).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The following conversions are supported:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Any -> Custom : Always possible, always lossless.
|
||||
* Any -> Unspecified: Always possible, lossless if channel designations
|
||||
* are all unknown and channel names are not used, lossy otherwise.
|
||||
* Custom -> Ambisonic : Possible if it contains ambisonic channels with
|
||||
* optional non-diegetic channels in the end. Lossy if the channels have
|
||||
* custom names, lossless otherwise.
|
||||
* Custom -> Native : Possible if it contains native channels in native
|
||||
* order. Lossy if the channels have custom names, lossless otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* On error this function keeps the original channel layout untouched.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param channel_layout channel layout which will be changed
|
||||
* @param order the desired channel layout order
|
||||
* @param flags a combination of AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_RETYPE_FLAG_* constants
|
||||
* @return 0 if the conversion was successful and lossless or if the channel
|
||||
* layout was already in the desired order
|
||||
* >0 if the conversion was successful but lossy
|
||||
* AVERROR(ENOSYS) if the conversion was not possible (or would be
|
||||
* lossy and AV_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_RETYPE_FLAG_LOSSLESS was specified)
|
||||
* AVERROR(EINVAL), AVERROR(ENOMEM) on error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_channel_layout_retype(AVChannelLayout *channel_layout, enum AVChannelOrder order, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,573 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* common internal and external API header
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_COMMON_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_COMMON_H
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__cplusplus) && !defined(__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS) && !defined(UINT64_C)
|
||||
#error missing -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS / #define __STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#include <math.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "error.h"
|
||||
#include "macros.h"
|
||||
#include "mem.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include "config.h"
|
||||
# include "intmath.h"
|
||||
# include "internal.h"
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H */
|
||||
|
||||
//rounded division & shift
|
||||
#define RSHIFT(a,b) ((a) > 0 ? ((a) + ((1<<(b))>>1))>>(b) : ((a) + ((1<<(b))>>1)-1)>>(b))
|
||||
/* assume b>0 */
|
||||
#define ROUNDED_DIV(a,b) (((a)>=0 ? (a) + ((b)>>1) : (a) - ((b)>>1))/(b))
|
||||
/* Fast a/(1<<b) rounded toward +inf. Assume a>=0 and b>=0 */
|
||||
#define AV_CEIL_RSHIFT(a,b) (!av_builtin_constant_p(b) ? -((-(a)) >> (b)) \
|
||||
: ((a) + (1<<(b)) - 1) >> (b))
|
||||
/* Backwards compat. */
|
||||
#define FF_CEIL_RSHIFT AV_CEIL_RSHIFT
|
||||
|
||||
#define FFUDIV(a,b) (((a)>0 ?(a):(a)-(b)+1) / (b))
|
||||
#define FFUMOD(a,b) ((a)-(b)*FFUDIV(a,b))
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute value, Note, INT_MIN / INT64_MIN result in undefined behavior as they
|
||||
* are not representable as absolute values of their type. This is the same
|
||||
* as with *abs()
|
||||
* @see FFNABS()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FFABS(a) ((a) >= 0 ? (a) : (-(a)))
|
||||
#define FFSIGN(a) ((a) > 0 ? 1 : -1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Negative Absolute value.
|
||||
* this works for all integers of all types.
|
||||
* As with many macros, this evaluates its argument twice, it thus must not have
|
||||
* a sideeffect, that is FFNABS(x++) has undefined behavior.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FFNABS(a) ((a) <= 0 ? (a) : (-(a)))
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Unsigned Absolute value.
|
||||
* This takes the absolute value of a signed int and returns it as a unsigned.
|
||||
* This also works with INT_MIN which would otherwise not be representable
|
||||
* As with many macros, this evaluates its argument twice.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FFABSU(a) ((a) <= 0 ? -(unsigned)(a) : (unsigned)(a))
|
||||
#define FFABS64U(a) ((a) <= 0 ? -(uint64_t)(a) : (uint64_t)(a))
|
||||
|
||||
/* misc math functions */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_ceil_log2
|
||||
# define av_ceil_log2 av_ceil_log2_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip
|
||||
# define av_clip av_clip_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip64
|
||||
# define av_clip64 av_clip64_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_uint8
|
||||
# define av_clip_uint8 av_clip_uint8_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_int8
|
||||
# define av_clip_int8 av_clip_int8_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_uint16
|
||||
# define av_clip_uint16 av_clip_uint16_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_int16
|
||||
# define av_clip_int16 av_clip_int16_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clipl_int32
|
||||
# define av_clipl_int32 av_clipl_int32_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_intp2
|
||||
# define av_clip_intp2 av_clip_intp2_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clip_uintp2
|
||||
# define av_clip_uintp2 av_clip_uintp2_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_mod_uintp2
|
||||
# define av_mod_uintp2 av_mod_uintp2_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_add32
|
||||
# define av_sat_add32 av_sat_add32_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_dadd32
|
||||
# define av_sat_dadd32 av_sat_dadd32_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_sub32
|
||||
# define av_sat_sub32 av_sat_sub32_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_dsub32
|
||||
# define av_sat_dsub32 av_sat_dsub32_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_add64
|
||||
# define av_sat_add64 av_sat_add64_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_sat_sub64
|
||||
# define av_sat_sub64 av_sat_sub64_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clipf
|
||||
# define av_clipf av_clipf_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_clipd
|
||||
# define av_clipd av_clipd_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_popcount
|
||||
# define av_popcount av_popcount_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_popcount64
|
||||
# define av_popcount64 av_popcount64_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef av_parity
|
||||
# define av_parity av_parity_c
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_log2
|
||||
av_const int av_log2(unsigned v);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef av_log2_16bit
|
||||
av_const int av_log2_16bit(unsigned v);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer value into the amin-amax range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param amin minimum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @param amax maximum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_clip_c(int a, int amin, int amax)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
|
||||
if (amin > amax) abort();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
if (a < amin) return amin;
|
||||
else if (a > amax) return amax;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed 64bit integer value into the amin-amax range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param amin minimum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @param amax maximum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int64_t av_clip64_c(int64_t a, int64_t amin, int64_t amax)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
|
||||
if (amin > amax) abort();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
if (a < amin) return amin;
|
||||
else if (a > amax) return amax;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer value into the 0-255 range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const uint8_t av_clip_uint8_c(int a)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (a&(~0xFF)) return (~a)>>31;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer value into the -128,127 range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int8_t av_clip_int8_c(int a)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if ((a+0x80U) & ~0xFF) return (a>>31) ^ 0x7F;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer value into the 0-65535 range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const uint16_t av_clip_uint16_c(int a)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (a&(~0xFFFF)) return (~a)>>31;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer value into the -32768,32767 range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int16_t av_clip_int16_c(int a)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if ((a+0x8000U) & ~0xFFFF) return (a>>31) ^ 0x7FFF;
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed 64-bit integer value into the -2147483648,2147483647 range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int32_t av_clipl_int32_c(int64_t a)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if ((a+0x80000000u) & ~UINT64_C(0xFFFFFFFF)) return (int32_t)((a>>63) ^ 0x7FFFFFFF);
|
||||
else return (int32_t)a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer into the -(2^p),(2^p-1) range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param p bit position to clip at
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_clip_intp2_c(int a, int p)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (((unsigned)a + (1 << p)) & ~((2 << p) - 1))
|
||||
return (a >> 31) ^ ((1 << p) - 1);
|
||||
else
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a signed integer to an unsigned power of two range.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param p bit position to clip at
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const unsigned av_clip_uintp2_c(int a, int p)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (a & ~((1<<p) - 1)) return (~a) >> 31 & ((1<<p) - 1);
|
||||
else return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clear high bits from an unsigned integer starting with specific bit position
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param p bit position to clip at
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const unsigned av_mod_uintp2_c(unsigned a, unsigned p)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return a & ((1U << p) - 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add two signed 32-bit values with saturation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a one value
|
||||
* @param b another value
|
||||
* @return sum with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int av_sat_add32_c(int a, int b)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_clipl_int32((int64_t)a + b);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add a doubled value to another value with saturation at both stages.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a first value
|
||||
* @param b value doubled and added to a
|
||||
* @return sum sat(a + sat(2*b)) with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int av_sat_dadd32_c(int a, int b)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_sat_add32(a, av_sat_add32(b, b));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtract two signed 32-bit values with saturation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a one value
|
||||
* @param b another value
|
||||
* @return difference with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int av_sat_sub32_c(int a, int b)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_clipl_int32((int64_t)a - b);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtract a doubled value from another value with saturation at both stages.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a first value
|
||||
* @param b value doubled and subtracted from a
|
||||
* @return difference sat(a - sat(2*b)) with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int av_sat_dsub32_c(int a, int b)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_sat_sub32(a, av_sat_add32(b, b));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add two signed 64-bit values with saturation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a one value
|
||||
* @param b another value
|
||||
* @return sum with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int64_t av_sat_add64_c(int64_t a, int64_t b) {
|
||||
#if (!defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) && AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(5,1)) || AV_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_add_overflow)
|
||||
int64_t tmp;
|
||||
return !__builtin_add_overflow(a, b, &tmp) ? tmp : (tmp < 0 ? INT64_MAX : INT64_MIN);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
int64_t s = a+(uint64_t)b;
|
||||
if ((int64_t)(a^b | ~s^b) >= 0)
|
||||
return INT64_MAX ^ (b >> 63);
|
||||
return s;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subtract two signed 64-bit values with saturation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param a one value
|
||||
* @param b another value
|
||||
* @return difference with signed saturation
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline int64_t av_sat_sub64_c(int64_t a, int64_t b) {
|
||||
#if (!defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) && AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(5,1)) || AV_HAS_BUILTIN(__builtin_sub_overflow)
|
||||
int64_t tmp;
|
||||
return !__builtin_sub_overflow(a, b, &tmp) ? tmp : (tmp < 0 ? INT64_MAX : INT64_MIN);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
if (b <= 0 && a >= INT64_MAX + b)
|
||||
return INT64_MAX;
|
||||
if (b >= 0 && a <= INT64_MIN + b)
|
||||
return INT64_MIN;
|
||||
return a - b;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a float value into the amin-amax range.
|
||||
* If a is nan or -inf amin will be returned.
|
||||
* If a is +inf amax will be returned.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param amin minimum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @param amax maximum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const float av_clipf_c(float a, float amin, float amax)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
|
||||
if (amin > amax) abort();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
return FFMIN(FFMAX(a, amin), amax);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Clip a double value into the amin-amax range.
|
||||
* If a is nan or -inf amin will be returned.
|
||||
* If a is +inf amax will be returned.
|
||||
* @param a value to clip
|
||||
* @param amin minimum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @param amax maximum value of the clip range
|
||||
* @return clipped value
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const double av_clipd_c(double a, double amin, double amax)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
|
||||
if (amin > amax) abort();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
return FFMIN(FFMAX(a, amin), amax);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/** Compute ceil(log2(x)).
|
||||
* @param x value used to compute ceil(log2(x))
|
||||
* @return computed ceiling of log2(x)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_ceil_log2_c(int x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_log2((x - 1U) << 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Count number of bits set to one in x
|
||||
* @param x value to count bits of
|
||||
* @return the number of bits set to one in x
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_popcount_c(uint32_t x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
x -= (x >> 1) & 0x55555555;
|
||||
x = (x & 0x33333333) + ((x >> 2) & 0x33333333);
|
||||
x = (x + (x >> 4)) & 0x0F0F0F0F;
|
||||
x += x >> 8;
|
||||
return (x + (x >> 16)) & 0x3F;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Count number of bits set to one in x
|
||||
* @param x value to count bits of
|
||||
* @return the number of bits set to one in x
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_popcount64_c(uint64_t x)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_popcount((uint32_t)x) + av_popcount((uint32_t)(x >> 32));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static av_always_inline av_const int av_parity_c(uint32_t v)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return av_popcount(v) & 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert a UTF-8 character (up to 4 bytes) to its 32-bit UCS-4 encoded form.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param val Output value, must be an lvalue of type uint32_t.
|
||||
* @param GET_BYTE Expression reading one byte from the input.
|
||||
* Evaluated up to 7 times (4 for the currently
|
||||
* assigned Unicode range). With a memory buffer
|
||||
* input, this could be *ptr++, or if you want to make sure
|
||||
* that *ptr stops at the end of a NULL terminated string then
|
||||
* *ptr ? *ptr++ : 0
|
||||
* @param ERROR Expression to be evaluated on invalid input,
|
||||
* typically a goto statement.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning ERROR should not contain a loop control statement which
|
||||
* could interact with the internal while loop, and should force an
|
||||
* exit from the macro code (e.g. through a goto or a return) in order
|
||||
* to prevent undefined results.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define GET_UTF8(val, GET_BYTE, ERROR)\
|
||||
val= (GET_BYTE);\
|
||||
{\
|
||||
uint32_t top = (val & 128) >> 1;\
|
||||
if ((val & 0xc0) == 0x80 || val >= 0xFE)\
|
||||
{ERROR}\
|
||||
while (val & top) {\
|
||||
unsigned int tmp = (GET_BYTE) - 128;\
|
||||
if(tmp>>6)\
|
||||
{ERROR}\
|
||||
val= (val<<6) + tmp;\
|
||||
top <<= 5;\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
val &= (top << 1) - 1;\
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert a UTF-16 character (2 or 4 bytes) to its 32-bit UCS-4 encoded form.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param val Output value, must be an lvalue of type uint32_t.
|
||||
* @param GET_16BIT Expression returning two bytes of UTF-16 data converted
|
||||
* to native byte order. Evaluated one or two times.
|
||||
* @param ERROR Expression to be evaluated on invalid input,
|
||||
* typically a goto statement.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define GET_UTF16(val, GET_16BIT, ERROR)\
|
||||
val = (GET_16BIT);\
|
||||
{\
|
||||
unsigned int hi = val - 0xD800;\
|
||||
if (hi < 0x800) {\
|
||||
val = (GET_16BIT) - 0xDC00;\
|
||||
if (val > 0x3FFU || hi > 0x3FFU)\
|
||||
{ERROR}\
|
||||
val += (hi<<10) + 0x10000;\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @def PUT_UTF8(val, tmp, PUT_BYTE)
|
||||
* Convert a 32-bit Unicode character to its UTF-8 encoded form (up to 4 bytes long).
|
||||
* @param val is an input-only argument and should be of type uint32_t. It holds
|
||||
* a UCS-4 encoded Unicode character that is to be converted to UTF-8. If
|
||||
* val is given as a function it is executed only once.
|
||||
* @param tmp is a temporary variable and should be of type uint8_t. It
|
||||
* represents an intermediate value during conversion that is to be
|
||||
* output by PUT_BYTE.
|
||||
* @param PUT_BYTE writes the converted UTF-8 bytes to any proper destination.
|
||||
* It could be a function or a statement, and uses tmp as the input byte.
|
||||
* For example, PUT_BYTE could be "*output++ = tmp;" PUT_BYTE will be
|
||||
* executed up to 4 times for values in the valid UTF-8 range and up to
|
||||
* 7 times in the general case, depending on the length of the converted
|
||||
* Unicode character.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define PUT_UTF8(val, tmp, PUT_BYTE)\
|
||||
{\
|
||||
int bytes, shift;\
|
||||
uint32_t in = val;\
|
||||
if (in < 0x80) {\
|
||||
tmp = in;\
|
||||
PUT_BYTE\
|
||||
} else {\
|
||||
bytes = (av_log2(in) + 4) / 5;\
|
||||
shift = (bytes - 1) * 6;\
|
||||
tmp = (256 - (256 >> bytes)) | (in >> shift);\
|
||||
PUT_BYTE\
|
||||
while (shift >= 6) {\
|
||||
shift -= 6;\
|
||||
tmp = 0x80 | ((in >> shift) & 0x3f);\
|
||||
PUT_BYTE\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @def PUT_UTF16(val, tmp, PUT_16BIT)
|
||||
* Convert a 32-bit Unicode character to its UTF-16 encoded form (2 or 4 bytes).
|
||||
* @param val is an input-only argument and should be of type uint32_t. It holds
|
||||
* a UCS-4 encoded Unicode character that is to be converted to UTF-16. If
|
||||
* val is given as a function it is executed only once.
|
||||
* @param tmp is a temporary variable and should be of type uint16_t. It
|
||||
* represents an intermediate value during conversion that is to be
|
||||
* output by PUT_16BIT.
|
||||
* @param PUT_16BIT writes the converted UTF-16 data to any proper destination
|
||||
* in desired endianness. It could be a function or a statement, and uses tmp
|
||||
* as the input byte. For example, PUT_BYTE could be "*output++ = tmp;"
|
||||
* PUT_BYTE will be executed 1 or 2 times depending on input character.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define PUT_UTF16(val, tmp, PUT_16BIT)\
|
||||
{\
|
||||
uint32_t in = val;\
|
||||
if (in < 0x10000) {\
|
||||
tmp = in;\
|
||||
PUT_16BIT\
|
||||
} else {\
|
||||
tmp = 0xD800 | ((in - 0x10000) >> 10);\
|
||||
PUT_16BIT\
|
||||
tmp = 0xDC00 | ((in - 0x10000) & 0x3FF);\
|
||||
PUT_16BIT\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
}\
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_COMMON_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2000, 2001, 2002 Fabrice Bellard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CPU_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CPU_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FORCE 0x80000000 /* force usage of selected flags (OR) */
|
||||
|
||||
/* lower 16 bits - CPU features */
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMX 0x0001 ///< standard MMX
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMXEXT 0x0002 ///< SSE integer functions or AMD MMX ext
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMX2 0x0002 ///< SSE integer functions or AMD MMX ext
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_3DNOW 0x0004 ///< AMD 3DNOW
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE 0x0008 ///< SSE functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE2 0x0010 ///< PIV SSE2 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE2SLOW 0x40000000 ///< SSE2 supported, but usually not faster
|
||||
///< than regular MMX/SSE (e.g. Core1)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_3DNOWEXT 0x0020 ///< AMD 3DNowExt
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE3 0x0040 ///< Prescott SSE3 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE3SLOW 0x20000000 ///< SSE3 supported, but usually not faster
|
||||
///< than regular MMX/SSE (e.g. Core1)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSSE3 0x0080 ///< Conroe SSSE3 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSSE3SLOW 0x4000000 ///< SSSE3 supported, but usually not faster
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ATOM 0x10000000 ///< Atom processor, some SSSE3 instructions are slower
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE4 0x0100 ///< Penryn SSE4.1 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE42 0x0200 ///< Nehalem SSE4.2 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AESNI 0x80000 ///< Advanced Encryption Standard functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX 0x4000 ///< AVX functions: requires OS support even if YMM registers aren't used
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVXSLOW 0x8000000 ///< AVX supported, but slow when using YMM registers (e.g. Bulldozer)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_XOP 0x0400 ///< Bulldozer XOP functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FMA4 0x0800 ///< Bulldozer FMA4 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_CMOV 0x1000 ///< supports cmov instruction
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX2 0x8000 ///< AVX2 functions: requires OS support even if YMM registers aren't used
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FMA3 0x10000 ///< Haswell FMA3 functions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_BMI1 0x20000 ///< Bit Manipulation Instruction Set 1
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_BMI2 0x40000 ///< Bit Manipulation Instruction Set 2
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX512 0x100000 ///< AVX-512 functions: requires OS support even if YMM/ZMM registers aren't used
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX512ICL 0x200000 ///< F/CD/BW/DQ/VL/VNNI/IFMA/VBMI/VBMI2/VPOPCNTDQ/BITALG/GFNI/VAES/VPCLMULQDQ
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SLOW_GATHER 0x2000000 ///< CPU has slow gathers.
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ALTIVEC 0x0001 ///< standard
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VSX 0x0002 ///< ISA 2.06
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_POWER8 0x0004 ///< ISA 2.07
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV5TE (1 << 0)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV6 (1 << 1)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV6T2 (1 << 2)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFP (1 << 3)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFPV3 (1 << 4)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_NEON (1 << 5)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV8 (1 << 6)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFP_VM (1 << 7) ///< VFPv2 vector mode, deprecated in ARMv7-A and unavailable in various CPUs implementations
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_DOTPROD (1 << 8)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_I8MM (1 << 9)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SETEND (1 <<16)
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMI (1 << 0)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MSA (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
//Loongarch SIMD extension.
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_LSX (1 << 0)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_LASX (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
// RISC-V extensions
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVI (1 << 0) ///< I (full GPR bank)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVF (1 << 1) ///< F (single precision FP)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVD (1 << 2) ///< D (double precision FP)
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVV_I32 (1 << 3) ///< Vectors of 8/16/32-bit int's */
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVV_F32 (1 << 4) ///< Vectors of float's */
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVV_I64 (1 << 5) ///< Vectors of 64-bit int's */
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVV_F64 (1 << 6) ///< Vectors of double's
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVB_BASIC (1 << 7) ///< Basic bit-manipulations
|
||||
#define AV_CPU_FLAG_RVB_ADDR (1 << 8) ///< Address bit-manipulations
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the flags which specify extensions supported by the CPU.
|
||||
* The returned value is affected by av_force_cpu_flags() if that was used
|
||||
* before. So av_get_cpu_flags() can easily be used in an application to
|
||||
* detect the enabled cpu flags.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_get_cpu_flags(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Disables cpu detection and forces the specified flags.
|
||||
* -1 is a special case that disables forcing of specific flags.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_force_cpu_flags(int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse CPU caps from a string and update the given AV_CPU_* flags based on that.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return negative on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_parse_cpu_caps(unsigned *flags, const char *s);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return the number of logical CPU cores present.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_cpu_count(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Overrides cpu count detection and forces the specified count.
|
||||
* Count < 1 disables forcing of specific count.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_cpu_force_count(int count);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the maximum data alignment that may be required by FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that this is affected by the build configuration and the CPU flags mask,
|
||||
* so e.g. if the CPU supports AVX, but libavutil has been built with
|
||||
* --disable-avx or the AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX flag has been disabled through
|
||||
* av_set_cpu_flags_mask(), then this function will behave as if AVX is not
|
||||
* present.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_cpu_max_align(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CPU_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crc32
|
||||
* Public header for CRC hash function implementation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CRC_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CRC_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_crc32 CRC
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_hash
|
||||
* CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) hash function implementation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This module supports numerous CRC polynomials, in addition to the most
|
||||
* widely used CRC-32-IEEE. See @ref AVCRCId for a list of available
|
||||
* polynomials.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef uint32_t AVCRC;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef enum {
|
||||
AV_CRC_8_ATM,
|
||||
AV_CRC_16_ANSI,
|
||||
AV_CRC_16_CCITT,
|
||||
AV_CRC_32_IEEE,
|
||||
AV_CRC_32_IEEE_LE, /*< reversed bitorder version of AV_CRC_32_IEEE */
|
||||
AV_CRC_16_ANSI_LE, /*< reversed bitorder version of AV_CRC_16_ANSI */
|
||||
AV_CRC_24_IEEE,
|
||||
AV_CRC_8_EBU,
|
||||
AV_CRC_MAX, /*< Not part of public API! Do not use outside libavutil. */
|
||||
}AVCRCId;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a CRC table.
|
||||
* @param ctx must be an array of size sizeof(AVCRC)*257 or sizeof(AVCRC)*1024
|
||||
* @param le If 1, the lowest bit represents the coefficient for the highest
|
||||
* exponent of the corresponding polynomial (both for poly and
|
||||
* actual CRC).
|
||||
* If 0, you must swap the CRC parameter and the result of av_crc
|
||||
* if you need the standard representation (can be simplified in
|
||||
* most cases to e.g. bswap16):
|
||||
* av_bswap32(crc << (32-bits))
|
||||
* @param bits number of bits for the CRC
|
||||
* @param poly generator polynomial without the x**bits coefficient, in the
|
||||
* representation as specified by le
|
||||
* @param ctx_size size of ctx in bytes
|
||||
* @return <0 on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_crc_init(AVCRC *ctx, int le, int bits, uint32_t poly, int ctx_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get an initialized standard CRC table.
|
||||
* @param crc_id ID of a standard CRC
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the CRC table or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVCRC *av_crc_get_table(AVCRCId crc_id);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Calculate the CRC of a block.
|
||||
* @param ctx initialized AVCRC array (see av_crc_init())
|
||||
* @param crc CRC of previous blocks if any or initial value for CRC
|
||||
* @param buffer buffer whose CRC to calculate
|
||||
* @param length length of the buffer
|
||||
* @return CRC updated with the data from the given block
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_crc_init() "le" parameter
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t av_crc(const AVCRC *ctx, uint32_t crc,
|
||||
const uint8_t *buffer, size_t length) av_pure;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CRC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,150 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2015 Kevin Wheatley <kevin.j.wheatley@gmail.com>
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2016 Ronald S. Bultje <rsbultje@gmail.com>
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2023 Leo Izen <leo.izen@gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_CSP_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_CSP_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Colorspace value utility functions for libavutil.
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_math_csp
|
||||
* @author Ronald S. Bultje <rsbultje@gmail.com>
|
||||
* @author Leo Izen <leo.izen@gmail.com>
|
||||
* @author Kevin Wheatley <kevin.j.wheatley@gmail.com>
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_math_csp Colorspace Utility
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_math
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Struct containing luma coefficients to be used for RGB to YUV/YCoCg, or similar
|
||||
* calculations.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVLumaCoefficients {
|
||||
AVRational cr, cg, cb;
|
||||
} AVLumaCoefficients;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Struct containing chromaticity x and y values for the standard CIE 1931
|
||||
* chromaticity definition.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCIExy {
|
||||
AVRational x, y;
|
||||
} AVCIExy;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Struct defining the red, green, and blue primary locations in terms of CIE
|
||||
* 1931 chromaticity x and y.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVPrimaryCoefficients {
|
||||
AVCIExy r, g, b;
|
||||
} AVPrimaryCoefficients;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Struct defining white point location in terms of CIE 1931 chromaticity x
|
||||
* and y.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef AVCIExy AVWhitepointCoefficients;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Struct that contains both white point location and primaries location, providing
|
||||
* the complete description of a color gamut.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVColorPrimariesDesc {
|
||||
AVWhitepointCoefficients wp;
|
||||
AVPrimaryCoefficients prim;
|
||||
} AVColorPrimariesDesc;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Function pointer representing a double -> double transfer function that performs
|
||||
* an EOTF transfer inversion. This function outputs linear light.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef double (*av_csp_trc_function)(double);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Retrieves the Luma coefficients necessary to construct a conversion matrix
|
||||
* from an enum constant describing the colorspace.
|
||||
* @param csp An enum constant indicating YUV or similar colorspace.
|
||||
* @return The Luma coefficients associated with that colorspace, or NULL
|
||||
* if the constant is unknown to libavutil.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVLumaCoefficients *av_csp_luma_coeffs_from_avcsp(enum AVColorSpace csp);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Retrieves a complete gamut description from an enum constant describing the
|
||||
* color primaries.
|
||||
* @param prm An enum constant indicating primaries
|
||||
* @return A description of the colorspace gamut associated with that enum
|
||||
* constant, or NULL if the constant is unknown to libavutil.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVColorPrimariesDesc *av_csp_primaries_desc_from_id(enum AVColorPrimaries prm);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Detects which enum AVColorPrimaries constant corresponds to the given complete
|
||||
* gamut description.
|
||||
* @see enum AVColorPrimaries
|
||||
* @param prm A description of the colorspace gamut
|
||||
* @return The enum constant associated with this gamut, or
|
||||
* AVCOL_PRI_UNSPECIFIED if no clear match can be idenitified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVColorPrimaries av_csp_primaries_id_from_desc(const AVColorPrimariesDesc *prm);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Determine a suitable 'gamma' value to match the supplied
|
||||
* AVColorTransferCharacteristic.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* See Apple Technical Note TN2257 (https://developer.apple.com/library/mac/technotes/tn2257/_index.html)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function returns the gamma exponent for the OETF. For example, sRGB is approximated
|
||||
* by gamma 2.2, not by gamma 0.45455.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Will return an approximation to the simple gamma function matching
|
||||
* the supplied Transfer Characteristic, Will return 0.0 for any
|
||||
* we cannot reasonably match against.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double av_csp_approximate_trc_gamma(enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic trc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Determine the function needed to apply the given
|
||||
* AVColorTransferCharacteristic to linear input.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The function returned should expect a nominal domain and range of [0.0-1.0]
|
||||
* values outside of this range maybe valid depending on the chosen
|
||||
* characteristic function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Will return pointer to the function matching the
|
||||
* supplied Transfer Characteristic. If unspecified will
|
||||
* return NULL:
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_csp_trc_function av_csp_trc_func_from_id(enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic trc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_CSP_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* DES encryption/decryption
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Reimar Doeffinger
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DES_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DES_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_des DES
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDES {
|
||||
uint64_t round_keys[3][16];
|
||||
int triple_des;
|
||||
} AVDES;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVDES context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDES *av_des_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief Initializes an AVDES context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param d pointer to a AVDES structure to initialize
|
||||
* @param key pointer to the key to use
|
||||
* @param key_bits must be 64 or 192
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption/CBC-MAC, 1 for decryption
|
||||
* @return zero on success, negative value otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_des_init(struct AVDES *d, const uint8_t *key, int key_bits, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief Encrypts / decrypts using the DES algorithm.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param d pointer to the AVDES structure
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src, must be 8-byte aligned
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst, must be 8-byte aligned, may be NULL
|
||||
* @param count number of 8 byte blocks
|
||||
* @param iv initialization vector for CBC mode, if NULL then ECB will be used,
|
||||
* must be 8-byte aligned
|
||||
* @param decrypt 0 for encryption, 1 for decryption
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_des_crypt(struct AVDES *d, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count, uint8_t *iv, int decrypt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief Calculates CBC-MAC using the DES algorithm.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param d pointer to the AVDES structure
|
||||
* @param dst destination array, can be equal to src, must be 8-byte aligned
|
||||
* @param src source array, can be equal to dst, must be 8-byte aligned, may be NULL
|
||||
* @param count number of 8 byte blocks
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_des_mac(struct AVDES *d, uint8_t *dst, const uint8_t *src, int count);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_DES_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DETECTION_BBOX_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DETECTION_BBOX_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
#include "avassert.h"
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDetectionBBox {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Distance in pixels from the left/top edge of the frame,
|
||||
* together with width and height, defining the bounding box.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int x;
|
||||
int y;
|
||||
int w;
|
||||
int h;
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_DETECTION_BBOX_LABEL_NAME_MAX_SIZE 64
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Detect result with confidence
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char detect_label[AV_DETECTION_BBOX_LABEL_NAME_MAX_SIZE];
|
||||
AVRational detect_confidence;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* At most 4 classifications based on the detected bounding box.
|
||||
* For example, we can get max 4 different attributes with 4 different
|
||||
* DNN models on one bounding box.
|
||||
* classify_count is zero if no classification.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_NUM_DETECTION_BBOX_CLASSIFY 4
|
||||
uint32_t classify_count;
|
||||
char classify_labels[AV_NUM_DETECTION_BBOX_CLASSIFY][AV_DETECTION_BBOX_LABEL_NAME_MAX_SIZE];
|
||||
AVRational classify_confidences[AV_NUM_DETECTION_BBOX_CLASSIFY];
|
||||
} AVDetectionBBox;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDetectionBBoxHeader {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Information about how the bounding box is generated.
|
||||
* for example, the DNN model name.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char source[256];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of bounding boxes in the array.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t nb_bboxes;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset in bytes from the beginning of this structure at which
|
||||
* the array of bounding boxes starts.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t bboxes_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Size of each bounding box in bytes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t bbox_size;
|
||||
} AVDetectionBBoxHeader;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Get the bounding box at the specified {@code idx}. Must be between 0 and nb_bboxes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline AVDetectionBBox *
|
||||
av_get_detection_bbox(const AVDetectionBBoxHeader *header, unsigned int idx)
|
||||
{
|
||||
av_assert0(idx < header->nb_bboxes);
|
||||
return (AVDetectionBBox *)((uint8_t *)header + header->bboxes_offset +
|
||||
idx * header->bbox_size);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates memory for AVDetectionBBoxHeader, plus an array of {@code nb_bboxes}
|
||||
* AVDetectionBBox, and initializes the variables.
|
||||
* Can be freed with a normal av_free() call.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param nb_bboxes number of AVDetectionBBox structures to allocate
|
||||
* @param out_size if non-NULL, the size in bytes of the resulting data array is
|
||||
* written here.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDetectionBBoxHeader *av_detection_bbox_alloc(uint32_t nb_bboxes, size_t *out_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates memory for AVDetectionBBoxHeader, plus an array of {@code nb_bboxes}
|
||||
* AVDetectionBBox, in the given AVFrame {@code frame} as AVFrameSideData of type
|
||||
* AV_FRAME_DATA_DETECTION_BBOXES and initializes the variables.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDetectionBBoxHeader *av_detection_bbox_create_side_data(AVFrame *frame, uint32_t nb_bboxes);
|
||||
#endif
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,241 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Public dictionary API.
|
||||
* @deprecated
|
||||
* AVDictionary is provided for compatibility with libav. It is both in
|
||||
* implementation as well as API inefficient. It does not scale and is
|
||||
* extremely slow with large dictionaries.
|
||||
* It is recommended that new code uses our tree container from tree.c/h
|
||||
* where applicable, which uses AVL trees to achieve O(log n) performance.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DICT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DICT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_dict AVDictionary
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_data
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @brief Simple key:value store
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* Dictionaries are used for storing key-value pairs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* - To **create an AVDictionary**, simply pass an address of a NULL
|
||||
* pointer to av_dict_set(). NULL can be used as an empty dictionary
|
||||
* wherever a pointer to an AVDictionary is required.
|
||||
* - To **insert an entry**, use av_dict_set().
|
||||
* - Use av_dict_get() to **retrieve an entry**.
|
||||
* - To **iterate over all entries**, use av_dict_iterate().
|
||||
* - In order to **free the dictionary and all its contents**, use av_dict_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
@code
|
||||
AVDictionary *d = NULL; // "create" an empty dictionary
|
||||
AVDictionaryEntry *t = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
av_dict_set(&d, "foo", "bar", 0); // add an entry
|
||||
|
||||
char *k = av_strdup("key"); // if your strings are already allocated,
|
||||
char *v = av_strdup("value"); // you can avoid copying them like this
|
||||
av_dict_set(&d, k, v, AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY | AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL);
|
||||
|
||||
while ((t = av_dict_iterate(d, t))) {
|
||||
<....> // iterate over all entries in d
|
||||
}
|
||||
av_dict_free(&d);
|
||||
@endcode
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @name AVDictionary Flags
|
||||
* Flags that influence behavior of the matching of keys or insertion to the dictionary.
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_MATCH_CASE 1 /**< Only get an entry with exact-case key match. Only relevant in av_dict_get(). */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX 2 /**< Return first entry in a dictionary whose first part corresponds to the search key,
|
||||
ignoring the suffix of the found key string. Only relevant in av_dict_get(). */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY 4 /**< Take ownership of a key that's been
|
||||
allocated with av_malloc() or another memory allocation function. */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL 8 /**< Take ownership of a value that's been
|
||||
allocated with av_malloc() or another memory allocation function. */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_DONT_OVERWRITE 16 /**< Don't overwrite existing entries. */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_APPEND 32 /**< If the entry already exists, append to it. Note that no
|
||||
delimiter is added, the strings are simply concatenated. */
|
||||
#define AV_DICT_MULTIKEY 64 /**< Allow to store several equal keys in the dictionary */
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDictionaryEntry {
|
||||
char *key;
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
} AVDictionaryEntry;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDictionary AVDictionary;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a dictionary entry with matching key.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The returned entry key or value must not be changed, or it will
|
||||
* cause undefined behavior.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param prev Set to the previous matching element to find the next.
|
||||
* If set to NULL the first matching element is returned.
|
||||
* @param key Matching key
|
||||
* @param flags A collection of AV_DICT_* flags controlling how the
|
||||
* entry is retrieved
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Found entry or NULL in case no matching entry was found in the dictionary
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDictionaryEntry *av_dict_get(const AVDictionary *m, const char *key,
|
||||
const AVDictionaryEntry *prev, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over a dictionary
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Iterates through all entries in the dictionary.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning The returned AVDictionaryEntry key/value must not be changed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning As av_dict_set() invalidates all previous entries returned
|
||||
* by this function, it must not be called while iterating over the dict.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Typical usage:
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* const AVDictionaryEntry *e = NULL;
|
||||
* while ((e = av_dict_iterate(m, e))) {
|
||||
* // ...
|
||||
* }
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param m The dictionary to iterate over
|
||||
* @param prev Pointer to the previous AVDictionaryEntry, NULL initially
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @retval AVDictionaryEntry* The next element in the dictionary
|
||||
* @retval NULL No more elements in the dictionary
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVDictionaryEntry *av_dict_iterate(const AVDictionary *m,
|
||||
const AVDictionaryEntry *prev);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get number of entries in dictionary.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param m dictionary
|
||||
* @return number of entries in dictionary
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_count(const AVDictionary *m);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the given entry in *pm, overwriting an existing entry.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note: If AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY or AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL is set,
|
||||
* these arguments will be freed on error.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning Adding a new entry to a dictionary invalidates all existing entries
|
||||
* previously returned with av_dict_get() or av_dict_iterate().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pm Pointer to a pointer to a dictionary struct. If *pm is NULL
|
||||
* a dictionary struct is allocated and put in *pm.
|
||||
* @param key Entry key to add to *pm (will either be av_strduped or added as a new key depending on flags)
|
||||
* @param value Entry value to add to *pm (will be av_strduped or added as a new key depending on flags).
|
||||
* Passing a NULL value will cause an existing entry to be deleted.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success otherwise an error code <0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_set(AVDictionary **pm, const char *key, const char *value, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenience wrapper for av_dict_set() that converts the value to a string
|
||||
* and stores it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note: If ::AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY is set, key will be freed on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_set_int(AVDictionary **pm, const char *key, int64_t value, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse the key/value pairs list and add the parsed entries to a dictionary.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In case of failure, all the successfully set entries are stored in
|
||||
* *pm. You may need to manually free the created dictionary.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param key_val_sep A 0-terminated list of characters used to separate
|
||||
* key from value
|
||||
* @param pairs_sep A 0-terminated list of characters used to separate
|
||||
* two pairs from each other
|
||||
* @param flags Flags to use when adding to the dictionary.
|
||||
* ::AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY and ::AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL
|
||||
* are ignored since the key/value tokens will always
|
||||
* be duplicated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_parse_string(AVDictionary **pm, const char *str,
|
||||
const char *key_val_sep, const char *pairs_sep,
|
||||
int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy entries from one AVDictionary struct into another.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note Metadata is read using the ::AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX flag
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst Pointer to a pointer to a AVDictionary struct to copy into. If *dst is NULL,
|
||||
* this function will allocate a struct for you and put it in *dst
|
||||
* @param src Pointer to the source AVDictionary struct to copy items from.
|
||||
* @param flags Flags to use when setting entries in *dst
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, negative AVERROR code on failure. If dst was allocated
|
||||
* by this function, callers should free the associated memory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_copy(AVDictionary **dst, const AVDictionary *src, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free all the memory allocated for an AVDictionary struct
|
||||
* and all keys and values.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_dict_free(AVDictionary **m);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get dictionary entries as a string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Create a string containing dictionary's entries.
|
||||
* Such string may be passed back to av_dict_parse_string().
|
||||
* @note String is escaped with backslashes ('\').
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning Separators cannot be neither '\\' nor '\0'. They also cannot be the same.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] m The dictionary
|
||||
* @param[out] buffer Pointer to buffer that will be allocated with string containg entries.
|
||||
* Buffer must be freed by the caller when is no longer needed.
|
||||
* @param[in] key_val_sep Character used to separate key from value
|
||||
* @param[in] pairs_sep Character used to separate two pairs from each other
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success, negative on error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dict_get_string(const AVDictionary *m, char **buffer,
|
||||
const char key_val_sep, const char pairs_sep);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_DICT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2014 Vittorio Giovara <vittorio.giovara@gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_video_display
|
||||
* Display matrix
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DISPLAY_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DISPLAY_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_video_display Display transformation matrix functions
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_video
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The display transformation matrix specifies an affine transformation that
|
||||
* should be applied to video frames for correct presentation. It is compatible
|
||||
* with the matrices stored in the ISO/IEC 14496-12 container format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The data is a 3x3 matrix represented as a 9-element array:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @code{.unparsed}
|
||||
* | a b u |
|
||||
* (a, b, u, c, d, v, x, y, w) -> | c d v |
|
||||
* | x y w |
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* All numbers are stored in native endianness, as 16.16 fixed-point values,
|
||||
* except for u, v and w, which are stored as 2.30 fixed-point values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The transformation maps a point (p, q) in the source (pre-transformation)
|
||||
* frame to the point (p', q') in the destination (post-transformation) frame as
|
||||
* follows:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @code{.unparsed}
|
||||
* | a b u |
|
||||
* (p, q, 1) . | c d v | = z * (p', q', 1)
|
||||
* | x y w |
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The transformation can also be more explicitly written in components as
|
||||
* follows:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @code{.unparsed}
|
||||
* p' = (a * p + c * q + x) / z;
|
||||
* q' = (b * p + d * q + y) / z;
|
||||
* z = u * p + v * q + w
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extract the rotation component of the transformation matrix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param matrix the transformation matrix
|
||||
* @return the angle (in degrees) by which the transformation rotates the frame
|
||||
* counterclockwise. The angle will be in range [-180.0, 180.0],
|
||||
* or NaN if the matrix is singular.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note floating point numbers are inherently inexact, so callers are
|
||||
* recommended to round the return value to nearest integer before use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double av_display_rotation_get(const int32_t matrix[9]);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize a transformation matrix describing a pure clockwise
|
||||
* rotation by the specified angle (in degrees).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[out] matrix a transformation matrix (will be fully overwritten
|
||||
* by this function)
|
||||
* @param angle rotation angle in degrees.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_display_rotation_set(int32_t matrix[9], double angle);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Flip the input matrix horizontally and/or vertically.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] matrix a transformation matrix
|
||||
* @param hflip whether the matrix should be flipped horizontally
|
||||
* @param vflip whether the matrix should be flipped vertically
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_display_matrix_flip(int32_t matrix[9], int hflip, int vflip);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_DISPLAY_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,236 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2020 Vacing Fang <vacingfang@tencent.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* DOVI configuration
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DOVI_META_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DOVI_META_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* DOVI configuration
|
||||
* ref: dolby-vision-bitstreams-within-the-iso-base-media-file-format-v2.1.2
|
||||
dolby-vision-bitstreams-in-mpeg-2-transport-stream-multiplex-v1.2
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* uint8_t dv_version_major, the major version number that the stream complies with
|
||||
* uint8_t dv_version_minor, the minor version number that the stream complies with
|
||||
* uint8_t dv_profile, the Dolby Vision profile
|
||||
* uint8_t dv_level, the Dolby Vision level
|
||||
* uint8_t rpu_present_flag
|
||||
* uint8_t el_present_flag
|
||||
* uint8_t bl_present_flag
|
||||
* uint8_t dv_bl_signal_compatibility_id
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct must be allocated with av_dovi_alloc() and
|
||||
* its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIDecoderConfigurationRecord {
|
||||
uint8_t dv_version_major;
|
||||
uint8_t dv_version_minor;
|
||||
uint8_t dv_profile;
|
||||
uint8_t dv_level;
|
||||
uint8_t rpu_present_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t el_present_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t bl_present_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t dv_bl_signal_compatibility_id;
|
||||
} AVDOVIDecoderConfigurationRecord;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a AVDOVIDecoderConfigurationRecord structure and initialize its
|
||||
* fields to default values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the newly allocated struct or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDOVIDecoderConfigurationRecord *av_dovi_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dolby Vision RPU data header.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note sizeof(AVDOVIRpuDataHeader) is not part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIRpuDataHeader {
|
||||
uint8_t rpu_type;
|
||||
uint16_t rpu_format;
|
||||
uint8_t vdr_rpu_profile;
|
||||
uint8_t vdr_rpu_level;
|
||||
uint8_t chroma_resampling_explicit_filter_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t coef_data_type; /* informative, lavc always converts to fixed */
|
||||
uint8_t coef_log2_denom;
|
||||
uint8_t vdr_rpu_normalized_idc;
|
||||
uint8_t bl_video_full_range_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t bl_bit_depth; /* [8, 16] */
|
||||
uint8_t el_bit_depth; /* [8, 16] */
|
||||
uint8_t vdr_bit_depth; /* [8, 16] */
|
||||
uint8_t spatial_resampling_filter_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t el_spatial_resampling_filter_flag;
|
||||
uint8_t disable_residual_flag;
|
||||
} AVDOVIRpuDataHeader;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVDOVIMappingMethod {
|
||||
AV_DOVI_MAPPING_POLYNOMIAL = 0,
|
||||
AV_DOVI_MAPPING_MMR = 1,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Coefficients of a piece-wise function. The pieces of the function span the
|
||||
* value ranges between two adjacent pivot values.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES 8
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIReshapingCurve {
|
||||
uint8_t num_pivots; /* [2, 9] */
|
||||
uint16_t pivots[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES + 1]; /* sorted ascending */
|
||||
enum AVDOVIMappingMethod mapping_idc[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES];
|
||||
/* AV_DOVI_MAPPING_POLYNOMIAL */
|
||||
uint8_t poly_order[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES]; /* [1, 2] */
|
||||
int64_t poly_coef[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES][3]; /* x^0, x^1, x^2 */
|
||||
/* AV_DOVI_MAPPING_MMR */
|
||||
uint8_t mmr_order[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES]; /* [1, 3] */
|
||||
int64_t mmr_constant[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES];
|
||||
int64_t mmr_coef[AV_DOVI_MAX_PIECES][3/* order - 1 */][7];
|
||||
} AVDOVIReshapingCurve;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVDOVINLQMethod {
|
||||
AV_DOVI_NLQ_NONE = -1,
|
||||
AV_DOVI_NLQ_LINEAR_DZ = 0,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Coefficients of the non-linear inverse quantization. For the interpretation
|
||||
* of these, see ETSI GS CCM 001.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVINLQParams {
|
||||
uint16_t nlq_offset;
|
||||
uint64_t vdr_in_max;
|
||||
/* AV_DOVI_NLQ_LINEAR_DZ */
|
||||
uint64_t linear_deadzone_slope;
|
||||
uint64_t linear_deadzone_threshold;
|
||||
} AVDOVINLQParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dolby Vision RPU data mapping parameters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note sizeof(AVDOVIDataMapping) is not part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIDataMapping {
|
||||
uint8_t vdr_rpu_id;
|
||||
uint8_t mapping_color_space;
|
||||
uint8_t mapping_chroma_format_idc;
|
||||
AVDOVIReshapingCurve curves[3]; /* per component */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Non-linear inverse quantization */
|
||||
enum AVDOVINLQMethod nlq_method_idc;
|
||||
uint32_t num_x_partitions;
|
||||
uint32_t num_y_partitions;
|
||||
AVDOVINLQParams nlq[3]; /* per component */
|
||||
} AVDOVIDataMapping;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Dolby Vision RPU colorspace metadata parameters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note sizeof(AVDOVIColorMetadata) is not part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIColorMetadata {
|
||||
uint8_t dm_metadata_id;
|
||||
uint8_t scene_refresh_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Coefficients of the custom Dolby Vision IPT-PQ matrices. These are to be
|
||||
* used instead of the matrices indicated by the frame's colorspace tags.
|
||||
* The output of rgb_to_lms_matrix is to be fed into a BT.2020 LMS->RGB
|
||||
* matrix based on a Hunt-Pointer-Estevez transform, but without any
|
||||
* crosstalk. (See the definition of the ICtCp colorspace for more
|
||||
* information.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational ycc_to_rgb_matrix[9]; /* before PQ linearization */
|
||||
AVRational ycc_to_rgb_offset[3]; /* input offset of neutral value */
|
||||
AVRational rgb_to_lms_matrix[9]; /* after PQ linearization */
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extra signal metadata (see Dolby patents for more info).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t signal_eotf;
|
||||
uint16_t signal_eotf_param0;
|
||||
uint16_t signal_eotf_param1;
|
||||
uint32_t signal_eotf_param2;
|
||||
uint8_t signal_bit_depth;
|
||||
uint8_t signal_color_space;
|
||||
uint8_t signal_chroma_format;
|
||||
uint8_t signal_full_range_flag; /* [0, 3] */
|
||||
uint16_t source_min_pq;
|
||||
uint16_t source_max_pq;
|
||||
uint16_t source_diagonal;
|
||||
} AVDOVIColorMetadata;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Combined struct representing a combination of header, mapping and color
|
||||
* metadata, for attaching to frames as side data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct must be allocated with av_dovi_metadata_alloc() and
|
||||
* its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVDOVIMetadata {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset in bytes from the beginning of this structure at which the
|
||||
* respective structs start.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t header_offset; /* AVDOVIRpuDataHeader */
|
||||
size_t mapping_offset; /* AVDOVIDataMapping */
|
||||
size_t color_offset; /* AVDOVIColorMetadata */
|
||||
} AVDOVIMetadata;
|
||||
|
||||
static av_always_inline AVDOVIRpuDataHeader *
|
||||
av_dovi_get_header(const AVDOVIMetadata *data)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (AVDOVIRpuDataHeader *)((uint8_t *) data + data->header_offset);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static av_always_inline AVDOVIDataMapping *
|
||||
av_dovi_get_mapping(const AVDOVIMetadata *data)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (AVDOVIDataMapping *)((uint8_t *) data + data->mapping_offset);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static av_always_inline AVDOVIColorMetadata *
|
||||
av_dovi_get_color(const AVDOVIMetadata *data)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (AVDOVIColorMetadata *)((uint8_t *) data + data->color_offset);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVDOVIMetadata structure and initialize its
|
||||
* fields to default values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size If this parameter is non-NULL, the size in bytes of the
|
||||
* allocated struct will be written here on success
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the newly allocated struct or NULL on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDOVIMetadata *av_dovi_metadata_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_DOVI_META_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2014 Tim Walker <tdskywalker@gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_DOWNMIX_INFO_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_DOWNMIX_INFO_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* audio downmix medatata
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_audio
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup downmix_info Audio downmix metadata
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Possible downmix types.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVDownmixType {
|
||||
AV_DOWNMIX_TYPE_UNKNOWN, /**< Not indicated. */
|
||||
AV_DOWNMIX_TYPE_LORO, /**< Lo/Ro 2-channel downmix (Stereo). */
|
||||
AV_DOWNMIX_TYPE_LTRT, /**< Lt/Rt 2-channel downmix, Dolby Surround compatible. */
|
||||
AV_DOWNMIX_TYPE_DPLII, /**< Lt/Rt 2-channel downmix, Dolby Pro Logic II compatible. */
|
||||
AV_DOWNMIX_TYPE_NB /**< Number of downmix types. Not part of ABI. */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure describes optional metadata relevant to a downmix procedure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* All fields are set by the decoder to the value indicated in the audio
|
||||
* bitstream (if present), or to a "sane" default otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDownmixInfo {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Type of downmix preferred by the mastering engineer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVDownmixType preferred_downmix_type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute scale factor representing the nominal level of the center
|
||||
* channel during a regular downmix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double center_mix_level;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute scale factor representing the nominal level of the center
|
||||
* channel during an Lt/Rt compatible downmix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double center_mix_level_ltrt;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute scale factor representing the nominal level of the surround
|
||||
* channels during a regular downmix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double surround_mix_level;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute scale factor representing the nominal level of the surround
|
||||
* channels during an Lt/Rt compatible downmix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double surround_mix_level_ltrt;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Absolute scale factor representing the level at which the LFE data is
|
||||
* mixed into L/R channels during downmixing.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double lfe_mix_level;
|
||||
} AVDownmixInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a frame's AV_FRAME_DATA_DOWNMIX_INFO side data for editing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the side data is absent, it is created and added to the frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param frame the frame for which the side data is to be obtained or created
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the AVDownmixInfo structure to be edited by the caller, or NULL if
|
||||
* the structure cannot be allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDownmixInfo *av_downmix_info_update_side_data(AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_DOWNMIX_INFO_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,205 @@
|
|||
/**
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_ENCRYPTION_INFO_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_ENCRYPTION_INFO_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVSubsampleEncryptionInfo {
|
||||
/** The number of bytes that are clear. */
|
||||
unsigned int bytes_of_clear_data;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of bytes that are protected. If using pattern encryption,
|
||||
* the pattern applies to only the protected bytes; if not using pattern
|
||||
* encryption, all these bytes are encrypted.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int bytes_of_protected_data;
|
||||
} AVSubsampleEncryptionInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This describes encryption info for a packet. This contains frame-specific
|
||||
* info for how to decrypt the packet before passing it to the decoder.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The size of this struct is not part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVEncryptionInfo {
|
||||
/** The fourcc encryption scheme, in big-endian byte order. */
|
||||
uint32_t scheme;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Only used for pattern encryption. This is the number of 16-byte blocks
|
||||
* that are encrypted.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t crypt_byte_block;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Only used for pattern encryption. This is the number of 16-byte blocks
|
||||
* that are clear.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t skip_byte_block;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The ID of the key used to encrypt the packet. This should always be
|
||||
* 16 bytes long, but may be changed in the future.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *key_id;
|
||||
uint32_t key_id_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The initialization vector. This may have been zero-filled to be the
|
||||
* correct block size. This should always be 16 bytes long, but may be
|
||||
* changed in the future.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *iv;
|
||||
uint32_t iv_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An array of subsample encryption info specifying how parts of the sample
|
||||
* are encrypted. If there are no subsamples, then the whole sample is
|
||||
* encrypted.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVSubsampleEncryptionInfo *subsamples;
|
||||
uint32_t subsample_count;
|
||||
} AVEncryptionInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This describes info used to initialize an encryption key system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The size of this struct is not part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVEncryptionInitInfo {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A unique identifier for the key system this is for, can be NULL if it
|
||||
* is not known. This should always be 16 bytes, but may change in the
|
||||
* future.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t* system_id;
|
||||
uint32_t system_id_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An array of key IDs this initialization data is for. All IDs are the
|
||||
* same length. Can be NULL if there are no known key IDs.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t** key_ids;
|
||||
/** The number of key IDs. */
|
||||
uint32_t num_key_ids;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of bytes in each key ID. This should always be 16, but may
|
||||
* change in the future.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t key_id_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Key-system specific initialization data. This data is copied directly
|
||||
* from the file and the format depends on the specific key system. This
|
||||
* can be NULL if there is no initialization data; in that case, there
|
||||
* will be at least one key ID.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t* data;
|
||||
uint32_t data_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* An optional pointer to the next initialization info in the list.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVEncryptionInitInfo *next;
|
||||
} AVEncryptionInitInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates an AVEncryptionInfo structure and sub-pointers to hold the given
|
||||
* number of subsamples. This will allocate pointers for the key ID, IV,
|
||||
* and subsample entries, set the size members, and zero-initialize the rest.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param subsample_count The number of subsamples.
|
||||
* @param key_id_size The number of bytes in the key ID, should be 16.
|
||||
* @param iv_size The number of bytes in the IV, should be 16.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new AVEncryptionInfo structure, or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVEncryptionInfo *av_encryption_info_alloc(uint32_t subsample_count, uint32_t key_id_size, uint32_t iv_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates an AVEncryptionInfo structure with a copy of the given data.
|
||||
* @return The new AVEncryptionInfo structure, or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVEncryptionInfo *av_encryption_info_clone(const AVEncryptionInfo *info);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Frees the given encryption info object. This MUST NOT be used to free the
|
||||
* side-data data pointer, that should use normal side-data methods.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_encryption_info_free(AVEncryptionInfo *info);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Creates a copy of the AVEncryptionInfo that is contained in the given side
|
||||
* data. The resulting object should be passed to av_encryption_info_free()
|
||||
* when done.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new AVEncryptionInfo structure, or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVEncryptionInfo *av_encryption_info_get_side_data(const uint8_t *side_data, size_t side_data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates and initializes side data that holds a copy of the given encryption
|
||||
* info. The resulting pointer should be either freed using av_free or given
|
||||
* to av_packet_add_side_data().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new side-data pointer, or NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *av_encryption_info_add_side_data(
|
||||
const AVEncryptionInfo *info, size_t *side_data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates an AVEncryptionInitInfo structure and sub-pointers to hold the
|
||||
* given sizes. This will allocate pointers and set all the fields.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new AVEncryptionInitInfo structure, or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVEncryptionInitInfo *av_encryption_init_info_alloc(
|
||||
uint32_t system_id_size, uint32_t num_key_ids, uint32_t key_id_size, uint32_t data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Frees the given encryption init info object. This MUST NOT be used to free
|
||||
* the side-data data pointer, that should use normal side-data methods.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_encryption_init_info_free(AVEncryptionInitInfo* info);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Creates a copy of the AVEncryptionInitInfo that is contained in the given
|
||||
* side data. The resulting object should be passed to
|
||||
* av_encryption_init_info_free() when done.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new AVEncryptionInitInfo structure, or NULL on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVEncryptionInitInfo *av_encryption_init_info_get_side_data(
|
||||
const uint8_t* side_data, size_t side_data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates and initializes side data that holds a copy of the given encryption
|
||||
* init info. The resulting pointer should be either freed using av_free or
|
||||
* given to av_packet_add_side_data().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The new side-data pointer, or NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t *av_encryption_init_info_add_side_data(
|
||||
const AVEncryptionInitInfo *info, size_t *side_data_size);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_ENCRYPTION_INFO_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,128 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* error code definitions
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_ERROR_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_ERROR_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "macros.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_error
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* error handling */
|
||||
#if EDOM > 0
|
||||
#define AVERROR(e) (-(e)) ///< Returns a negative error code from a POSIX error code, to return from library functions.
|
||||
#define AVUNERROR(e) (-(e)) ///< Returns a POSIX error code from a library function error return value.
|
||||
#else
|
||||
/* Some platforms have E* and errno already negated. */
|
||||
#define AVERROR(e) (e)
|
||||
#define AVUNERROR(e) (e)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define FFERRTAG(a, b, c, d) (-(int)MKTAG(a, b, c, d))
|
||||
|
||||
#define AVERROR_BSF_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'B','S','F') ///< Bitstream filter not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_BUG FFERRTAG( 'B','U','G','!') ///< Internal bug, also see AVERROR_BUG2
|
||||
#define AVERROR_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL FFERRTAG( 'B','U','F','S') ///< Buffer too small
|
||||
#define AVERROR_DECODER_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'D','E','C') ///< Decoder not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_DEMUXER_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'D','E','M') ///< Demuxer not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_ENCODER_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'E','N','C') ///< Encoder not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_EOF FFERRTAG( 'E','O','F',' ') ///< End of file
|
||||
#define AVERROR_EXIT FFERRTAG( 'E','X','I','T') ///< Immediate exit was requested; the called function should not be restarted
|
||||
#define AVERROR_EXTERNAL FFERRTAG( 'E','X','T',' ') ///< Generic error in an external library
|
||||
#define AVERROR_FILTER_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'F','I','L') ///< Filter not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_INVALIDDATA FFERRTAG( 'I','N','D','A') ///< Invalid data found when processing input
|
||||
#define AVERROR_MUXER_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'M','U','X') ///< Muxer not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_OPTION_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'O','P','T') ///< Option not found
|
||||
#define AVERROR_PATCHWELCOME FFERRTAG( 'P','A','W','E') ///< Not yet implemented in FFmpeg, patches welcome
|
||||
#define AVERROR_PROTOCOL_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'P','R','O') ///< Protocol not found
|
||||
|
||||
#define AVERROR_STREAM_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'S','T','R') ///< Stream not found
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This is semantically identical to AVERROR_BUG
|
||||
* it has been introduced in Libav after our AVERROR_BUG and with a modified value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AVERROR_BUG2 FFERRTAG( 'B','U','G',' ')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_UNKNOWN FFERRTAG( 'U','N','K','N') ///< Unknown error, typically from an external library
|
||||
#define AVERROR_EXPERIMENTAL (-0x2bb2afa8) ///< Requested feature is flagged experimental. Set strict_std_compliance if you really want to use it.
|
||||
#define AVERROR_INPUT_CHANGED (-0x636e6701) ///< Input changed between calls. Reconfiguration is required. (can be OR-ed with AVERROR_OUTPUT_CHANGED)
|
||||
#define AVERROR_OUTPUT_CHANGED (-0x636e6702) ///< Output changed between calls. Reconfiguration is required. (can be OR-ed with AVERROR_INPUT_CHANGED)
|
||||
/* HTTP & RTSP errors */
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_BAD_REQUEST FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','0')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','1')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_FORBIDDEN FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','3')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','4')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_OTHER_4XX FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','X','X')
|
||||
#define AVERROR_HTTP_SERVER_ERROR FFERRTAG(0xF8,'5','X','X')
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE 64
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Put a description of the AVERROR code errnum in errbuf.
|
||||
* In case of failure the global variable errno is set to indicate the
|
||||
* error. Even in case of failure av_strerror() will print a generic
|
||||
* error message indicating the errnum provided to errbuf.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param errnum error code to describe
|
||||
* @param errbuf buffer to which description is written
|
||||
* @param errbuf_size the size in bytes of errbuf
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative value if a description for errnum
|
||||
* cannot be found
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_strerror(int errnum, char *errbuf, size_t errbuf_size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Fill the provided buffer with a string containing an error string
|
||||
* corresponding to the AVERROR code errnum.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param errbuf a buffer
|
||||
* @param errbuf_size size in bytes of errbuf
|
||||
* @param errnum error code to describe
|
||||
* @return the buffer in input, filled with the error description
|
||||
* @see av_strerror()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline char *av_make_error_string(char *errbuf, size_t errbuf_size, int errnum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
av_strerror(errnum, errbuf, errbuf_size);
|
||||
return errbuf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convenience macro, the return value should be used only directly in
|
||||
* function arguments but never stand-alone.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define av_err2str(errnum) \
|
||||
av_make_error_string((char[AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE]){0}, AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE, errnum)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_ERROR_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,140 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2002 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* simple arithmetic expression evaluator
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_EVAL_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_EVAL_H
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVExpr AVExpr;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse and evaluate an expression.
|
||||
* Note, this is significantly slower than av_expr_eval().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param res a pointer to a double where is put the result value of
|
||||
* the expression, or NAN in case of error
|
||||
* @param s expression as a zero terminated string, for example "1+2^3+5*5+sin(2/3)"
|
||||
* @param const_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of constant identifiers, for example {"PI", "E", 0}
|
||||
* @param const_values a zero terminated array of values for the identifiers from const_names
|
||||
* @param func1_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of funcs1 identifiers
|
||||
* @param funcs1 NULL terminated array of function pointers for functions which take 1 argument
|
||||
* @param func2_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of funcs2 identifiers
|
||||
* @param funcs2 NULL terminated array of function pointers for functions which take 2 arguments
|
||||
* @param opaque a pointer which will be passed to all functions from funcs1 and funcs2
|
||||
* @param log_offset log level offset, can be used to silence error messages
|
||||
* @param log_ctx parent logging context
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative value corresponding to an
|
||||
* AVERROR code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_expr_parse_and_eval(double *res, const char *s,
|
||||
const char * const *const_names, const double *const_values,
|
||||
const char * const *func1_names, double (* const *funcs1)(void *, double),
|
||||
const char * const *func2_names, double (* const *funcs2)(void *, double, double),
|
||||
void *opaque, int log_offset, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse an expression.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param expr a pointer where is put an AVExpr containing the parsed
|
||||
* value in case of successful parsing, or NULL otherwise.
|
||||
* The pointed to AVExpr must be freed with av_expr_free() by the user
|
||||
* when it is not needed anymore.
|
||||
* @param s expression as a zero terminated string, for example "1+2^3+5*5+sin(2/3)"
|
||||
* @param const_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of constant identifiers, for example {"PI", "E", 0}
|
||||
* @param func1_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of funcs1 identifiers
|
||||
* @param funcs1 NULL terminated array of function pointers for functions which take 1 argument
|
||||
* @param func2_names NULL terminated array of zero terminated strings of funcs2 identifiers
|
||||
* @param funcs2 NULL terminated array of function pointers for functions which take 2 arguments
|
||||
* @param log_offset log level offset, can be used to silence error messages
|
||||
* @param log_ctx parent logging context
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative value corresponding to an
|
||||
* AVERROR code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_expr_parse(AVExpr **expr, const char *s,
|
||||
const char * const *const_names,
|
||||
const char * const *func1_names, double (* const *funcs1)(void *, double),
|
||||
const char * const *func2_names, double (* const *funcs2)(void *, double, double),
|
||||
int log_offset, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Evaluate a previously parsed expression.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param e the AVExpr to evaluate
|
||||
* @param const_values a zero terminated array of values for the identifiers from av_expr_parse() const_names
|
||||
* @param opaque a pointer which will be passed to all functions from funcs1 and funcs2
|
||||
* @return the value of the expression
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double av_expr_eval(AVExpr *e, const double *const_values, void *opaque);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Track the presence of variables and their number of occurrences in a parsed expression
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param e the AVExpr to track variables in
|
||||
* @param counter a zero-initialized array where the count of each variable will be stored
|
||||
* @param size size of array
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative value indicates that no expression or array was passed
|
||||
* or size was zero
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_expr_count_vars(AVExpr *e, unsigned *counter, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Track the presence of user provided functions and their number of occurrences
|
||||
* in a parsed expression.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param e the AVExpr to track user provided functions in
|
||||
* @param counter a zero-initialized array where the count of each function will be stored
|
||||
* if you passed 5 functions with 2 arguments to av_expr_parse()
|
||||
* then for arg=2 this will use up to 5 entries.
|
||||
* @param size size of array
|
||||
* @param arg number of arguments the counted functions have
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative value indicates that no expression or array was passed
|
||||
* or size was zero
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_expr_count_func(AVExpr *e, unsigned *counter, int size, int arg);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free a parsed expression previously created with av_expr_parse().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_expr_free(AVExpr *e);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse the string in numstr and return its value as a double. If
|
||||
* the string is empty, contains only whitespaces, or does not contain
|
||||
* an initial substring that has the expected syntax for a
|
||||
* floating-point number, no conversion is performed. In this case,
|
||||
* returns a value of zero and the value returned in tail is the value
|
||||
* of numstr.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param numstr a string representing a number, may contain one of
|
||||
* the International System number postfixes, for example 'K', 'M',
|
||||
* 'G'. If 'i' is appended after the postfix, powers of 2 are used
|
||||
* instead of powers of 10. The 'B' postfix multiplies the value by
|
||||
* 8, and can be appended after another postfix or used alone. This
|
||||
* allows using for example 'KB', 'MiB', 'G' and 'B' as postfix.
|
||||
* @param tail if non-NULL puts here the pointer to the char next
|
||||
* after the last parsed character
|
||||
*/
|
||||
double av_strtod(const char *numstr, char **tail);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_EVAL_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,67 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2023 Nuo Mi
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_EXECUTOR_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_EXECUTOR_H
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVExecutor AVExecutor;
|
||||
typedef struct AVTask AVTask;
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVTask {
|
||||
AVTask *next;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVTaskCallbacks {
|
||||
void *user_data;
|
||||
|
||||
int local_context_size;
|
||||
|
||||
// return 1 if a's priority > b's priority
|
||||
int (*priority_higher)(const AVTask *a, const AVTask *b);
|
||||
|
||||
// task is ready for run
|
||||
int (*ready)(const AVTask *t, void *user_data);
|
||||
|
||||
// run the task
|
||||
int (*run)(AVTask *t, void *local_context, void *user_data);
|
||||
} AVTaskCallbacks;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Alloc executor
|
||||
* @param callbacks callback structure for executor
|
||||
* @param thread_count worker thread number
|
||||
* @return return the executor
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVExecutor* av_executor_alloc(const AVTaskCallbacks *callbacks, int thread_count);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free executor
|
||||
* @param e pointer to executor
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_executor_free(AVExecutor **e);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Add task to executor
|
||||
* @param e pointer to executor
|
||||
* @param t pointer to task. If NULL, it will wakeup one work thread
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_executor_execute(AVExecutor *e, AVTask *t);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif //AVUTIL_EXECUTOR_H
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
|
|||
/* Automatically generated by version.sh, do not manually edit! */
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_FFVERSION_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_FFVERSION_H
|
||||
#define FFMPEG_VERSION "7.0.2"
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_FFVERSION_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,246 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_fifo
|
||||
* A generic FIFO API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_FIFO_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_FIFO_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_fifo AVFifo
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_data
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* A generic FIFO API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVFifo AVFifo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callback for writing or reading from a FIFO, passed to (and invoked from) the
|
||||
* av_fifo_*_cb() functions. It may be invoked multiple times from a single
|
||||
* av_fifo_*_cb() call and may process less data than the maximum size indicated
|
||||
* by nb_elems.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param opaque the opaque pointer provided to the av_fifo_*_cb() function
|
||||
* @param buf the buffer for reading or writing the data, depending on which
|
||||
* av_fifo_*_cb function is called
|
||||
* @param nb_elems On entry contains the maximum number of elements that can be
|
||||
* read from / written into buf. On success, the callback should
|
||||
* update it to contain the number of elements actually written.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative error code on failure (will be returned from
|
||||
* the invoking av_fifo_*_cb() function)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef int AVFifoCB(void *opaque, void *buf, size_t *nb_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Automatically resize the FIFO on writes, so that the data fits. This
|
||||
* automatic resizing happens up to a limit that can be modified with
|
||||
* av_fifo_auto_grow_limit().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_FIFO_FLAG_AUTO_GROW (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate and initialize an AVFifo with a given element size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param elems initial number of elements that can be stored in the FIFO
|
||||
* @param elem_size Size in bytes of a single element. Further operations on
|
||||
* the returned FIFO will implicitly use this element size.
|
||||
* @param flags a combination of AV_FIFO_FLAG_*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return newly-allocated AVFifo on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVFifo *av_fifo_alloc2(size_t elems, size_t elem_size,
|
||||
unsigned int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return Element size for FIFO operations. This element size is set at
|
||||
* FIFO allocation and remains constant during its lifetime
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_fifo_elem_size(const AVFifo *f);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the maximum size (in elements) to which the FIFO can be resized
|
||||
* automatically. Has no effect unless AV_FIFO_FLAG_AUTO_GROW is used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_fifo_auto_grow_limit(AVFifo *f, size_t max_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return number of elements available for reading from the given FIFO.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_fifo_can_read(const AVFifo *f);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @return Number of elements that can be written into the given FIFO without
|
||||
* growing it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In other words, this number of elements or less is guaranteed to fit
|
||||
* into the FIFO. More data may be written when the
|
||||
* AV_FIFO_FLAG_AUTO_GROW flag was specified at FIFO creation, but this
|
||||
* may involve memory allocation, which can fail.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t av_fifo_can_write(const AVFifo *f);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Enlarge an AVFifo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* On success, the FIFO will be large enough to hold exactly
|
||||
* inc + av_fifo_can_read() + av_fifo_can_write()
|
||||
* elements. In case of failure, the old FIFO is kept unchanged.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f AVFifo to resize
|
||||
* @param inc number of elements to allocate for, in addition to the current
|
||||
* allocated size
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_grow2(AVFifo *f, size_t inc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write data into a FIFO.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In case nb_elems > av_fifo_can_write(f) and the AV_FIFO_FLAG_AUTO_GROW flag
|
||||
* was not specified at FIFO creation, nothing is written and an error
|
||||
* is returned.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Calling function is guaranteed to succeed if nb_elems <= av_fifo_can_write(f).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param buf Data to be written. nb_elems * av_fifo_elem_size(f) bytes will be
|
||||
* read from buf on success.
|
||||
* @param nb_elems number of elements to write into FIFO
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_write(AVFifo *f, const void *buf, size_t nb_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Write data from a user-provided callback into a FIFO.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param read_cb Callback supplying the data to the FIFO. May be called
|
||||
* multiple times.
|
||||
* @param opaque opaque user data to be provided to read_cb
|
||||
* @param nb_elems Should point to the maximum number of elements that can be
|
||||
* written. Will be updated to contain the number of elements
|
||||
* actually written.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_write_from_cb(AVFifo *f, AVFifoCB read_cb,
|
||||
void *opaque, size_t *nb_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read data from a FIFO.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In case nb_elems > av_fifo_can_read(f), nothing is read and an error
|
||||
* is returned.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param buf Buffer to store the data. nb_elems * av_fifo_elem_size(f) bytes
|
||||
* will be written into buf on success.
|
||||
* @param nb_elems number of elements to read from FIFO
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_read(AVFifo *f, void *buf, size_t nb_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Feed data from a FIFO into a user-provided callback.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param write_cb Callback the data will be supplied to. May be called
|
||||
* multiple times.
|
||||
* @param opaque opaque user data to be provided to write_cb
|
||||
* @param nb_elems Should point to the maximum number of elements that can be
|
||||
* read. Will be updated to contain the total number of elements
|
||||
* actually sent to the callback.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_read_to_cb(AVFifo *f, AVFifoCB write_cb,
|
||||
void *opaque, size_t *nb_elems);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read data from a FIFO without modifying FIFO state.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Returns an error if an attempt is made to peek to nonexistent elements
|
||||
* (i.e. if offset + nb_elems is larger than av_fifo_can_read(f)).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param buf Buffer to store the data. nb_elems * av_fifo_elem_size(f) bytes
|
||||
* will be written into buf.
|
||||
* @param nb_elems number of elements to read from FIFO
|
||||
* @param offset number of initial elements to skip.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_peek(const AVFifo *f, void *buf, size_t nb_elems, size_t offset);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Feed data from a FIFO into a user-provided callback.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param f the FIFO buffer
|
||||
* @param write_cb Callback the data will be supplied to. May be called
|
||||
* multiple times.
|
||||
* @param opaque opaque user data to be provided to write_cb
|
||||
* @param nb_elems Should point to the maximum number of elements that can be
|
||||
* read. Will be updated to contain the total number of elements
|
||||
* actually sent to the callback.
|
||||
* @param offset number of initial elements to skip; offset + *nb_elems must not
|
||||
* be larger than av_fifo_can_read(f).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a non-negative number on success, a negative error code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_fifo_peek_to_cb(const AVFifo *f, AVFifoCB write_cb, void *opaque,
|
||||
size_t *nb_elems, size_t offset);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Discard the specified amount of data from an AVFifo.
|
||||
* @param size number of elements to discard, MUST NOT be larger than
|
||||
* av_fifo_can_read(f)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_fifo_drain2(AVFifo *f, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Empty the AVFifo.
|
||||
* @param f AVFifo to reset
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_fifo_reset2(AVFifo *f);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVFifo and reset pointer to NULL.
|
||||
* @param f Pointer to an AVFifo to free. *f == NULL is allowed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_fifo_freep2(AVFifo **f);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_FIFO_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_FILE_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_FILE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Misc file utilities.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Read the file with name filename, and put its content in a newly
|
||||
* allocated buffer or map it with mmap() when available.
|
||||
* In case of success set *bufptr to the read or mmapped buffer, and
|
||||
* *size to the size in bytes of the buffer in *bufptr.
|
||||
* Unlike mmap this function succeeds with zero sized files, in this
|
||||
* case *bufptr will be set to NULL and *size will be set to 0.
|
||||
* The returned buffer must be released with av_file_unmap().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param filename path to the file
|
||||
* @param[out] bufptr pointee is set to the mapped or allocated buffer
|
||||
* @param[out] size pointee is set to the size in bytes of the buffer
|
||||
* @param log_offset loglevel offset used for logging
|
||||
* @param log_ctx context used for logging
|
||||
* @return a non negative number in case of success, a negative value
|
||||
* corresponding to an AVERROR error code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
av_warn_unused_result
|
||||
int av_file_map(const char *filename, uint8_t **bufptr, size_t *size,
|
||||
int log_offset, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Unmap or free the buffer bufptr created by av_file_map().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param bufptr the buffer previously created with av_file_map()
|
||||
* @param size size in bytes of bufptr, must be the same as returned
|
||||
* by av_file_map()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_file_unmap(uint8_t *bufptr, size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_FILE_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,322 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVFilmGrainParamsType {
|
||||
AV_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_NONE = 0,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The union is valid when interpreted as AVFilmGrainAOMParams (codec.aom)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_AV1,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The union is valid when interpreted as AVFilmGrainH274Params (codec.h274)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_H274,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure describes how to handle film grain synthesis for AOM codecs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct must be allocated as part of AVFilmGrainParams using
|
||||
* av_film_grain_params_alloc(). Its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVFilmGrainAOMParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of points, and the scale and value for each point of the
|
||||
* piecewise linear scaling function for the uma plane.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int num_y_points;
|
||||
uint8_t y_points[14][2 /* value, scaling */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Signals whether to derive the chroma scaling function from the luma.
|
||||
* Not equivalent to copying the luma values and scales.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int chroma_scaling_from_luma;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If chroma_scaling_from_luma is set to 0, signals the chroma scaling
|
||||
* function parameters.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int num_uv_points[2 /* cb, cr */];
|
||||
uint8_t uv_points[2 /* cb, cr */][10][2 /* value, scaling */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the shift applied to the chroma components. For AV1, its within
|
||||
* [8; 11] and determines the range and quantization of the film grain.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int scaling_shift;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the auto-regression lag.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int ar_coeff_lag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Luma auto-regression coefficients. The number of coefficients is given by
|
||||
* 2 * ar_coeff_lag * (ar_coeff_lag + 1).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int8_t ar_coeffs_y[24];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Chroma auto-regression coefficients. The number of coefficients is given by
|
||||
* 2 * ar_coeff_lag * (ar_coeff_lag + 1) + !!num_y_points.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int8_t ar_coeffs_uv[2 /* cb, cr */][25];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the range of the auto-regressive coefficients. Values of 6,
|
||||
* 7, 8 and so on represent a range of [-2, 2), [-1, 1), [-0.5, 0.5) and
|
||||
* so on. For AV1 must be between 6 and 9.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int ar_coeff_shift;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Signals the down shift applied to the generated gaussian numbers during
|
||||
* synthesis.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int grain_scale_shift;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the luma/chroma multipliers for the index to the component
|
||||
* scaling function.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int uv_mult[2 /* cb, cr */];
|
||||
int uv_mult_luma[2 /* cb, cr */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset used for component scaling function. For AV1 its a 9-bit value
|
||||
* with a range [-256, 255]
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int uv_offset[2 /* cb, cr */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Signals whether to overlap film grain blocks.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int overlap_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Signals to clip to limited color levels after film grain application.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int limit_output_range;
|
||||
} AVFilmGrainAOMParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure describes how to handle film grain synthesis for codecs using
|
||||
* the ITU-T H.274 Versatile suplemental enhancement information message.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct must be allocated as part of AVFilmGrainParams using
|
||||
* av_film_grain_params_alloc(). Its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVFilmGrainH274Params {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the film grain simulation mode.
|
||||
* 0 = Frequency filtering, 1 = Auto-regression
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int model_id;
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_H274_FILM_GRAIN_VCS
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* TODO: On this ABI bump, please also re-order the fields in
|
||||
* AVFilmGrainParams (see below)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the bit depth used for the luma component.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated use AVFilmGrainParams.bit_depth_luma.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
int bit_depth_luma;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the bit depth used for the chroma components.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated use AVFilmGrainParams.bit_depth_chroma.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
int bit_depth_chroma;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the video signal characteristics.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @deprecated use AVFilmGrainParams.color_{range,primaries,trc,space}.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
enum AVColorPrimaries color_primaries;
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace color_space;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the blending mode used to blend the simulated film grain
|
||||
* with the decoded images.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 0 = Additive, 1 = Multiplicative
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int blending_mode_id;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies a scale factor used in the film grain characterization equations.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int log2_scale_factor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates if the modelling of film grain for a given component is present.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int component_model_present[3 /* y, cb, cr */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the number of intensity intervals for which a specific set of
|
||||
* model values has been estimated, with a range of [1, 256].
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t num_intensity_intervals[3 /* y, cb, cr */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the number of model values present for each intensity interval
|
||||
* in which the film grain has been modelled, with a range of [1, 6].
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_model_values[3 /* y, cb, cr */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the lower ounds of each intensity interval for whichthe set of
|
||||
* model values applies for the component.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t intensity_interval_lower_bound[3 /* y, cb, cr */][256 /* intensity interval */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the upper bound of each intensity interval for which the set of
|
||||
* model values applies for the component.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t intensity_interval_upper_bound[3 /* y, cb, cr */][256 /* intensity interval */];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the model values for the component for each intensity interval.
|
||||
* - When model_id == 0, the following applies:
|
||||
* For comp_model_value[y], the range of values is [0, 2^bit_depth_luma - 1]
|
||||
* For comp_model_value[cb..cr], the range of values is [0, 2^bit_depth_chroma - 1]
|
||||
* - Otherwise, the following applies:
|
||||
* For comp_model_value[y], the range of values is [-2^(bit_depth_luma - 1), 2^(bit_depth_luma - 1) - 1]
|
||||
* For comp_model_value[cb..cr], the range of values is [-2^(bit_depth_chroma - 1), 2^(bit_depth_chroma - 1) - 1]
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int16_t comp_model_value[3 /* y, cb, cr */][256 /* intensity interval */][6 /* model value */];
|
||||
} AVFilmGrainH274Params;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure describes how to handle film grain synthesis in video
|
||||
* for specific codecs. Must be present on every frame where film grain is
|
||||
* meant to be synthesised for correct presentation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct must be allocated with av_film_grain_params_alloc() and
|
||||
* its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVFilmGrainParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Specifies the codec for which this structure is valid.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVFilmGrainParamsType type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seed to use for the synthesis process, if the codec allows for it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note For H.264, this refers to `pic_offset` as defined in
|
||||
* SMPTE RDD 5-2006.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t seed;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Additional fields may be added both here and in any structure included.
|
||||
* If a codec's film grain structure differs slightly over another
|
||||
* codec's, fields within may change meaning depending on the type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* TODO: Move this to the end of the structure, at the next ABI bump.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
union {
|
||||
AVFilmGrainAOMParams aom;
|
||||
AVFilmGrainH274Params h274;
|
||||
} codec;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Intended display resolution. May be 0 if the codec does not specify
|
||||
* any restrictions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
int width, height;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Intended subsampling ratio, or 0 for luma-only streams.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int subsampling_x, subsampling_y;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Intended video signal characteristics.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
enum AVColorPrimaries color_primaries;
|
||||
enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
|
||||
enum AVColorSpace color_space;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Intended bit depth, or 0 for unknown/unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int bit_depth_luma;
|
||||
int bit_depth_chroma;
|
||||
|
||||
} AVFilmGrainParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVFilmGrainParams structure and set its fields to
|
||||
* default values. The resulting struct can be freed using av_freep().
|
||||
* If size is not NULL it will be set to the number of bytes allocated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return An AVFilmGrainParams filled with default values or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVFilmGrainParams *av_film_grain_params_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a complete AVFilmGrainParams and add it to the frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param frame The frame which side data is added to.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The AVFilmGrainParams structure to be filled by caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVFilmGrainParams *av_film_grain_params_create_side_data(AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Select the most appropriate film grain parameters set for the frame,
|
||||
* taking into account the frame's format, resolution and video signal
|
||||
* characteristics.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note, for H.274, this may select a film grain parameter set with
|
||||
* greater chroma resolution than the frame. Users should take care to
|
||||
* correctly adjust the chroma grain frequency to the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVFilmGrainParams *av_film_grain_params_select(const AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_FILM_GRAIN_PARAMS_H */
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -0,0 +1,264 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2013 Reimar Döffinger <Reimar.Doeffinger@gmx.de>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_hash_generic
|
||||
* Generic hashing API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HASH_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HASH_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_hash Hash Functions
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* Hash functions useful in multimedia.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Hash functions are widely used in multimedia, from error checking and
|
||||
* concealment to internal regression testing. libavutil has efficient
|
||||
* implementations of a variety of hash functions that may be useful for
|
||||
* FFmpeg and other multimedia applications.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_hash_generic Generic Hashing API
|
||||
* An abstraction layer for all hash functions supported by libavutil.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If your application needs to support a wide range of different hash
|
||||
* functions, then the Generic Hashing API is for you. It provides a generic,
|
||||
* reusable API for @ref lavu_hash "all hash functions" implemented in libavutil.
|
||||
* If you just need to use one particular hash function, use the @ref lavu_hash
|
||||
* "individual hash" directly.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section Sample Code
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A basic template for using the Generic Hashing API follows:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
* struct AVHashContext *ctx = NULL;
|
||||
* const char *hash_name = NULL;
|
||||
* uint8_t *output_buf = NULL;
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Select from a string returned by av_hash_names()
|
||||
* hash_name = ...;
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Allocate a hash context
|
||||
* ret = av_hash_alloc(&ctx, hash_name);
|
||||
* if (ret < 0)
|
||||
* return ret;
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Initialize the hash context
|
||||
* av_hash_init(ctx);
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Update the hash context with data
|
||||
* while (data_left) {
|
||||
* av_hash_update(ctx, data, size);
|
||||
* }
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Now we have no more data, so it is time to finalize the hash and get the
|
||||
* // output. But we need to first allocate an output buffer. Note that you can
|
||||
* // use any memory allocation function, including malloc(), not just
|
||||
* // av_malloc().
|
||||
* output_buf = av_malloc(av_hash_get_size(ctx));
|
||||
* if (!output_buf)
|
||||
* return AVERROR(ENOMEM);
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Finalize the hash context.
|
||||
* // You can use any of the av_hash_final*() functions provided, for other
|
||||
* // output formats. If you do so, be sure to adjust the memory allocation
|
||||
* // above. See the function documentation below for the exact amount of extra
|
||||
* // memory needed.
|
||||
* av_hash_final(ctx, output_buffer);
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // Free the context
|
||||
* av_hash_freep(&ctx);
|
||||
* @endcode
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section Hash Function-Specific Information
|
||||
* If the CRC32 hash is selected, the #AV_CRC_32_IEEE polynomial will be
|
||||
* used.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the Murmur3 hash is selected, the default seed will be used. See @ref
|
||||
* lavu_murmur3_seedinfo "Murmur3" for more information.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @example ffhash.c
|
||||
* This example is a simple command line application that takes one or more
|
||||
* arguments. It demonstrates a typical use of the hashing API with allocation,
|
||||
* initialization, updating, and finalizing.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVHashContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a hash context for the algorithm specified by name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 for success, a negative error code for failure
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The context is not initialized after a call to this function; you must
|
||||
* call av_hash_init() to do so.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hash_alloc(struct AVHashContext **ctx, const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the names of available hash algorithms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function can be used to enumerate the algorithms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] i Index of the hash algorithm, starting from 0
|
||||
* @return Pointer to a static string or `NULL` if `i` is out of range
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_hash_names(int i);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the name of the algorithm corresponding to the given hash context.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_hash_get_name(const struct AVHashContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Maximum value that av_hash_get_size() will currently return.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You can use this if you absolutely want or need to use static allocation for
|
||||
* the output buffer and are fine with not supporting hashes newly added to
|
||||
* libavutil without recompilation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @warning
|
||||
* Adding new hashes with larger sizes, and increasing the macro while doing
|
||||
* so, will not be considered an ABI change. To prevent your code from
|
||||
* overflowing a buffer, either dynamically allocate the output buffer with
|
||||
* av_hash_get_size(), or limit your use of the Hashing API to hashes that are
|
||||
* already in FFmpeg during the time of compilation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_HASH_MAX_SIZE 64
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the size of the resulting hash value in bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The maximum value this function will currently return is available as macro
|
||||
* #AV_HASH_MAX_SIZE.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @return Size of the hash value in bytes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hash_get_size(const struct AVHashContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize or reset a hash context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_init(struct AVHashContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Update a hash context with additional data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @param[in] src Data to be added to the hash context
|
||||
* @param[in] len Size of the additional data
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_update(struct AVHashContext *ctx, const uint8_t *src, size_t len);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize a hash context and compute the actual hash value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The minimum size of `dst` buffer is given by av_hash_get_size() or
|
||||
* #AV_HASH_MAX_SIZE. The use of the latter macro is discouraged.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is not safe to update or finalize a hash context again, if it has already
|
||||
* been finalized.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @param[out] dst Where the final hash value will be stored
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_hash_final_bin() provides an alternative API
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_final(struct AVHashContext *ctx, uint8_t *dst);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize a hash context and store the actual hash value in a buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is not safe to update or finalize a hash context again, if it has already
|
||||
* been finalized.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If `size` is smaller than the hash size (given by av_hash_get_size()), the
|
||||
* hash is truncated; if size is larger, the buffer is padded with 0.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @param[out] dst Where the final hash value will be stored
|
||||
* @param[in] size Number of bytes to write to `dst`
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_final_bin(struct AVHashContext *ctx, uint8_t *dst, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize a hash context and store the hexadecimal representation of the
|
||||
* actual hash value as a string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is not safe to update or finalize a hash context again, if it has already
|
||||
* been finalized.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The string is always 0-terminated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If `size` is smaller than `2 * hash_size + 1`, where `hash_size` is the
|
||||
* value returned by av_hash_get_size(), the string will be truncated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @param[out] dst Where the string will be stored
|
||||
* @param[in] size Maximum number of bytes to write to `dst`
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_final_hex(struct AVHashContext *ctx, uint8_t *dst, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize a hash context and store the Base64 representation of the
|
||||
* actual hash value as a string.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is not safe to update or finalize a hash context again, if it has already
|
||||
* been finalized.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The string is always 0-terminated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If `size` is smaller than AV_BASE64_SIZE(hash_size), where `hash_size` is
|
||||
* the value returned by av_hash_get_size(), the string will be truncated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Hash context
|
||||
* @param[out] dst Where the final hash value will be stored
|
||||
* @param[in] size Maximum number of bytes to write to `dst`
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_final_b64(struct AVHashContext *ctx, uint8_t *dst, int size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free hash context and set hash context pointer to `NULL`.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param[in,out] ctx Pointer to hash context
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hash_freep(struct AVHashContext **ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HASH_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,376 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2018 Mohammad Izadi <moh.izadi at gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_METADATA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_METADATA_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Option for overlapping elliptical pixel selectors in an image.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHDRPlusOverlapProcessOption {
|
||||
AV_HDR_PLUS_OVERLAP_PROCESS_WEIGHTED_AVERAGING = 0,
|
||||
AV_HDR_PLUS_OVERLAP_PROCESS_LAYERING = 1,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Represents the percentile at a specific percentage in
|
||||
* a distribution.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHDRPlusPercentile {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The percentage value corresponding to a specific percentile linearized
|
||||
* RGB value in the processing window in the scene. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0 to100, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t percentage;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The linearized maxRGB value at a specific percentile in the processing
|
||||
* window in the scene. The value shall be in the range of 0 to 1, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.00001.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational percentile;
|
||||
} AVHDRPlusPercentile;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Color transform parameters at a processing window in a dynamic metadata for
|
||||
* SMPTE 2094-40.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHDRPlusColorTransformParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The relative x coordinate of the top left pixel of the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 and 1, inclusive and
|
||||
* in multiples of 1/(width of Picture - 1). The value 1 corresponds
|
||||
* to the absolute coordinate of width of Picture - 1. The value for
|
||||
* first processing window shall be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational window_upper_left_corner_x;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The relative y coordinate of the top left pixel of the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 and 1, inclusive and
|
||||
* in multiples of 1/(height of Picture - 1). The value 1 corresponds
|
||||
* to the absolute coordinate of height of Picture - 1. The value for
|
||||
* first processing window shall be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational window_upper_left_corner_y;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The relative x coordinate of the bottom right pixel of the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 and 1, inclusive and
|
||||
* in multiples of 1/(width of Picture - 1). The value 1 corresponds
|
||||
* to the absolute coordinate of width of Picture - 1. The value for
|
||||
* first processing window shall be 1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational window_lower_right_corner_x;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The relative y coordinate of the bottom right pixel of the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 and 1, inclusive and
|
||||
* in multiples of 1/(height of Picture - 1). The value 1 corresponds
|
||||
* to the absolute coordinate of height of Picture - 1. The value for
|
||||
* first processing window shall be 1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational window_lower_right_corner_y;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The x coordinate of the center position of the concentric internal and
|
||||
* external ellipses of the elliptical pixel selector in the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 to (width of Picture - 1),
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1 pixel.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t center_of_ellipse_x;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The y coordinate of the center position of the concentric internal and
|
||||
* external ellipses of the elliptical pixel selector in the processing
|
||||
* window. The value shall be in the range of 0 to (height of Picture - 1),
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1 pixel.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t center_of_ellipse_y;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The clockwise rotation angle in degree of arc with respect to the
|
||||
* positive direction of the x-axis of the concentric internal and external
|
||||
* ellipses of the elliptical pixel selector in the processing window. The
|
||||
* value shall be in the range of 0 to 180, inclusive and in multiples of 1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t rotation_angle;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The semi-major axis value of the internal ellipse of the elliptical pixel
|
||||
* selector in amount of pixels in the processing window. The value shall be
|
||||
* in the range of 1 to 65535, inclusive and in multiples of 1 pixel.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t semimajor_axis_internal_ellipse;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The semi-major axis value of the external ellipse of the elliptical pixel
|
||||
* selector in amount of pixels in the processing window. The value
|
||||
* shall not be less than semimajor_axis_internal_ellipse of the current
|
||||
* processing window. The value shall be in the range of 1 to 65535,
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1 pixel.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t semimajor_axis_external_ellipse;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The semi-minor axis value of the external ellipse of the elliptical pixel
|
||||
* selector in amount of pixels in the processing window. The value shall be
|
||||
* in the range of 1 to 65535, inclusive and in multiples of 1 pixel.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint16_t semiminor_axis_external_ellipse;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Overlap process option indicates one of the two methods of combining
|
||||
* rendered pixels in the processing window in an image with at least one
|
||||
* elliptical pixel selector. For overlapping elliptical pixel selectors
|
||||
* in an image, overlap_process_option shall have the same value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHDRPlusOverlapProcessOption overlap_process_option;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The maximum of the color components of linearized RGB values in the
|
||||
* processing window in the scene. The values should be in the range of 0 to
|
||||
* 1, inclusive and in multiples of 0.00001. maxscl[ 0 ], maxscl[ 1 ], and
|
||||
* maxscl[ 2 ] are corresponding to R, G, B color components respectively.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational maxscl[3];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The average of linearized maxRGB values in the processing window in the
|
||||
* scene. The value should be in the range of 0 to 1, inclusive and in
|
||||
* multiples of 0.00001.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational average_maxrgb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of linearized maxRGB values at given percentiles in the
|
||||
* processing window in the scene. The maximum value shall be 15.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_distribution_maxrgb_percentiles;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The linearized maxRGB values at given percentiles in the
|
||||
* processing window in the scene.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHDRPlusPercentile distribution_maxrgb[15];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The fraction of selected pixels in the image that contains the brightest
|
||||
* pixel in the scene. The value shall be in the range of 0 to 1, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.001.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational fraction_bright_pixels;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag indicates that the metadata for the tone mapping function in
|
||||
* the processing window is present (for value of 1).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t tone_mapping_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The x coordinate of the separation point between the linear part and the
|
||||
* curved part of the tone mapping function. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 0 to 1, excluding 0 and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational knee_point_x;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The y coordinate of the separation point between the linear part and the
|
||||
* curved part of the tone mapping function. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 0 to 1, excluding 0 and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational knee_point_y;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of the intermediate anchor parameters of the tone mapping
|
||||
* function in the processing window. The maximum value shall be 15.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_bezier_curve_anchors;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The intermediate anchor parameters of the tone mapping function in the
|
||||
* processing window in the scene. The values should be in the range of 0
|
||||
* to 1, inclusive and in multiples of 1/1023.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational bezier_curve_anchors[15];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag shall be equal to 0 in bitstreams conforming to this version of
|
||||
* this Specification. Other values are reserved for future use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t color_saturation_mapping_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The color saturation gain in the processing window in the scene. The
|
||||
* value shall be in the range of 0 to 63/8, inclusive and in multiples of
|
||||
* 1/8. The default value shall be 1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational color_saturation_weight;
|
||||
} AVHDRPlusColorTransformParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct represents dynamic metadata for color volume transform -
|
||||
* application 4 of SMPTE 2094-40:2016 standard.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To be used as payload of a AVFrameSideData or AVPacketSideData with the
|
||||
* appropriate type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with
|
||||
* av_dynamic_hdr_plus_alloc() and its size is not a part of
|
||||
* the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDynamicHDRPlus {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Country code by Rec. ITU-T T.35 Annex A. The value shall be 0xB5.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t itu_t_t35_country_code;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Application version in the application defining document in ST-2094
|
||||
* suite. The value shall be set to 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t application_version;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of processing windows. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 1 to 3, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_windows;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The color transform parameters for every processing window.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHDRPlusColorTransformParams params[3];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The nominal maximum display luminance of the targeted system display,
|
||||
* in units of 0.0001 candelas per square metre. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0 to 10000, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational targeted_system_display_maximum_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag shall be equal to 0 in bit streams conforming to this version
|
||||
* of this Specification. The value 1 is reserved for future use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t targeted_system_display_actual_peak_luminance_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of rows in the targeted system_display_actual_peak_luminance
|
||||
* array. The value shall be in the range of 2 to 25, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_rows_targeted_system_display_actual_peak_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of columns in the
|
||||
* targeted_system_display_actual_peak_luminance array. The value shall be
|
||||
* in the range of 2 to 25, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_cols_targeted_system_display_actual_peak_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The normalized actual peak luminance of the targeted system display. The
|
||||
* values should be in the range of 0 to 1, inclusive and in multiples of
|
||||
* 1/15.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational targeted_system_display_actual_peak_luminance[25][25];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag shall be equal to 0 in bitstreams conforming to this version of
|
||||
* this Specification. The value 1 is reserved for future use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of rows in the mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance array.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 2 to 25, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_rows_mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of columns in the mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance
|
||||
* array. The value shall be in the range of 2 to 25, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_cols_mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The normalized actual peak luminance of the mastering display used for
|
||||
* mastering the image essence. The values should be in the range of 0 to 1,
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1/15.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational mastering_display_actual_peak_luminance[25][25];
|
||||
} AVDynamicHDRPlus;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVDynamicHDRPlus structure and set its fields to
|
||||
* default values. The resulting struct can be freed using av_freep().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return An AVDynamicHDRPlus filled with default values or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDynamicHDRPlus *av_dynamic_hdr_plus_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a complete AVDynamicHDRPlus and add it to the frame.
|
||||
* @param frame The frame which side data is added to.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The AVDynamicHDRPlus structure to be filled by caller or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDynamicHDRPlus *av_dynamic_hdr_plus_create_side_data(AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parse the user data registered ITU-T T.35 to AVbuffer (AVDynamicHDRPlus).
|
||||
* The T.35 buffer must begin with the application mode, skipping the
|
||||
* country code, terminal provider codes, and application identifier.
|
||||
* @param s A pointer containing the decoded AVDynamicHDRPlus structure.
|
||||
* @param data The byte array containing the raw ITU-T T.35 data.
|
||||
* @param size Size of the data array in bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success. Otherwise, returns the appropriate AVERROR.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dynamic_hdr_plus_from_t35(AVDynamicHDRPlus *s, const uint8_t *data,
|
||||
size_t size);
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_HDR_PLUS_MAX_PAYLOAD_SIZE 907
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Serialize dynamic HDR10+ metadata to a user data registered ITU-T T.35 buffer,
|
||||
* excluding the first 48 bytes of the header, and beginning with the application mode.
|
||||
* @param s A pointer containing the decoded AVDynamicHDRPlus structure.
|
||||
* @param[in,out] data A pointer to pointer to a byte buffer to be filled with the
|
||||
* serialized metadata.
|
||||
* If *data is NULL, a buffer be will be allocated and a pointer to
|
||||
* it stored in its place. The caller assumes ownership of the buffer.
|
||||
* May be NULL, in which case the function will only store the
|
||||
* required buffer size in *size.
|
||||
* @param[in,out] size A pointer to a size to be set to the returned buffer's size.
|
||||
* If *data is not NULL, *size must contain the size of the input
|
||||
* buffer. May be NULL only if *data is NULL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return >= 0 on success. Otherwise, returns the appropriate AVERROR.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_dynamic_hdr_plus_to_t35(const AVDynamicHDRPlus *s, uint8_t **data, size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_METADATA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,346 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2021 Limin Wang <lance.lmwang at gmail.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_VIVID_METADATA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_VIVID_METADATA_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* HDR Vivid three spline params.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHDRVivid3SplineParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mode of three Spline. the value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 0 to 3, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int th_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* three_Spline_TH_enable_MB is in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/255.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational th_enable_mb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_enable of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational th_enable;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_Delta1 of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 0.25, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.25/1023.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational th_delta1;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_Delta2 of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 0.25, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.25/1023.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational th_delta2;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_enable_Strength of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/255.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational enable_strength;
|
||||
} AVHDRVivid3SplineParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Color tone mapping parameters at a processing window in a dynamic metadata for
|
||||
* CUVA 005.1:2021.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHDRVividColorToneMappingParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The nominal maximum display luminance of the targeted system display,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/4095 candelas per square metre. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational targeted_system_display_maximum_luminance;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag indicates that transfer the base paramter(for value of 1)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int base_enable_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_m_p in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/16383. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_m_p;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_m_m in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/10. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 6.3, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_m_m;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_m_a in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/1023. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_m_a;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_m_b in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1/1023. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_m_b;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_m_n in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/10. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 6.3, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_m_n;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* indicates k1_0 in the base parameter,
|
||||
* base_param_k1 <= 1: k1_0 = base_param_k1
|
||||
* base_param_k1 > 1: reserved
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int base_param_k1;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* indicates k2_0 in the base parameter,
|
||||
* base_param_k2 <= 1: k2_0 = base_param_k2
|
||||
* base_param_k2 > 1: reserved
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int base_param_k2;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* indicates k3_0 in the base parameter,
|
||||
* base_param_k3 == 1: k3_0 = base_param_k3
|
||||
* base_param_k3 == 2: k3_0 = maximum_maxrgb
|
||||
* base_param_k3 > 2: reserved
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int base_param_k3;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag indicates that delta mode of base paramter(for value of 1)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int base_param_Delta_enable_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* base_param_Delta in the base parameter,
|
||||
* in multiples of 1.0/127. The value shall be in
|
||||
* the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational base_param_Delta;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* indicates 3Spline_enable_flag in the base parameter,
|
||||
* This flag indicates that transfer three Spline of base paramter(for value of 1)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int three_Spline_enable_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of three Spline. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 1 to 2, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int three_Spline_num;
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_HDR_VIVID_THREE_SPLINE
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mode of three Spline. the value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 0 to 3, inclusive.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
int three_Spline_TH_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* three_Spline_TH_enable_MB is in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/255.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVRational three_Spline_TH_enable_MB;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_enable of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive.
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/4095.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVRational three_Spline_TH_enable;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_Delta1 of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 0.25, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.25/1023.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVRational three_Spline_TH_Delta1;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_TH_Delta2 of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 0.25, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 0.25/1023.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVRational three_Spline_TH_Delta2;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* 3Spline_enable_Strength of three Spline.
|
||||
* The value shall be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive,
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1.0/255.
|
||||
* @deprecated Use three_spline instead
|
||||
*/
|
||||
attribute_deprecated
|
||||
AVRational three_Spline_enable_Strength;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
AVHDRVivid3SplineParams three_spline[2];
|
||||
} AVHDRVividColorToneMappingParams;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Color transform parameters at a processing window in a dynamic metadata for
|
||||
* CUVA 005.1:2021.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHDRVividColorTransformParams {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates the minimum brightness of the displayed content.
|
||||
* The values should be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0,
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational minimum_maxrgb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates the average brightness of the displayed content.
|
||||
* The values should be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0,
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational average_maxrgb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates the variance brightness of the displayed content.
|
||||
* The values should be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0,
|
||||
* inclusive and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational variance_maxrgb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates the maximum brightness of the displayed content.
|
||||
* The values should be in the range of 0.0 to 1.0, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1/4095.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational maximum_maxrgb;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag indicates that the metadata for the tone mapping function in
|
||||
* the processing window is present (for value of 1).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int tone_mapping_mode_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of tone mapping param. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 1 to 2, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int tone_mapping_param_num;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The color tone mapping parameters.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHDRVividColorToneMappingParams tm_params[2];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This flag indicates that the metadata for the color saturation mapping in
|
||||
* the processing window is present (for value of 1).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int color_saturation_mapping_flag;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of color saturation param. The value shall be in the range
|
||||
* of 0 to 7, inclusive.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int color_saturation_num;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Indicates the color correction strength parameter.
|
||||
* The values should be in the range of 0.0 to 2.0, inclusive
|
||||
* and in multiples of 1/128.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational color_saturation_gain[8];
|
||||
} AVHDRVividColorTransformParams;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct represents dynamic metadata for color volume transform -
|
||||
* CUVA 005.1:2021 standard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To be used as payload of a AVFrameSideData or AVPacketSideData with the
|
||||
* appropriate type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with
|
||||
* av_dynamic_hdr_vivid_alloc() and its size is not a part of
|
||||
* the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDynamicHDRVivid {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The system start code. The value shall be set to 0x01.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t system_start_code;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The number of processing windows. The value shall be set to 0x01
|
||||
* if the system_start_code is 0x01.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t num_windows;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The color transform parameters for every processing window.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHDRVividColorTransformParams params[3];
|
||||
} AVDynamicHDRVivid;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVDynamicHDRVivid structure and set its fields to
|
||||
* default values. The resulting struct can be freed using av_freep().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return An AVDynamicHDRVivid filled with default values or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDynamicHDRVivid *av_dynamic_hdr_vivid_alloc(size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a complete AVDynamicHDRVivid and add it to the frame.
|
||||
* @param frame The frame which side data is added to.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The AVDynamicHDRVivid structure to be filled by caller or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDynamicHDRVivid *av_dynamic_hdr_vivid_create_side_data(AVFrame *frame);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HDR_DYNAMIC_VIVID_METADATA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2012 Martin Storsjo
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HMAC_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HMAC_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_hmac HMAC
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVHMACType {
|
||||
AV_HMAC_MD5,
|
||||
AV_HMAC_SHA1,
|
||||
AV_HMAC_SHA224,
|
||||
AV_HMAC_SHA256,
|
||||
AV_HMAC_SHA384,
|
||||
AV_HMAC_SHA512,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVHMAC AVHMAC;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVHMAC context.
|
||||
* @param type The hash function used for the HMAC.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHMAC *av_hmac_alloc(enum AVHMACType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVHMAC context.
|
||||
* @param ctx The context to free, may be NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hmac_free(AVHMAC *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initialize an AVHMAC context with an authentication key.
|
||||
* @param ctx The HMAC context
|
||||
* @param key The authentication key
|
||||
* @param keylen The length of the key, in bytes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hmac_init(AVHMAC *ctx, const uint8_t *key, unsigned int keylen);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Hash data with the HMAC.
|
||||
* @param ctx The HMAC context
|
||||
* @param data The data to hash
|
||||
* @param len The length of the data, in bytes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hmac_update(AVHMAC *ctx, const uint8_t *data, unsigned int len);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finish hashing and output the HMAC digest.
|
||||
* @param ctx The HMAC context
|
||||
* @param out The output buffer to write the digest into
|
||||
* @param outlen The length of the out buffer, in bytes
|
||||
* @return The number of bytes written to out, or a negative error code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hmac_final(AVHMAC *ctx, uint8_t *out, unsigned int outlen);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Hash an array of data with a key.
|
||||
* @param ctx The HMAC context
|
||||
* @param data The data to hash
|
||||
* @param len The length of the data, in bytes
|
||||
* @param key The authentication key
|
||||
* @param keylen The length of the key, in bytes
|
||||
* @param out The output buffer to write the digest into
|
||||
* @param outlen The length of the out buffer, in bytes
|
||||
* @return The number of bytes written to out, or a negative error code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hmac_calc(AVHMAC *ctx, const uint8_t *data, unsigned int len,
|
||||
const uint8_t *key, unsigned int keylen,
|
||||
uint8_t *out, unsigned int outlen);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HMAC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,598 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "buffer.h"
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
#include "log.h"
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType {
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_NONE,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VDPAU,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_CUDA,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VAAPI,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_DXVA2,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_QSV,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VIDEOTOOLBOX,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_D3D11VA,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_DRM,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_OPENCL,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_MEDIACODEC,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VULKAN,
|
||||
AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_D3D12VA,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct aggregates all the (hardware/vendor-specific) "high-level" state,
|
||||
* i.e. state that is not tied to a concrete processing configuration.
|
||||
* E.g., in an API that supports hardware-accelerated encoding and decoding,
|
||||
* this struct will (if possible) wrap the state that is common to both encoding
|
||||
* and decoding and from which specific instances of encoders or decoders can be
|
||||
* derived.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This struct is reference-counted with the AVBuffer mechanism. The
|
||||
* av_hwdevice_ctx_alloc() constructor yields a reference, whose data field
|
||||
* points to the actual AVHWDeviceContext. Further objects derived from
|
||||
* AVHWDeviceContext (such as AVHWFramesContext, describing a frame pool with
|
||||
* specific properties) will hold an internal reference to it. After all the
|
||||
* references are released, the AVHWDeviceContext itself will be freed,
|
||||
* optionally invoking a user-specified callback for uninitializing the hardware
|
||||
* state.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHWDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A class for logging. Set by av_hwdevice_ctx_alloc().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This field identifies the underlying API used for hardware access.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This field is set when this struct is allocated and never changed
|
||||
* afterwards.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The format-specific data, allocated and freed by libavutil along with
|
||||
* this context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Should be cast by the user to the format-specific context defined in the
|
||||
* corresponding header (hwcontext_*.h) and filled as described in the
|
||||
* documentation before calling av_hwdevice_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After calling av_hwdevice_ctx_init() this struct should not be modified
|
||||
* by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *hwctx;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This field may be set by the caller before calling av_hwdevice_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If non-NULL, this callback will be called when the last reference to
|
||||
* this context is unreferenced, immediately before it is freed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note when other objects (e.g an AVHWFramesContext) are derived from this
|
||||
* struct, this callback will be invoked after all such child objects
|
||||
* are fully uninitialized and their respective destructors invoked.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*free)(struct AVHWDeviceContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Arbitrary user data, to be used e.g. by the free() callback.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *user_opaque;
|
||||
} AVHWDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct describes a set or pool of "hardware" frames (i.e. those with
|
||||
* data not located in normal system memory). All the frames in the pool are
|
||||
* assumed to be allocated in the same way and interchangeable.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This struct is reference-counted with the AVBuffer mechanism and tied to a
|
||||
* given AVHWDeviceContext instance. The av_hwframe_ctx_alloc() constructor
|
||||
* yields a reference, whose data field points to the actual AVHWFramesContext
|
||||
* struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHWFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A class for logging.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A reference to the parent AVHWDeviceContext. This reference is owned and
|
||||
* managed by the enclosing AVHWFramesContext, but the caller may derive
|
||||
* additional references from it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *device_ref;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The parent AVHWDeviceContext. This is simply a pointer to
|
||||
* device_ref->data provided for convenience.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by libavutil in av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHWDeviceContext *device_ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The format-specific data, allocated and freed automatically along with
|
||||
* this context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The user shall ignore this field if the corresponding format-specific
|
||||
* header (hwcontext_*.h) does not define a context to be used as
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.hwctx.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Otherwise, it should be cast by the user to said context and filled
|
||||
* as described in the documentation before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After any frames using this context are created, the contents of this
|
||||
* struct should not be modified by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *hwctx;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This field may be set by the caller before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If non-NULL, this callback will be called when the last reference to
|
||||
* this context is unreferenced, immediately before it is freed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*free)(struct AVHWFramesContext *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Arbitrary user data, to be used e.g. by the free() callback.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *user_opaque;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A pool from which the frames are allocated by av_hwframe_get_buffer().
|
||||
* This field may be set by the caller before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
* The buffers returned by calling av_buffer_pool_get() on this pool must
|
||||
* have the properties described in the documentation in the corresponding hw
|
||||
* type's header (hwcontext_*.h). The pool will be freed strictly before
|
||||
* this struct's free() callback is invoked.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This field may be NULL, then libavutil will attempt to allocate a pool
|
||||
* internally. Note that certain device types enforce pools allocated at
|
||||
* fixed size (frame count), which cannot be extended dynamically. In such a
|
||||
* case, initial_pool_size must be set appropriately.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferPool *pool;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Initial size of the frame pool. If a device type does not support
|
||||
* dynamically resizing the pool, then this is also the maximum pool size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* May be set by the caller before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init(). Must be
|
||||
* set if pool is NULL and the device type does not support dynamic pools.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int initial_pool_size;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The pixel format identifying the underlying HW surface type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be a hwaccel format, i.e. the corresponding descriptor must have the
|
||||
* AV_PIX_FMT_FLAG_HWACCEL flag set.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be set by the user before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat format;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The pixel format identifying the actual data layout of the hardware
|
||||
* frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be set by the caller before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note when the underlying API does not provide the exact data layout, but
|
||||
* only the colorspace/bit depth, this field should be set to the fully
|
||||
* planar version of that format (e.g. for 8-bit 420 YUV it should be
|
||||
* AV_PIX_FMT_YUV420P, not AV_PIX_FMT_NV12 or anything else).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat sw_format;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The allocated dimensions of the frames in this pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be set by the user before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int width, height;
|
||||
} AVHWFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Look up an AVHWDeviceType by name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param name String name of the device type (case-insensitive).
|
||||
* @return The type from enum AVHWDeviceType, or AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_NONE if
|
||||
* not found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType av_hwdevice_find_type_by_name(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/** Get the string name of an AVHWDeviceType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param type Type from enum AVHWDeviceType.
|
||||
* @return Pointer to a static string containing the name, or NULL if the type
|
||||
* is not valid.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *av_hwdevice_get_type_name(enum AVHWDeviceType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over supported device types.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param prev AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_NONE initially, then the previous type
|
||||
* returned by this function in subsequent iterations.
|
||||
* @return The next usable device type from enum AVHWDeviceType, or
|
||||
* AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_NONE if there are no more.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType av_hwdevice_iterate_types(enum AVHWDeviceType prev);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVHWDeviceContext for a given hardware type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param type the type of the hardware device to allocate.
|
||||
* @return a reference to the newly created AVHWDeviceContext on success or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_hwdevice_ctx_alloc(enum AVHWDeviceType type);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize the device context before use. This function must be called after
|
||||
* the context is filled with all the required information and before it is
|
||||
* used in any way.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ref a reference to the AVHWDeviceContext
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwdevice_ctx_init(AVBufferRef *ref);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Open a device of the specified type and create an AVHWDeviceContext for it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is a convenience function intended to cover the simple cases. Callers
|
||||
* who need to fine-tune device creation/management should open the device
|
||||
* manually and then wrap it in an AVHWDeviceContext using
|
||||
* av_hwdevice_ctx_alloc()/av_hwdevice_ctx_init().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The returned context is already initialized and ready for use, the caller
|
||||
* should not call av_hwdevice_ctx_init() on it. The user_opaque/free fields of
|
||||
* the created AVHWDeviceContext are set by this function and should not be
|
||||
* touched by the caller.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param device_ctx On success, a reference to the newly-created device context
|
||||
* will be written here. The reference is owned by the caller
|
||||
* and must be released with av_buffer_unref() when no longer
|
||||
* needed. On failure, NULL will be written to this pointer.
|
||||
* @param type The type of the device to create.
|
||||
* @param device A type-specific string identifying the device to open.
|
||||
* @param opts A dictionary of additional (type-specific) options to use in
|
||||
* opening the device. The dictionary remains owned by the caller.
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwdevice_ctx_create(AVBufferRef **device_ctx, enum AVHWDeviceType type,
|
||||
const char *device, AVDictionary *opts, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a new device of the specified type from an existing device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the source device is a device of the target type or was originally
|
||||
* derived from such a device (possibly through one or more intermediate
|
||||
* devices of other types), then this will return a reference to the
|
||||
* existing device of the same type as is requested.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Otherwise, it will attempt to derive a new device from the given source
|
||||
* device. If direct derivation to the new type is not implemented, it will
|
||||
* attempt the same derivation from each ancestor of the source device in
|
||||
* turn looking for an implemented derivation method.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_ctx On success, a reference to the newly-created
|
||||
* AVHWDeviceContext.
|
||||
* @param type The type of the new device to create.
|
||||
* @param src_ctx A reference to an existing AVHWDeviceContext which will be
|
||||
* used to create the new device.
|
||||
* @param flags Currently unused; should be set to zero.
|
||||
* @return Zero on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwdevice_ctx_create_derived(AVBufferRef **dst_ctx,
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType type,
|
||||
AVBufferRef *src_ctx, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create a new device of the specified type from an existing device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function performs the same action as av_hwdevice_ctx_create_derived,
|
||||
* however, it is able to set options for the new device to be derived.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_ctx On success, a reference to the newly-created
|
||||
* AVHWDeviceContext.
|
||||
* @param type The type of the new device to create.
|
||||
* @param src_ctx A reference to an existing AVHWDeviceContext which will be
|
||||
* used to create the new device.
|
||||
* @param options Options for the new device to create, same format as in
|
||||
* av_hwdevice_ctx_create.
|
||||
* @param flags Currently unused; should be set to zero.
|
||||
* @return Zero on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwdevice_ctx_create_derived_opts(AVBufferRef **dst_ctx,
|
||||
enum AVHWDeviceType type,
|
||||
AVBufferRef *src_ctx,
|
||||
AVDictionary *options, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an AVHWFramesContext tied to a given device context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param device_ctx a reference to a AVHWDeviceContext. This function will make
|
||||
* a new reference for internal use, the one passed to the
|
||||
* function remains owned by the caller.
|
||||
* @return a reference to the newly created AVHWFramesContext on success or NULL
|
||||
* on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVBufferRef *av_hwframe_ctx_alloc(AVBufferRef *device_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Finalize the context before use. This function must be called after the
|
||||
* context is filled with all the required information and before it is attached
|
||||
* to any frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ref a reference to the AVHWFramesContext
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_ctx_init(AVBufferRef *ref);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a new frame attached to the given AVHWFramesContext.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param hwframe_ctx a reference to an AVHWFramesContext
|
||||
* @param frame an empty (freshly allocated or unreffed) frame to be filled with
|
||||
* newly allocated buffers.
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused, should be set to zero
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_get_buffer(AVBufferRef *hwframe_ctx, AVFrame *frame, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy data to or from a hw surface. At least one of dst/src must have an
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext attached.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If src has an AVHWFramesContext attached, then the format of dst (if set)
|
||||
* must use one of the formats returned by av_hwframe_transfer_get_formats(src,
|
||||
* AV_HWFRAME_TRANSFER_DIRECTION_FROM).
|
||||
* If dst has an AVHWFramesContext attached, then the format of src must use one
|
||||
* of the formats returned by av_hwframe_transfer_get_formats(dst,
|
||||
* AV_HWFRAME_TRANSFER_DIRECTION_TO)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* dst may be "clean" (i.e. with data/buf pointers unset), in which case the
|
||||
* data buffers will be allocated by this function using av_frame_get_buffer().
|
||||
* If dst->format is set, then this format will be used, otherwise (when
|
||||
* dst->format is AV_PIX_FMT_NONE) the first acceptable format will be chosen.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The two frames must have matching allocated dimensions (i.e. equal to
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.width/height), since not all device types support
|
||||
* transferring a sub-rectangle of the whole surface. The display dimensions
|
||||
* (i.e. AVFrame.width/height) may be smaller than the allocated dimensions, but
|
||||
* also have to be equal for both frames. When the display dimensions are
|
||||
* smaller than the allocated dimensions, the content of the padding in the
|
||||
* destination frame is unspecified.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst the destination frame. dst is not touched on failure.
|
||||
* @param src the source frame.
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused, should be set to zero
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR error code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_transfer_data(AVFrame *dst, const AVFrame *src, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVHWFrameTransferDirection {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Transfer the data from the queried hw frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_TRANSFER_DIRECTION_FROM,
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Transfer the data to the queried hw frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_TRANSFER_DIRECTION_TO,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get a list of possible source or target formats usable in
|
||||
* av_hwframe_transfer_data().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param hwframe_ctx the frame context to obtain the information for
|
||||
* @param dir the direction of the transfer
|
||||
* @param formats the pointer to the output format list will be written here.
|
||||
* The list is terminated with AV_PIX_FMT_NONE and must be freed
|
||||
* by the caller when no longer needed using av_free().
|
||||
* If this function returns successfully, the format list will
|
||||
* have at least one item (not counting the terminator).
|
||||
* On failure, the contents of this pointer are unspecified.
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused, should be set to zero
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_transfer_get_formats(AVBufferRef *hwframe_ctx,
|
||||
enum AVHWFrameTransferDirection dir,
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat **formats, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct describes the constraints on hardware frames attached to
|
||||
* a given device with a hardware-specific configuration. This is returned
|
||||
* by av_hwdevice_get_hwframe_constraints() and must be freed by
|
||||
* av_hwframe_constraints_free() after use.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVHWFramesConstraints {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A list of possible values for format in the hw_frames_ctx,
|
||||
* terminated by AV_PIX_FMT_NONE. This member will always be filled.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat *valid_hw_formats;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A list of possible values for sw_format in the hw_frames_ctx,
|
||||
* terminated by AV_PIX_FMT_NONE. Can be NULL if this information is
|
||||
* not known.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat *valid_sw_formats;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The minimum size of frames in this hw_frames_ctx.
|
||||
* (Zero if not known.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int min_width;
|
||||
int min_height;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The maximum size of frames in this hw_frames_ctx.
|
||||
* (INT_MAX if not known / no limit.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int max_width;
|
||||
int max_height;
|
||||
} AVHWFramesConstraints;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a HW-specific configuration structure for a given HW device.
|
||||
* After use, the user must free all members as required by the specific
|
||||
* hardware structure being used, then free the structure itself with
|
||||
* av_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param device_ctx a reference to the associated AVHWDeviceContext.
|
||||
* @return The newly created HW-specific configuration structure on
|
||||
* success or NULL on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *av_hwdevice_hwconfig_alloc(AVBufferRef *device_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the constraints on HW frames given a device and the HW-specific
|
||||
* configuration to be used with that device. If no HW-specific
|
||||
* configuration is provided, returns the maximum possible capabilities
|
||||
* of the device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ref a reference to the associated AVHWDeviceContext.
|
||||
* @param hwconfig a filled HW-specific configuration structure, or NULL
|
||||
* to return the maximum possible capabilities of the device.
|
||||
* @return AVHWFramesConstraints structure describing the constraints
|
||||
* on the device, or NULL if not available.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVHWFramesConstraints *av_hwdevice_get_hwframe_constraints(AVBufferRef *ref,
|
||||
const void *hwconfig);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVHWFrameConstraints structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param constraints The (filled or unfilled) AVHWFrameConstraints structure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_hwframe_constraints_free(AVHWFramesConstraints **constraints);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Flags to apply to frame mappings.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mapping must be readable.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_MAP_READ = 1 << 0,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mapping must be writeable.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_MAP_WRITE = 1 << 1,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mapped frame will be overwritten completely in subsequent
|
||||
* operations, so the current frame data need not be loaded. Any values
|
||||
* which are not overwritten are unspecified.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_MAP_OVERWRITE = 1 << 2,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mapping must be direct. That is, there must not be any copying in
|
||||
* the map or unmap steps. Note that performance of direct mappings may
|
||||
* be much lower than normal memory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_HWFRAME_MAP_DIRECT = 1 << 3,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Map a hardware frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This has a number of different possible effects, depending on the format
|
||||
* and origin of the src and dst frames. On input, src should be a usable
|
||||
* frame with valid buffers and dst should be blank (typically as just created
|
||||
* by av_frame_alloc()). src should have an associated hwframe context, and
|
||||
* dst may optionally have a format and associated hwframe context.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If src was created by mapping a frame from the hwframe context of dst,
|
||||
* then this function undoes the mapping - dst is replaced by a reference to
|
||||
* the frame that src was originally mapped from.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If both src and dst have an associated hwframe context, then this function
|
||||
* attempts to map the src frame from its hardware context to that of dst and
|
||||
* then fill dst with appropriate data to be usable there. This will only be
|
||||
* possible if the hwframe contexts and associated devices are compatible -
|
||||
* given compatible devices, av_hwframe_ctx_create_derived() can be used to
|
||||
* create a hwframe context for dst in which mapping should be possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If src has a hwframe context but dst does not, then the src frame is
|
||||
* mapped to normal memory and should thereafter be usable as a normal frame.
|
||||
* If the format is set on dst, then the mapping will attempt to create dst
|
||||
* with that format and fail if it is not possible. If format is unset (is
|
||||
* AV_PIX_FMT_NONE) then dst will be mapped with whatever the most appropriate
|
||||
* format to use is (probably the sw_format of the src hwframe context).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A return value of AVERROR(ENOSYS) indicates that the mapping is not
|
||||
* possible with the given arguments and hwframe setup, while other return
|
||||
* values indicate that it failed somehow.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* On failure, the destination frame will be left blank, except for the
|
||||
* hw_frames_ctx/format fields thay may have been set by the caller - those will
|
||||
* be preserved as they were.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst Destination frame, to contain the mapping.
|
||||
* @param src Source frame, to be mapped.
|
||||
* @param flags Some combination of AV_HWFRAME_MAP_* flags.
|
||||
* @return Zero on success, negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_map(AVFrame *dst, const AVFrame *src, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Create and initialise an AVHWFramesContext as a mapping of another existing
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext on a different device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* av_hwframe_ctx_init() should not be called after this.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param derived_frame_ctx On success, a reference to the newly created
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.
|
||||
* @param format The AVPixelFormat for the derived context.
|
||||
* @param derived_device_ctx A reference to the device to create the new
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext on.
|
||||
* @param source_frame_ctx A reference to an existing AVHWFramesContext
|
||||
* which will be mapped to the derived context.
|
||||
* @param flags Some combination of AV_HWFRAME_MAP_* flags, defining the
|
||||
* mapping parameters to apply to frames which are allocated
|
||||
* in the derived device.
|
||||
* @return Zero on success, negative AVERROR code on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_hwframe_ctx_create_derived(AVBufferRef **derived_frame_ctx,
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat format,
|
||||
AVBufferRef *derived_device_ctx,
|
||||
AVBufferRef *source_frame_ctx,
|
||||
int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_CUDA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_CUDA_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef CUDA_VERSION
|
||||
#include <cuda.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_CUDA.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This API supports dynamic frame pools. AVHWFramesContext.pool must return
|
||||
* AVBufferRefs whose data pointer is a CUdeviceptr.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVCUDADeviceContextInternal AVCUDADeviceContextInternal;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVCUDADeviceContext {
|
||||
CUcontext cuda_ctx;
|
||||
CUstream stream;
|
||||
AVCUDADeviceContextInternal *internal;
|
||||
} AVCUDADeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.hwctx is currently not used
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup hwcontext_cuda Device context creation flags
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Flags for av_hwdevice_ctx_create.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Use primary device context instead of creating a new one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CUDA_USE_PRIMARY_CONTEXT (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Use current device context instead of creating a new one.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_CUDA_USE_CURRENT_CONTEXT (1 << 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_CUDA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,178 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D11VA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D11VA_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_D3D11VA.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The default pool implementation will be fixed-size if initial_pool_size is
|
||||
* set (and allocate elements from an array texture). Otherwise it will allocate
|
||||
* individual textures. Be aware that decoding requires a single array texture.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Using sw_format==AV_PIX_FMT_YUV420P has special semantics, and maps to
|
||||
* DXGI_FORMAT_420_OPAQUE. av_hwframe_transfer_data() is not supported for
|
||||
* this format. Refer to MSDN for details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* av_hwdevice_ctx_create() for this device type supports a key named "debug"
|
||||
* for the AVDictionary entry. If this is set to any value, the device creation
|
||||
* code will try to load various supported D3D debugging layers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <d3d11.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D11VADeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Device used for texture creation and access. This can also be used to
|
||||
* set the libavcodec decoding device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be set by the user. This is the only mandatory field - the other
|
||||
* device context fields are set from this and are available for convenience.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11Device *device;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If unset, this will be set from the device field on init.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11DeviceContext *device_context;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If unset, this will be set from the device field on init.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11VideoDevice *video_device;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If unset, this will be set from the device_context field on init.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11VideoContext *video_context;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callbacks for locking. They protect accesses to device_context and
|
||||
* video_context calls. They also protect access to the internal staging
|
||||
* texture (for av_hwframe_transfer_data() calls). They do NOT protect
|
||||
* access to hwcontext or decoder state in general.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If unset on init, the hwcontext implementation will set them to use an
|
||||
* internal mutex.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The underlying lock must be recursive. lock_ctx is for free use by the
|
||||
* locking implementation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*lock)(void *lock_ctx);
|
||||
void (*unlock)(void *lock_ctx);
|
||||
void *lock_ctx;
|
||||
} AVD3D11VADeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11 frame descriptor for pool allocation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In user-allocated pools, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs
|
||||
* with the data pointer pointing at an object of this type describing the
|
||||
* planes of the frame.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This has no use outside of custom allocation, and AVFrame AVBufferRef do not
|
||||
* necessarily point to an instance of this struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D11FrameDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The texture in which the frame is located. The reference count is
|
||||
* managed by the AVBufferRef, and destroying the reference will release
|
||||
* the interface.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Normally stored in AVFrame.data[0].
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11Texture2D *texture;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The index into the array texture element representing the frame, or 0
|
||||
* if the texture is not an array texture.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Normally stored in AVFrame.data[1] (cast from intptr_t).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
intptr_t index;
|
||||
} AVD3D11FrameDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D11VAFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The canonical texture used for pool allocation. If this is set to NULL
|
||||
* on init, the hwframes implementation will allocate and set an array
|
||||
* texture if initial_pool_size > 0.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The only situation when the API user should set this is:
|
||||
* - the user wants to do manual pool allocation (setting
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.pool), instead of letting AVHWFramesContext
|
||||
* allocate the pool
|
||||
* - of an array texture
|
||||
* - and wants it to use it for decoding
|
||||
* - this has to be done before calling av_hwframe_ctx_init()
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWFramesContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is in particular used by the libavcodec D3D11VA hwaccel, which
|
||||
* requires a single array texture. It will create ID3D11VideoDecoderOutputView
|
||||
* objects for each array texture element on decoder initialization.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D11Texture2D *texture;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11_TEXTURE2D_DESC.BindFlags used for texture creation. The user must
|
||||
* at least set D3D11_BIND_DECODER if the frames context is to be used for
|
||||
* video decoding.
|
||||
* This field is ignored/invalid if a user-allocated texture is provided.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
UINT BindFlags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D11_TEXTURE2D_DESC.MiscFlags used for texture creation.
|
||||
* This field is ignored/invalid if a user-allocated texture is provided.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
UINT MiscFlags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* In case if texture structure member above is not NULL contains the same texture
|
||||
* pointer for all elements and different indexes into the array texture.
|
||||
* In case if texture structure member above is NULL, all elements contains
|
||||
* pointers to separate non-array textures and 0 indexes.
|
||||
* This field is ignored/invalid if a user-allocated texture is provided.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVD3D11FrameDescriptor *texture_infos;
|
||||
} AVD3D11VAFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D11VA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,134 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Direct3D 12 HW acceleration.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2022-2023 Wu Jianhua <toqsxw@outlook.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D12VA_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D12VA_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_D3D12VA.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.pool must contain AVBufferRefs whose
|
||||
* data pointer points to an AVD3D12VAFrame struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <initguid.h>
|
||||
#include <d3d12.h>
|
||||
#include <d3d12sdklayers.h>
|
||||
#include <d3d12video.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D12VADeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Device used for objects creation and access. This can also be
|
||||
* used to set the libavcodec decoding device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Can be set by the user. This is the only mandatory field - the other
|
||||
* device context fields are set from this and are available for convenience.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D12Device *device;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* If unset, this will be set from the device field on init.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always release this interface,
|
||||
* and it does not matter whether it was user-allocated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D12VideoDevice *video_device;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callbacks for locking. They protect access to the internal staging
|
||||
* texture (for av_hwframe_transfer_data() calls). They do NOT protect
|
||||
* access to hwcontext or decoder state in general.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If unset on init, the hwcontext implementation will set them to use an
|
||||
* internal mutex.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The underlying lock must be recursive. lock_ctx is for free use by the
|
||||
* locking implementation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*lock)(void *lock_ctx);
|
||||
void (*unlock)(void *lock_ctx);
|
||||
void *lock_ctx;
|
||||
} AVD3D12VADeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief This struct is used to sync d3d12 execution
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D12VASyncContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* D3D12 fence object
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D12Fence *fence;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A handle to the event object that's raised when the fence
|
||||
* reaches a certain value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
HANDLE event;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The fence value used for sync
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t fence_value;
|
||||
} AVD3D12VASyncContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief D3D12VA frame descriptor for pool allocation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D12VAFrame {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The texture in which the frame is located. The reference count is
|
||||
* managed by the AVBufferRef, and destroying the reference will release
|
||||
* the interface.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ID3D12Resource *texture;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The sync context for the texture
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see: https://learn.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/medfound/direct3d-12-video-overview#directx-12-fences
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVD3D12VASyncContext sync_ctx;
|
||||
} AVD3D12VAFrame;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief This struct is allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVD3D12VAFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DXGI_FORMAT format. MUST be compatible with the pixel format.
|
||||
* If unset, will be automatically set.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
DXGI_FORMAT format;
|
||||
} AVD3D12VAFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_D3D12VA_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,169 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DRM_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DRM_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_DRM.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Internal frame allocation is not currently supported - all frames
|
||||
* must be allocated by the user. Thus AVHWFramesContext is always
|
||||
* NULL, though this may change if support for frame allocation is
|
||||
* added in future.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The maximum number of layers/planes in a DRM frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_DRM_MAX_PLANES = 4
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM object descriptor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Describes a single DRM object, addressing it as a PRIME file
|
||||
* descriptor.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDRMObjectDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM PRIME fd for the object.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Total size of the object.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* (This includes any parts not which do not contain image data.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t size;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Format modifier applied to the object (DRM_FORMAT_MOD_*).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the format modifier is unknown then this should be set to
|
||||
* DRM_FORMAT_MOD_INVALID.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t format_modifier;
|
||||
} AVDRMObjectDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM plane descriptor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Describes a single plane of a layer, which is contained within
|
||||
* a single object.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDRMPlaneDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Index of the object containing this plane in the objects
|
||||
* array of the enclosing frame descriptor.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int object_index;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset within that object of this plane.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ptrdiff_t offset;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pitch (linesize) of this plane.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ptrdiff_t pitch;
|
||||
} AVDRMPlaneDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM layer descriptor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Describes a single layer within a frame. This has the structure
|
||||
* defined by its format, and will contain one or more planes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDRMLayerDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Format of the layer (DRM_FORMAT_*).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t format;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of planes in the layer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This must match the number of planes required by format.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_planes;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of planes in this layer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDRMPlaneDescriptor planes[AV_DRM_MAX_PLANES];
|
||||
} AVDRMLayerDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM frame descriptor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is used as the data pointer for AV_PIX_FMT_DRM_PRIME frames.
|
||||
* It is also used by user-allocated frame pools - allocating in
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs which contain
|
||||
* an object of this type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The fields of this structure should be set such it can be
|
||||
* imported directly by EGL using the EGL_EXT_image_dma_buf_import
|
||||
* and EGL_EXT_image_dma_buf_import_modifiers extensions.
|
||||
* (Note that the exact layout of a particular format may vary between
|
||||
* platforms - we only specify that the same platform should be able
|
||||
* to import it.)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The total number of planes must not exceed AV_DRM_MAX_PLANES, and
|
||||
* the order of the planes by increasing layer index followed by
|
||||
* increasing plane index must be the same as the order which would
|
||||
* be used for the data pointers in the equivalent software format.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDRMFrameDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of DRM objects making up this frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_objects;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of objects making up the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDRMObjectDescriptor objects[AV_DRM_MAX_PLANES];
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of layers in the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_layers;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of layers in the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDRMLayerDescriptor layers[AV_DRM_MAX_PLANES];
|
||||
} AVDRMFrameDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* DRM device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDRMDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* File descriptor of DRM device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is used as the device to create frames on, and may also be
|
||||
* used in some derivation and mapping operations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If no device is required, set to -1.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
} AVDRMDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DRM_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DXVA2_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DXVA2_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_DXVA2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Only fixed-size pools are supported.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For user-allocated pools, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs
|
||||
* with the data pointer set to a pointer to IDirect3DSurface9.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <d3d9.h>
|
||||
#include <dxva2api.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDXVA2DeviceContext {
|
||||
IDirect3DDeviceManager9 *devmgr;
|
||||
} AVDXVA2DeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVDXVA2FramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The surface type (e.g. DXVA2_VideoProcessorRenderTarget or
|
||||
* DXVA2_VideoDecoderRenderTarget). Must be set by the caller.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
DWORD surface_type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The surface pool. When an external pool is not provided by the caller,
|
||||
* this will be managed (allocated and filled on init, freed on uninit) by
|
||||
* libavutil.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
IDirect3DSurface9 **surfaces;
|
||||
int nb_surfaces;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Certain drivers require the decoder to be destroyed before the surfaces.
|
||||
* To allow internally managed pools to work properly in such cases, this
|
||||
* field is provided.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If it is non-NULL, libavutil will call IDirectXVideoDecoder_Release() on
|
||||
* it just before the internal surface pool is freed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is for convenience only. Some code uses other methods to manage the
|
||||
* decoder reference.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
IDirectXVideoDecoder *decoder_to_release;
|
||||
} AVDXVA2FramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_DXVA2_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_MEDIACODEC_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_MEDIACODEC_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* MediaCodec details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVMediaCodecDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* android/view/Surface handle, to be filled by the user.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the default surface used by decoders on this device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *surface;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pointer to ANativeWindow.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It both surface and native_window is NULL, try to create it
|
||||
* automatically if create_window is true and OS support
|
||||
* createPersistentInputSurface.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It can be used as output surface for decoder and input surface for
|
||||
* encoder.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *native_window;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Enable createPersistentInputSurface automatically.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Disabled by default.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It can be enabled by setting this flag directly, or by setting
|
||||
* AVDictionary of av_hwdevice_ctx_create(), with "create_window" as key.
|
||||
* The second method is useful for ffmpeg cmdline, e.g., we can enable it
|
||||
* via:
|
||||
* -init_hw_device mediacodec=mediacodec,create_window=1
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int create_window;
|
||||
} AVMediaCodecDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_MEDIACODEC_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_OPENCL_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_OPENCL_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __APPLE__
|
||||
#include <OpenCL/cl.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <CL/cl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_OPENCL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Pools allocated internally are always dynamic, and are primarily intended
|
||||
* to be used in OpenCL-only cases. If interoperation is required, it is
|
||||
* typically required to allocate frames in the other API and then map the
|
||||
* frames context to OpenCL with av_hwframe_ctx_create_derived().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* OpenCL frame descriptor for pool allocation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In user-allocated pools, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs
|
||||
* with the data pointer pointing at an object of this type describing the
|
||||
* planes of the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVOpenCLFrameDescriptor {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of planes in the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_planes;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* OpenCL image2d objects for each plane of the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
cl_mem planes[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
} AVOpenCLFrameDescriptor;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* OpenCL device details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVOpenCLDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The primary device ID of the device. If multiple OpenCL devices
|
||||
* are associated with the context then this is the one which will
|
||||
* be used for all operations internal to FFmpeg.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
cl_device_id device_id;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The OpenCL context which will contain all operations and frames on
|
||||
* this device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
cl_context context;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The default command queue for this device, which will be used by all
|
||||
* frames contexts which do not have their own command queue. If not
|
||||
* intialised by the user, a default queue will be created on the
|
||||
* primary device.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
cl_command_queue command_queue;
|
||||
} AVOpenCLDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* OpenCL-specific data associated with a frame pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVOpenCLFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The command queue used for internal asynchronous operations on this
|
||||
* device (av_hwframe_transfer_data(), av_hwframe_map()).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this is not set, the command queue from the associated device is
|
||||
* used instead.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
cl_command_queue command_queue;
|
||||
} AVOpenCLFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_OPENCL_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_QSV_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_QSV_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <mfxvideo.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_QSV.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This API does not support dynamic frame pools. AVHWFramesContext.pool must
|
||||
* contain AVBufferRefs whose data pointer points to an mfxFrameSurface1 struct.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVQSVDeviceContext {
|
||||
mfxSession session;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The mfxLoader handle used for mfxSession creation
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This field is only available for oneVPL user. For non-oneVPL user, this
|
||||
* field must be set to NULL.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Filled by the user before calling av_hwdevice_ctx_init() and should be
|
||||
* cast to mfxLoader handle. Deallocating the AVHWDeviceContext will always
|
||||
* release this interface.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *loader;
|
||||
} AVQSVDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVQSVFramesContext {
|
||||
mfxFrameSurface1 *surfaces;
|
||||
int nb_surfaces;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A combination of MFX_MEMTYPE_* describing the frame pool.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int frame_type;
|
||||
} AVQSVFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_QSV_H */
|
||||
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,117 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VAAPI_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VAAPI_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <va/va.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VAAPI.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Dynamic frame pools are supported, but note that any pool used as a render
|
||||
* target is required to be of fixed size in order to be be usable as an
|
||||
* argument to vaCreateContext().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For user-allocated pools, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs
|
||||
* with the data pointer set to a VASurfaceID.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The quirks field has been set by the user and should not be detected
|
||||
* automatically by av_hwdevice_ctx_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_VAAPI_DRIVER_QUIRK_USER_SET = (1 << 0),
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The driver does not destroy parameter buffers when they are used by
|
||||
* vaRenderPicture(). Additional code will be required to destroy them
|
||||
* separately afterwards.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_VAAPI_DRIVER_QUIRK_RENDER_PARAM_BUFFERS = (1 << 1),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The driver does not support the VASurfaceAttribMemoryType attribute,
|
||||
* so the surface allocation code will not try to use it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_VAAPI_DRIVER_QUIRK_ATTRIB_MEMTYPE = (1 << 2),
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The driver does not support surface attributes at all.
|
||||
* The surface allocation code will never pass them to surface allocation,
|
||||
* and the results of the vaQuerySurfaceAttributes() call will be faked.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_VAAPI_DRIVER_QUIRK_SURFACE_ATTRIBUTES = (1 << 3),
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* VAAPI connection details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVAAPIDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The VADisplay handle, to be filled by the user.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VADisplay display;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Driver quirks to apply - this is filled by av_hwdevice_ctx_init(),
|
||||
* with reference to a table of known drivers, unless the
|
||||
* AV_VAAPI_DRIVER_QUIRK_USER_SET bit is already present. The user
|
||||
* may need to refer to this field when performing any later
|
||||
* operations using VAAPI with the same VADisplay.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int driver_quirks;
|
||||
} AVVAAPIDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* VAAPI-specific data associated with a frame pool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVAAPIFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set by the user to apply surface attributes to all surfaces in
|
||||
* the frame pool. If null, default settings are used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VASurfaceAttrib *attributes;
|
||||
int nb_attributes;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The surfaces IDs of all surfaces in the pool after creation.
|
||||
* Only valid if AVHWFramesContext.initial_pool_size was positive.
|
||||
* These are intended to be used as the render_targets arguments to
|
||||
* vaCreateContext().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VASurfaceID *surface_ids;
|
||||
int nb_surfaces;
|
||||
} AVVAAPIFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* VAAPI hardware pipeline configuration details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Allocated with av_hwdevice_hwconfig_alloc().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVAAPIHWConfig {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* ID of a VAAPI pipeline configuration.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VAConfigID config_id;
|
||||
} AVVAAPIHWConfig;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VAAPI_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VDPAU_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VDPAU_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <vdpau/vdpau.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VDPAU.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This API supports dynamic frame pools. AVHWFramesContext.pool must return
|
||||
* AVBufferRefs whose data pointer is a VdpVideoSurface.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This struct is allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVDPAUDeviceContext {
|
||||
VdpDevice device;
|
||||
VdpGetProcAddress *get_proc_address;
|
||||
} AVVDPAUDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* AVHWFramesContext.hwctx is currently not used
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VDPAU_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <VideoToolbox/VideoToolbox.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* An API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VIDEOTOOLBOX.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This API supports frame allocation using a native CVPixelBufferPool
|
||||
* instead of an AVBufferPool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the API user sets a custom pool, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return
|
||||
* AVBufferRefs whose data pointer is a CVImageBufferRef or CVPixelBufferRef.
|
||||
* Note that the underlying CVPixelBuffer could be retained by OS frameworks
|
||||
* depending on application usage, so it is preferable to let CoreVideo manage
|
||||
* the pool using the default implementation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Currently AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx are always NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVVTFramesContext {
|
||||
enum AVColorRange color_range;
|
||||
} AVVTFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert a VideoToolbox (actually CoreVideo) format to AVPixelFormat.
|
||||
* Returns AV_PIX_FMT_NONE if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat av_map_videotoolbox_format_to_pixfmt(uint32_t cv_fmt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an AVPixelFormat to a VideoToolbox (actually CoreVideo) format.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t av_map_videotoolbox_format_from_pixfmt(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Same as av_map_videotoolbox_format_from_pixfmt function, but can map and
|
||||
* return full range pixel formats via a flag.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t av_map_videotoolbox_format_from_pixfmt2(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, bool full_range);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an AVChromaLocation to a VideoToolbox/CoreVideo chroma location string.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CFStringRef av_map_videotoolbox_chroma_loc_from_av(enum AVChromaLocation loc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an AVColorSpace to a VideoToolbox/CoreVideo color matrix string.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CFStringRef av_map_videotoolbox_color_matrix_from_av(enum AVColorSpace space);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an AVColorPrimaries to a VideoToolbox/CoreVideo color primaries string.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CFStringRef av_map_videotoolbox_color_primaries_from_av(enum AVColorPrimaries pri);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Convert an AVColorTransferCharacteristic to a VideoToolbox/CoreVideo color transfer
|
||||
* function string.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
CFStringRef av_map_videotoolbox_color_trc_from_av(enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic trc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Update a CVPixelBufferRef's metadata to based on an AVFrame.
|
||||
* Returns 0 if no known equivalent was found.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_vt_pixbuf_set_attachments(void *log_ctx,
|
||||
CVPixelBufferRef pixbuf, const struct AVFrame *src);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VIDEOTOOLBOX_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,345 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VULKAN_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VULKAN_H
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(VK_USE_PLATFORM_WIN32_KHR)
|
||||
#define VK_USE_PLATFORM_WIN32_KHR
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <vulkan/vulkan.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "frame.h"
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct AVVkFrame AVVkFrame;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* API-specific header for AV_HWDEVICE_TYPE_VULKAN.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For user-allocated pools, AVHWFramesContext.pool must return AVBufferRefs
|
||||
* with the data pointer set to an AVVkFrame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Main Vulkan context, allocated as AVHWDeviceContext.hwctx.
|
||||
* All of these can be set before init to change what the context uses
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVulkanDeviceContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Custom memory allocator, else NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const VkAllocationCallbacks *alloc;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pointer to the instance-provided vkGetInstanceProcAddr loading function.
|
||||
* If NULL, will pick either libvulkan or libvolk, depending on libavutil's
|
||||
* compilation settings, and set this field.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
PFN_vkGetInstanceProcAddr get_proc_addr;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Vulkan instance. Must be at least version 1.3.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkInstance inst;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Physical device
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkPhysicalDevice phys_dev;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Active device
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkDevice act_dev;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* This structure should be set to the set of features that present and enabled
|
||||
* during device creation. When a device is created by FFmpeg, it will default to
|
||||
* enabling all that are present of the shaderImageGatherExtended,
|
||||
* fragmentStoresAndAtomics, shaderInt64 and vertexPipelineStoresAndAtomics features.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkPhysicalDeviceFeatures2 device_features;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Enabled instance extensions.
|
||||
* If supplying your own device context, set this to an array of strings, with
|
||||
* each entry containing the specified Vulkan extension string to enable.
|
||||
* Duplicates are possible and accepted.
|
||||
* If no extensions are enabled, set these fields to NULL, and 0 respectively.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char * const *enabled_inst_extensions;
|
||||
int nb_enabled_inst_extensions;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Enabled device extensions. By default, VK_KHR_external_memory_fd,
|
||||
* VK_EXT_external_memory_dma_buf, VK_EXT_image_drm_format_modifier,
|
||||
* VK_KHR_external_semaphore_fd and VK_EXT_external_memory_host are enabled if found.
|
||||
* If supplying your own device context, these fields takes the same format as
|
||||
* the above fields, with the same conditions that duplicates are possible
|
||||
* and accepted, and that NULL and 0 respectively means no extensions are enabled.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char * const *enabled_dev_extensions;
|
||||
int nb_enabled_dev_extensions;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family index for graphics operations, and the number of queues
|
||||
* enabled for it. If unavaiable, will be set to -1. Not required.
|
||||
* av_hwdevice_create() will attempt to find a dedicated queue for each
|
||||
* queue family, or pick the one with the least unrelated flags set.
|
||||
* Queue indices here may overlap if a queue has to share capabilities.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int queue_family_index;
|
||||
int nb_graphics_queues;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family index for transfer operations and the number of queues
|
||||
* enabled. Required.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int queue_family_tx_index;
|
||||
int nb_tx_queues;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family index for compute operations and the number of queues
|
||||
* enabled. Required.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int queue_family_comp_index;
|
||||
int nb_comp_queues;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family index for video encode ops, and the amount of queues enabled.
|
||||
* If the device doesn't support such, queue_family_encode_index will be -1.
|
||||
* Not required.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int queue_family_encode_index;
|
||||
int nb_encode_queues;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family index for video decode ops, and the amount of queues enabled.
|
||||
* If the device doesn't support such, queue_family_decode_index will be -1.
|
||||
* Not required.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int queue_family_decode_index;
|
||||
int nb_decode_queues;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locks a queue, preventing other threads from submitting any command
|
||||
* buffers to this queue.
|
||||
* If set to NULL, will be set to lavu-internal functions that utilize a
|
||||
* mutex.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*lock_queue)(struct AVHWDeviceContext *ctx, uint32_t queue_family, uint32_t index);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Similar to lock_queue(), unlocks a queue. Must only be called after locking.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*unlock_queue)(struct AVHWDeviceContext *ctx, uint32_t queue_family, uint32_t index);
|
||||
} AVVulkanDeviceContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Defines the behaviour of frame allocation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum AVVkFrameFlags {
|
||||
/* Unless this flag is set, autodetected flags will be OR'd based on the
|
||||
* device and tiling during av_hwframe_ctx_init(). */
|
||||
AV_VK_FRAME_FLAG_NONE = (1ULL << 0),
|
||||
|
||||
#if FF_API_VULKAN_CONTIGUOUS_MEMORY
|
||||
/* DEPRECATED: does nothing. Replaced by multiplane images. */
|
||||
AV_VK_FRAME_FLAG_CONTIGUOUS_MEMORY = (1ULL << 1),
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Disables multiplane images.
|
||||
* This is required to export/import images from CUDA. */
|
||||
AV_VK_FRAME_FLAG_DISABLE_MULTIPLANE = (1ULL << 2),
|
||||
} AVVkFrameFlags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocated as AVHWFramesContext.hwctx, used to set pool-specific options
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVVulkanFramesContext {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Controls the tiling of allocated frames.
|
||||
* If left as VK_IMAGE_TILING_OPTIMAL (0), will use optimal tiling.
|
||||
* Can be set to VK_IMAGE_TILING_LINEAR to force linear images,
|
||||
* or VK_IMAGE_TILING_DRM_FORMAT_MODIFIER_EXT to force DMABUF-backed
|
||||
* images.
|
||||
* @note Imported frames from other APIs ignore this.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkImageTiling tiling;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Defines extra usage of output frames. If non-zero, all flags MUST be
|
||||
* supported by the VkFormat. Otherwise, will use supported flags amongst:
|
||||
* - VK_IMAGE_USAGE_SAMPLED_BIT
|
||||
* - VK_IMAGE_USAGE_STORAGE_BIT
|
||||
* - VK_IMAGE_USAGE_TRANSFER_SRC_BIT
|
||||
* - VK_IMAGE_USAGE_TRANSFER_DST_BIT
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkImageUsageFlagBits usage;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extension data for image creation.
|
||||
* If DRM tiling is used, a VkImageDrmFormatModifierListCreateInfoEXT structure
|
||||
* can be added to specify the exact modifier to use.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Additional structures may be added at av_hwframe_ctx_init() time,
|
||||
* which will be freed automatically on uninit(), so users must only free
|
||||
* any structures they've allocated themselves.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *create_pnext;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extension data for memory allocation. Must have as many entries as
|
||||
* the number of planes of the sw_format.
|
||||
* This will be chained to VkExportMemoryAllocateInfo, which is used
|
||||
* to make all pool images exportable to other APIs if the necessary
|
||||
* extensions are present in enabled_dev_extensions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void *alloc_pnext[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A combination of AVVkFrameFlags. Unless AV_VK_FRAME_FLAG_NONE is set,
|
||||
* autodetected flags will be OR'd based on the device and tiling during
|
||||
* av_hwframe_ctx_init().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVVkFrameFlags flags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Flags to set during image creation. If unset, defaults to
|
||||
* VK_IMAGE_CREATE_ALIAS_BIT.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkImageCreateFlags img_flags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Vulkan format for each image. MUST be compatible with the pixel format.
|
||||
* If unset, will be automatically set.
|
||||
* There are at most two compatible formats for a frame - a multiplane
|
||||
* format, and a single-plane multi-image format.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkFormat format[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of layers each image will have.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int nb_layers;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Locks a frame, preventing other threads from changing frame properties.
|
||||
* Users SHOULD only ever lock just before command submission in order
|
||||
* to get accurate frame properties, and unlock immediately after command
|
||||
* submission without waiting for it to finish.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If unset, will be set to lavu-internal functions that utilize a mutex.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*lock_frame)(struct AVHWFramesContext *fc, AVVkFrame *vkf);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Similar to lock_frame(), unlocks a frame. Must only be called after locking.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void (*unlock_frame)(struct AVHWFramesContext *fc, AVVkFrame *vkf);
|
||||
} AVVulkanFramesContext;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Frame structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note the size of this structure is not part of the ABI, to allocate
|
||||
* you must use @av_vk_frame_alloc().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVVkFrame {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Vulkan images to which the memory is bound to.
|
||||
* May be one for multiplane formats, or multiple.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkImage img[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Tiling for the frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkImageTiling tiling;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Memory backing the images. Either one, or as many as there are planes
|
||||
* in the sw_format.
|
||||
* In case of having multiple VkImages, but one memory, the offset field
|
||||
* will indicate the bound offset for each image.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkDeviceMemory mem[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
size_t size[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* OR'd flags for all memory allocated
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkMemoryPropertyFlagBits flags;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Updated after every barrier. One per VkImage.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkAccessFlagBits access[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
VkImageLayout layout[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Synchronization timeline semaphores, one for each VkImage.
|
||||
* Must not be freed manually. Must be waited on at every submission using
|
||||
* the value in sem_value, and must be signalled at every submission,
|
||||
* using an incremented value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
VkSemaphore sem[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Up to date semaphore value at which each image becomes accessible.
|
||||
* One per VkImage.
|
||||
* Clients must wait on this value when submitting a command queue,
|
||||
* and increment it when signalling.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint64_t sem_value[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Internal data.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct AVVkFrameInternal *internal;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Describes the binding offset of each image to the VkDeviceMemory.
|
||||
* One per VkImage.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
ptrdiff_t offset[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Queue family of the images. Must be VK_QUEUE_FAMILY_IGNORED if
|
||||
* the image was allocated with the CONCURRENT concurrency option.
|
||||
* One per VkImage.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint32_t queue_family[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates a single AVVkFrame and initializes everything as 0.
|
||||
* @note Must be freed via av_free()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVVkFrame *av_vk_frame_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Returns the optimal per-plane Vulkan format for a given sw_format,
|
||||
* one for each plane.
|
||||
* Returns NULL on unsupported formats.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const VkFormat *av_vkfmt_from_pixfmt(enum AVPixelFormat p);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_HWCONTEXT_VULKAN_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,680 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Immersive Audio Model and Formats helper functions and defines
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_IAMF_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_IAMF_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* Immersive Audio Model and Formats API header
|
||||
* @see <a href="https://aomediacodec.github.io/iamf/">Immersive Audio Model and Formats</a>
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "avassert.h"
|
||||
#include "channel_layout.h"
|
||||
#include "dict.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_iamf_params Parameter Definition
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* Parameters as defined in section 3.6.1 and 3.8 of IAMF.
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_iamf_audio Audio Element
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* Audio Elements as defined in section 3.6 of IAMF.
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_iamf_mix Mix Presentation
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
* Mix Presentations as defined in section 3.7 of IAMF.
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_iamf_params
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAnimationType {
|
||||
AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_STEP,
|
||||
AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_LINEAR,
|
||||
AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_BEZIER,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mix Gain Parameter Data as defined in section 3.8.1 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This struct's size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFMixGain {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Duration for the given subblock, in units of
|
||||
* 1 / @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.parameter_rate "parameter_rate".
|
||||
* It must not be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int subblock_duration;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The type of animation applied to the parameter values.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAnimationType animation_type;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameter value that is applied at the start of the subblock.
|
||||
* Applies to all defined Animation Types.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Valid range of values is -128.0 to 128.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational start_point_value;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameter value that is applied at the end of the subblock.
|
||||
* Applies only to AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_LINEAR and
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_BEZIER Animation Types.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Valid range of values is -128.0 to 128.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational end_point_value;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameter value of the middle control point of a quadratic Bezier
|
||||
* curve, i.e., its y-axis value.
|
||||
* Applies only to AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_BEZIER Animation Type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Valid range of values is -128.0 to 128.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational control_point_value;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameter value of the time of the middle control point of a
|
||||
* quadratic Bezier curve, i.e., its x-axis value.
|
||||
* Applies only to AV_IAMF_ANIMATION_TYPE_BEZIER Animation Type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Valid range of values is 0.0 to 1.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational control_point_relative_time;
|
||||
} AVIAMFMixGain;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Demixing Info Parameter Data as defined in section 3.8.2 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This struct's size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFDemixingInfo {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Duration for the given subblock, in units of
|
||||
* 1 / @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.parameter_rate "parameter_rate".
|
||||
* It must not be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int subblock_duration;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Pre-defined combination of demixing parameters.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int dmixp_mode;
|
||||
} AVIAMFDemixingInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Recon Gain Info Parameter Data as defined in section 3.8.3 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This struct's size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFReconGain {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Duration for the given subblock, in units of
|
||||
* 1 / @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.parameter_rate "parameter_rate".
|
||||
* It must not be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int subblock_duration;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of gain values to be applied to each channel for each layer
|
||||
* defined in the Audio Element referencing the parent Parameter Definition.
|
||||
* Values for layers where the AV_IAMF_LAYER_FLAG_RECON_GAIN flag is not set
|
||||
* are undefined.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Channel order is: FL, C, FR, SL, SR, TFL, TFR, BL, BR, TBL, TBR, LFE
|
||||
*/
|
||||
uint8_t recon_gain[6][12];
|
||||
} AVIAMFReconGain;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFParamDefinitionType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subblocks are of struct type AVIAMFMixGain
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_MIX_GAIN,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subblocks are of struct type AVIAMFDemixingInfo
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_DEMIXING,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Subblocks are of struct type AVIAMFReconGain
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_RECON_GAIN,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameters as defined in section 3.6.1 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The struct is allocated by av_iamf_param_definition_alloc() along with an
|
||||
* array of subblocks, its type depending on the value of type.
|
||||
* This array is placed subblocks_offset bytes after the start of this struct.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note This struct's size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFParamDefinition {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset in bytes from the start of this struct, at which the subblocks
|
||||
* array is located.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t subblocks_offset;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Size in bytes of each element in the subblocks array.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
size_t subblock_size;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of subblocks in the array.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int nb_subblocks;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Parameters type. Determines the type of the subblock elements.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFParamDefinitionType type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Identifier for the paremeter substream.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int parameter_id;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Sample rate for the paremeter substream. It must not be 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int parameter_rate;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The accumulated duration of all blocks in this parameter definition,
|
||||
* in units of 1 / @ref parameter_rate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* May be 0, in which case all duration values should be specified in
|
||||
* another parameter definition referencing the same parameter_id.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int duration;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The duration of every subblock in the case where all subblocks, with
|
||||
* the optional exception of the last subblock, have equal durations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be 0 if subblocks have different durations.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int constant_subblock_duration;
|
||||
} AVIAMFParamDefinition;
|
||||
|
||||
const AVClass *av_iamf_param_definition_get_class(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates memory for AVIAMFParamDefinition, plus an array of {@code nb_subblocks}
|
||||
* amount of subblocks of the given type and initializes the variables. Can be
|
||||
* freed with a normal av_free() call.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size if non-NULL, the size in bytes of the resulting data array is written here.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFParamDefinition *av_iamf_param_definition_alloc(enum AVIAMFParamDefinitionType type,
|
||||
unsigned int nb_subblocks, size_t *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the subblock at the specified {@code idx}. Must be between 0 and nb_subblocks - 1.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.type "param definition type" defines
|
||||
* the struct type of the returned pointer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline void*
|
||||
av_iamf_param_definition_get_subblock(const AVIAMFParamDefinition *par, unsigned int idx)
|
||||
{
|
||||
av_assert0(idx < par->nb_subblocks);
|
||||
return (void *)((uint8_t *)par + par->subblocks_offset + idx * par->subblock_size);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_iamf_audio
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAmbisonicsMode {
|
||||
AV_IAMF_AMBISONICS_MODE_MONO,
|
||||
AV_IAMF_AMBISONICS_MODE_PROJECTION,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Recon gain information for the layer is present in AVIAMFReconGain
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_IAMF_LAYER_FLAG_RECON_GAIN (1 << 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A layer defining a Channel Layout in the Audio Element.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When @ref AVIAMFAudioElement.audio_element_type "the parent's Audio Element type"
|
||||
* is AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_CHANNEL, this corresponds to an Scalable Channel
|
||||
* Layout layer as defined in section 3.6.2 of IAMF.
|
||||
* For AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_SCENE, it is an Ambisonics channel
|
||||
* layout as defined in section 3.6.3 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_audio_element_add_layer()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFLayer {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
AVChannelLayout ch_layout;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A bitmask which may contain a combination of AV_IAMF_LAYER_FLAG_* flags.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int flags;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Output gain channel flags as defined in section 3.6.2 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This field is defined only if @ref AVIAMFAudioElement.audio_element_type
|
||||
* "the parent's Audio Element type" is AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_CHANNEL,
|
||||
* must be 0 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int output_gain_flags;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Output gain as defined in section 3.6.2 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Must be 0 if @ref output_gain_flags is 0.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational output_gain;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Ambisonics mode as defined in section 3.6.3 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This field is defined only if @ref AVIAMFAudioElement.audio_element_type
|
||||
* "the parent's Audio Element type" is AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_SCENE.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If AV_IAMF_AMBISONICS_MODE_MONO, channel_mapping is defined implicitly
|
||||
* (Ambisonic Order) or explicitly (Custom Order with ambi channels) in
|
||||
* @ref ch_layout.
|
||||
* If AV_IAMF_AMBISONICS_MODE_PROJECTION, @ref demixing_matrix must be set.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAmbisonicsMode ambisonics_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Demixing matrix as defined in section 3.6.3 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The length of the array is ch_layout.nb_channels multiplied by the sum of
|
||||
* the amount of streams in the group plus the amount of streams in the group
|
||||
* that are stereo.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* May be set only if @ref ambisonics_mode == AV_IAMF_AMBISONICS_MODE_PROJECTION,
|
||||
* must be NULL otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational *demixing_matrix;
|
||||
} AVIAMFLayer;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAudioElementType {
|
||||
AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_CHANNEL,
|
||||
AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_SCENE,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Information on how to combine one or more audio streams, as defined in
|
||||
* section 3.6 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_audio_element_alloc()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFAudioElement {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
AVIAMFLayer **layers;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of layers, or channel groups, in the Audio Element.
|
||||
* There may be 6 layers at most, and for @ref audio_element_type
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_SCENE, there may be exactly 1.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_audio_element_add_layer(), must not be
|
||||
* modified by any other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int nb_layers;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Demixing information used to reconstruct a scalable channel audio
|
||||
* representation.
|
||||
* The @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.type "type" must be
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_DEMIXING.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFParamDefinition *demixing_info;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Recon gain information used to reconstruct a scalable channel audio
|
||||
* representation.
|
||||
* The @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.type "type" must be
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_RECON_GAIN.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFParamDefinition *recon_gain_info;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Audio element type as defined in section 3.6 of IAMF.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFAudioElementType audio_element_type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Default weight value as defined in section 3.6 of IAMF.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int default_w;
|
||||
} AVIAMFAudioElement;
|
||||
|
||||
const AVClass *av_iamf_audio_element_get_class(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates a AVIAMFAudioElement, and initializes its fields with default values.
|
||||
* No layers are allocated. Must be freed with av_iamf_audio_element_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_iamf_audio_element_add_layer()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFAudioElement *av_iamf_audio_element_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a layer and add it to a given AVIAMFAudioElement.
|
||||
* It is freed by av_iamf_audio_element_free() alongside the rest of the parent
|
||||
* AVIAMFAudioElement.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the allocated layer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFLayer *av_iamf_audio_element_add_layer(AVIAMFAudioElement *audio_element);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVIAMFAudioElement and all its contents.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param audio_element pointer to pointer to an allocated AVIAMFAudioElement.
|
||||
* upon return, *audio_element will be set to NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_iamf_audio_element_free(AVIAMFAudioElement **audio_element);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_iamf_mix
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFHeadphonesMode {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The referenced Audio Element shall be rendered to stereo loudspeakers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_HEADPHONES_MODE_STEREO,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The referenced Audio Element shall be rendered with a binaural renderer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_HEADPHONES_MODE_BINAURAL,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Submix element as defined in section 3.7 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_submix_add_element()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFSubmixElement {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The id of the Audio Element this submix element references.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int audio_element_id;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Information required required for applying any processing to the
|
||||
* referenced and rendered Audio Element before being summed with other
|
||||
* processed Audio Elements.
|
||||
* The @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.type "type" must be
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_MIX_GAIN.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFParamDefinition *element_mix_config;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Default mix gain value to apply when there are no AVIAMFParamDefinition
|
||||
* with @ref element_mix_config "element_mix_config's"
|
||||
* @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.parameter_id "parameter_id" available for a
|
||||
* given audio frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational default_mix_gain;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A value that indicates whether the referenced channel-based Audio Element
|
||||
* shall be rendered to stereo loudspeakers or spatialized with a binaural
|
||||
* renderer when played back on headphones.
|
||||
* If the Audio Element is not of @ref AVIAMFAudioElement.audio_element_type
|
||||
* "type" AV_IAMF_AUDIO_ELEMENT_TYPE_CHANNEL, then this field is undefined.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
enum AVIAMFHeadphonesMode headphones_rendering_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A dictionary of strings describing the submix in different languages.
|
||||
* Must have the same amount of entries as
|
||||
* @ref AVIAMFMixPresentation.annotations "the mix's annotations", stored
|
||||
* in the same order, and with the same key strings.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @ref AVDictionaryEntry.key "key" is a string conforming to BCP-47 that
|
||||
* specifies the language for the string stored in
|
||||
* @ref AVDictionaryEntry.value "value".
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDictionary *annotations;
|
||||
} AVIAMFSubmixElement;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFSubmixLayoutType {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The layout follows the loudspeaker sound system convention of ITU-2051-3.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_SUBMIX_LAYOUT_TYPE_LOUDSPEAKERS = 2,
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The layout is binaural.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AV_IAMF_SUBMIX_LAYOUT_TYPE_BINAURAL = 3,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Submix layout as defined in section 3.7.6 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_submix_add_layout()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFSubmixLayout {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
enum AVIAMFSubmixLayoutType layout_type;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Channel layout matching one of Sound Systems A to J of ITU-2051-3, plus
|
||||
* 7.1.2ch and 3.1.2ch
|
||||
* If layout_type is not AV_IAMF_SUBMIX_LAYOUT_TYPE_LOUDSPEAKERS, this field
|
||||
* is undefined.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVChannelLayout sound_system;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The program integrated loudness information, as defined in
|
||||
* ITU-1770-4.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational integrated_loudness;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The digital (sampled) peak value of the audio signal, as defined
|
||||
* in ITU-1770-4.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational digital_peak;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The true peak of the audio signal, as defined in ITU-1770-4.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational true_peak;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The Dialogue loudness information, as defined in ITU-1770-4.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational dialogue_anchored_loudness;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The Album loudness information, as defined in ITU-1770-4.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational album_anchored_loudness;
|
||||
} AVIAMFSubmixLayout;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Submix layout as defined in section 3.7 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_mix_presentation_add_submix()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFSubmix {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of submix elements.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_submix_add_element(), must not be modified by any
|
||||
* other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmixElement **elements;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of elements in the submix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_submix_add_element(), must not be modified by any
|
||||
* other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int nb_elements;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of submix layouts.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_submix_add_layout(), must not be modified by any
|
||||
* other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmixLayout **layouts;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of layouts in the submix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_submix_add_layout(), must not be modified by any
|
||||
* other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int nb_layouts;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Information required for post-processing the mixed audio signal to
|
||||
* generate the audio signal for playback.
|
||||
* The @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.type "type" must be
|
||||
* AV_IAMF_PARAMETER_DEFINITION_MIX_GAIN.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFParamDefinition *output_mix_config;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Default mix gain value to apply when there are no AVIAMFParamDefinition
|
||||
* with @ref output_mix_config "output_mix_config's"
|
||||
* @ref AVIAMFParamDefinition.parameter_id "parameter_id" available for a
|
||||
* given audio frame.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVRational default_mix_gain;
|
||||
} AVIAMFSubmix;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Information on how to render and mix one or more AVIAMFAudioElement to generate
|
||||
* the final audio output, as defined in section 3.7 of IAMF.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The struct should be allocated with av_iamf_mix_presentation_alloc()
|
||||
* and its size is not a part of the public ABI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVIAMFMixPresentation {
|
||||
const AVClass *av_class;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Array of submixes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_mix_presentation_add_submix(), must not be modified
|
||||
* by any other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmix **submixes;
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Number of submixes in the presentation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Set by av_iamf_mix_presentation_add_submix(), must not be modified
|
||||
* by any other code.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
unsigned int nb_submixes;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A dictionary of strings describing the mix in different languages.
|
||||
* Must have the same amount of entries as every
|
||||
* @ref AVIAMFSubmixElement.annotations "Submix element annotations",
|
||||
* stored in the same order, and with the same key strings.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @ref AVDictionaryEntry.key "key" is a string conforming to BCP-47
|
||||
* that specifies the language for the string stored in
|
||||
* @ref AVDictionaryEntry.value "value".
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVDictionary *annotations;
|
||||
} AVIAMFMixPresentation;
|
||||
|
||||
const AVClass *av_iamf_mix_presentation_get_class(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocates a AVIAMFMixPresentation, and initializes its fields with default
|
||||
* values. No submixes are allocated.
|
||||
* Must be freed with av_iamf_mix_presentation_free().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_iamf_mix_presentation_add_submix()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFMixPresentation *av_iamf_mix_presentation_alloc(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a submix and add it to a given AVIAMFMixPresentation.
|
||||
* It is freed by av_iamf_mix_presentation_free() alongside the rest of the
|
||||
* parent AVIAMFMixPresentation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the allocated submix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmix *av_iamf_mix_presentation_add_submix(AVIAMFMixPresentation *mix_presentation);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a submix element and add it to a given AVIAMFSubmix.
|
||||
* It is freed by av_iamf_mix_presentation_free() alongside the rest of the
|
||||
* parent AVIAMFSubmix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the allocated submix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmixElement *av_iamf_submix_add_element(AVIAMFSubmix *submix);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate a submix layout and add it to a given AVIAMFSubmix.
|
||||
* It is freed by av_iamf_mix_presentation_free() alongside the rest of the
|
||||
* parent AVIAMFSubmix.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return a pointer to the allocated submix.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVIAMFSubmixLayout *av_iamf_submix_add_layout(AVIAMFSubmix *submix);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Free an AVIAMFMixPresentation and all its contents.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param mix_presentation pointer to pointer to an allocated AVIAMFMixPresentation.
|
||||
* upon return, *mix_presentation will be set to NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_iamf_mix_presentation_free(AVIAMFMixPresentation **mix_presentation);
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_IAMF_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,377 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_IMGUTILS_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_IMGUTILS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @file
|
||||
* misc image utilities
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_picture
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "pixdesc.h"
|
||||
#include "pixfmt.h"
|
||||
#include "rational.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Compute the max pixel step for each plane of an image with a
|
||||
* format described by pixdesc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The pixel step is the distance in bytes between the first byte of
|
||||
* the group of bytes which describe a pixel component and the first
|
||||
* byte of the successive group in the same plane for the same
|
||||
* component.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param max_pixsteps an array which is filled with the max pixel step
|
||||
* for each plane. Since a plane may contain different pixel
|
||||
* components, the computed max_pixsteps[plane] is relative to the
|
||||
* component in the plane with the max pixel step.
|
||||
* @param max_pixstep_comps an array which is filled with the component
|
||||
* for each plane which has the max pixel step. May be NULL.
|
||||
* @param pixdesc the AVPixFmtDescriptor for the image, describing its format
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_image_fill_max_pixsteps(int max_pixsteps[4], int max_pixstep_comps[4],
|
||||
const AVPixFmtDescriptor *pixdesc);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Compute the size of an image line with format pix_fmt and width
|
||||
* width for the plane plane.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return the computed size in bytes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_get_linesize(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int plane);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Fill plane linesizes for an image with pixel format pix_fmt and
|
||||
* width width.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param linesizes array to be filled with the linesize for each plane
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the AVPixelFormat of the image
|
||||
* @param width width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative error code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_linesizes(int linesizes[4], enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Fill plane sizes for an image with pixel format pix_fmt and height height.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param size the array to be filled with the size of each image plane
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the AVPixelFormat of the image
|
||||
* @param height height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param linesizes the array containing the linesize for each
|
||||
* plane, should be filled by av_image_fill_linesizes()
|
||||
* @return >= 0 in case of success, a negative error code otherwise
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The linesize parameters have the type ptrdiff_t here, while they are
|
||||
* int for av_image_fill_linesizes().
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_plane_sizes(size_t size[4], enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt,
|
||||
int height, const ptrdiff_t linesizes[4]);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Fill plane data pointers for an image with pixel format pix_fmt and
|
||||
* height height.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param data pointers array to be filled with the pointer for each image plane
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the AVPixelFormat of the image
|
||||
* @param height height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param ptr the pointer to a buffer which will contain the image
|
||||
* @param linesizes the array containing the linesize for each
|
||||
* plane, should be filled by av_image_fill_linesizes()
|
||||
* @return the size in bytes required for the image buffer, a negative
|
||||
* error code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_pointers(uint8_t *data[4], enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int height,
|
||||
uint8_t *ptr, const int linesizes[4]);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Allocate an image with size w and h and pixel format pix_fmt, and
|
||||
* fill pointers and linesizes accordingly.
|
||||
* The allocated image buffer has to be freed by using
|
||||
* av_freep(&pointers[0]).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pointers array to be filled with the pointer for each image plane
|
||||
* @param linesizes the array filled with the linesize for each plane
|
||||
* @param w width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param h height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the AVPixelFormat of the image
|
||||
* @param align the value to use for buffer size alignment
|
||||
* @return the size in bytes required for the image buffer, a negative
|
||||
* error code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_alloc(uint8_t *pointers[4], int linesizes[4],
|
||||
int w, int h, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int align);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy image plane from src to dst.
|
||||
* That is, copy "height" number of lines of "bytewidth" bytes each.
|
||||
* The first byte of each successive line is separated by *_linesize
|
||||
* bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* bytewidth must be contained by both absolute values of dst_linesize
|
||||
* and src_linesize, otherwise the function behavior is undefined.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst destination plane to copy to
|
||||
* @param dst_linesize linesize for the image plane in dst
|
||||
* @param src source plane to copy from
|
||||
* @param src_linesize linesize for the image plane in src
|
||||
* @param height height (number of lines) of the plane
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_image_copy_plane(uint8_t *dst, int dst_linesize,
|
||||
const uint8_t *src, int src_linesize,
|
||||
int bytewidth, int height);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy image data located in uncacheable (e.g. GPU mapped) memory. Where
|
||||
* available, this function will use special functionality for reading from such
|
||||
* memory, which may result in greatly improved performance compared to plain
|
||||
* av_image_copy_plane().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* bytewidth must be contained by both absolute values of dst_linesize
|
||||
* and src_linesize, otherwise the function behavior is undefined.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The linesize parameters have the type ptrdiff_t here, while they are
|
||||
* int for av_image_copy_plane().
|
||||
* @note On x86, the linesizes currently need to be aligned to the cacheline
|
||||
* size (i.e. 64) to get improved performance.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_image_copy_plane_uc_from(uint8_t *dst, ptrdiff_t dst_linesize,
|
||||
const uint8_t *src, ptrdiff_t src_linesize,
|
||||
ptrdiff_t bytewidth, int height);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy image in src_data to dst_data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_data destination image data buffer to copy to
|
||||
* @param dst_linesizes linesizes for the image in dst_data
|
||||
* @param src_data source image data buffer to copy from
|
||||
* @param src_linesizes linesizes for the image in src_data
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the AVPixelFormat of the image
|
||||
* @param width width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height height of the image in pixels
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_image_copy(uint8_t * const dst_data[4], const int dst_linesizes[4],
|
||||
const uint8_t * const src_data[4], const int src_linesizes[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Wrapper around av_image_copy() to workaround the limitation
|
||||
* that the conversion from uint8_t * const * to const uint8_t * const *
|
||||
* is not performed automatically in C.
|
||||
* @see av_image_copy()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline
|
||||
void av_image_copy2(uint8_t * const dst_data[4], const int dst_linesizes[4],
|
||||
uint8_t * const src_data[4], const int src_linesizes[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height)
|
||||
{
|
||||
av_image_copy(dst_data, dst_linesizes,
|
||||
(const uint8_t * const *)src_data, src_linesizes,
|
||||
pix_fmt, width, height);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy image data located in uncacheable (e.g. GPU mapped) memory. Where
|
||||
* available, this function will use special functionality for reading from such
|
||||
* memory, which may result in greatly improved performance compared to plain
|
||||
* av_image_copy().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The data pointers and the linesizes must be aligned to the maximum required
|
||||
* by the CPU architecture.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The linesize parameters have the type ptrdiff_t here, while they are
|
||||
* int for av_image_copy().
|
||||
* @note On x86, the linesizes currently need to be aligned to the cacheline
|
||||
* size (i.e. 64) to get improved performance.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_image_copy_uc_from(uint8_t * const dst_data[4], const ptrdiff_t dst_linesizes[4],
|
||||
const uint8_t * const src_data[4], const ptrdiff_t src_linesizes[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Setup the data pointers and linesizes based on the specified image
|
||||
* parameters and the provided array.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The fields of the given image are filled in by using the src
|
||||
* address which points to the image data buffer. Depending on the
|
||||
* specified pixel format, one or multiple image data pointers and
|
||||
* line sizes will be set. If a planar format is specified, several
|
||||
* pointers will be set pointing to the different picture planes and
|
||||
* the line sizes of the different planes will be stored in the
|
||||
* lines_sizes array. Call with src == NULL to get the required
|
||||
* size for the src buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To allocate the buffer and fill in the dst_data and dst_linesize in
|
||||
* one call, use av_image_alloc().
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_data data pointers to be filled in
|
||||
* @param dst_linesize linesizes for the image in dst_data to be filled in
|
||||
* @param src buffer which will contain or contains the actual image data, can be NULL
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format of the image
|
||||
* @param width the width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height the height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param align the value used in src for linesize alignment
|
||||
* @return the size in bytes required for src, a negative error code
|
||||
* in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_arrays(uint8_t *dst_data[4], int dst_linesize[4],
|
||||
const uint8_t *src,
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height, int align);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the size in bytes of the amount of data required to store an
|
||||
* image with the given parameters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format of the image
|
||||
* @param width the width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height the height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param align the assumed linesize alignment
|
||||
* @return the buffer size in bytes, a negative error code in case of failure
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_get_buffer_size(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height, int align);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Copy image data from an image into a buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* av_image_get_buffer_size() can be used to compute the required size
|
||||
* for the buffer to fill.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst a buffer into which picture data will be copied
|
||||
* @param dst_size the size in bytes of dst
|
||||
* @param src_data pointers containing the source image data
|
||||
* @param src_linesize linesizes for the image in src_data
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format of the source image
|
||||
* @param width the width of the source image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height the height of the source image in pixels
|
||||
* @param align the assumed linesize alignment for dst
|
||||
* @return the number of bytes written to dst, or a negative value
|
||||
* (error code) on error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_copy_to_buffer(uint8_t *dst, int dst_size,
|
||||
const uint8_t * const src_data[4], const int src_linesize[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height, int align);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check if the given dimension of an image is valid, meaning that all
|
||||
* bytes of the image can be addressed with a signed int.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param w the width of the picture
|
||||
* @param h the height of the picture
|
||||
* @param log_offset the offset to sum to the log level for logging with log_ctx
|
||||
* @param log_ctx the parent logging context, it may be NULL
|
||||
* @return >= 0 if valid, a negative error code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_check_size(unsigned int w, unsigned int h, int log_offset, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check if the given dimension of an image is valid, meaning that all
|
||||
* bytes of a plane of an image with the specified pix_fmt can be addressed
|
||||
* with a signed int.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param w the width of the picture
|
||||
* @param h the height of the picture
|
||||
* @param max_pixels the maximum number of pixels the user wants to accept
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format, can be AV_PIX_FMT_NONE if unknown.
|
||||
* @param log_offset the offset to sum to the log level for logging with log_ctx
|
||||
* @param log_ctx the parent logging context, it may be NULL
|
||||
* @return >= 0 if valid, a negative error code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_check_size2(unsigned int w, unsigned int h, int64_t max_pixels, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int log_offset, void *log_ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Check if the given sample aspect ratio of an image is valid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is considered invalid if the denominator is 0 or if applying the ratio
|
||||
* to the image size would make the smaller dimension less than 1. If the
|
||||
* sar numerator is 0, it is considered unknown and will return as valid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param w width of the image
|
||||
* @param h height of the image
|
||||
* @param sar sample aspect ratio of the image
|
||||
* @return 0 if valid, a negative AVERROR code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_check_sar(unsigned int w, unsigned int h, AVRational sar);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Overwrite the image data with black. This is suitable for filling a
|
||||
* sub-rectangle of an image, meaning the padding between the right most pixel
|
||||
* and the left most pixel on the next line will not be overwritten. For some
|
||||
* formats, the image size might be rounded up due to inherent alignment.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the pixel format has alpha, the alpha is cleared to opaque.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This can return an error if the pixel format is not supported. Normally, all
|
||||
* non-hwaccel pixel formats should be supported.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Passing NULL for dst_data is allowed. Then the function returns whether the
|
||||
* operation would have succeeded. (It can return an error if the pix_fmt is
|
||||
* not supported.)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_data data pointers to destination image
|
||||
* @param dst_linesize linesizes for the destination image
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format of the image
|
||||
* @param range the color range of the image (important for colorspaces such as YUV)
|
||||
* @param width the width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height the height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @return 0 if the image data was cleared, a negative AVERROR code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_black(uint8_t * const dst_data[4], const ptrdiff_t dst_linesize[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, enum AVColorRange range,
|
||||
int width, int height);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Overwrite the image data with a color. This is suitable for filling a
|
||||
* sub-rectangle of an image, meaning the padding between the right most pixel
|
||||
* and the left most pixel on the next line will not be overwritten. For some
|
||||
* formats, the image size might be rounded up due to inherent alignment.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the pixel format has alpha, it is also replaced. Color component values
|
||||
* are interpreted as native integers (or intfloats) regardless of actual pixel
|
||||
* format endianness.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This can return an error if the pixel format is not supported. Normally, all
|
||||
* non-hwaccel pixel formats should be supported.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Passing NULL for dst_data is allowed. Then the function returns whether the
|
||||
* operation would have succeeded. (It can return an error if the pix_fmt is
|
||||
* not supported.)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param dst_data data pointers to destination image
|
||||
* @param dst_linesize linesizes for the destination image
|
||||
* @param pix_fmt the pixel format of the image
|
||||
* @param color the color components to be used for the fill
|
||||
* @param width the width of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param height the height of the image in pixels
|
||||
* @param flags currently unused
|
||||
* @return 0 if the image data was filled, a negative AVERROR code otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_image_fill_color(uint8_t * const dst_data[4], const ptrdiff_t dst_linesize[4],
|
||||
enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, const uint32_t color[4],
|
||||
int width, int height, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_IMGUTILS_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2011 Mans Rullgard
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_INTFLOAT_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_INTFLOAT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
|
||||
union av_intfloat32 {
|
||||
uint32_t i;
|
||||
float f;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
union av_intfloat64 {
|
||||
uint64_t i;
|
||||
double f;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reinterpret a 32-bit integer as a float.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline float av_int2float(uint32_t i)
|
||||
{
|
||||
union av_intfloat32 v;
|
||||
v.i = i;
|
||||
return v.f;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reinterpret a float as a 32-bit integer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline uint32_t av_float2int(float f)
|
||||
{
|
||||
union av_intfloat32 v;
|
||||
v.f = f;
|
||||
return v.i;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reinterpret a 64-bit integer as a double.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline double av_int2double(uint64_t i)
|
||||
{
|
||||
union av_intfloat64 v;
|
||||
v.i = i;
|
||||
return v.f;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Reinterpret a double as a 64-bit integer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static av_always_inline uint64_t av_double2int(double f)
|
||||
{
|
||||
union av_intfloat64 v;
|
||||
v.f = f;
|
||||
return v.i;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_INTFLOAT_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,640 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_INTREADWRITE_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_INTREADWRITE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#include "libavutil/avconfig.h"
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "bswap.h"
|
||||
|
||||
typedef union {
|
||||
uint64_t u64;
|
||||
uint32_t u32[2];
|
||||
uint16_t u16[4];
|
||||
uint8_t u8 [8];
|
||||
double f64;
|
||||
float f32[2];
|
||||
} av_alias av_alias64;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef union {
|
||||
uint32_t u32;
|
||||
uint16_t u16[2];
|
||||
uint8_t u8 [4];
|
||||
float f32;
|
||||
} av_alias av_alias32;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef union {
|
||||
uint16_t u16;
|
||||
uint8_t u8 [2];
|
||||
} av_alias av_alias16;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Arch-specific headers can provide any combination of
|
||||
* AV_[RW][BLN](16|24|32|48|64) and AV_(COPY|SWAP|ZERO)(64|128) macros.
|
||||
* Preprocessor symbols must be defined, even if these are implemented
|
||||
* as inline functions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* R/W means read/write, B/L/N means big/little/native endianness.
|
||||
* The following macros require aligned access, compared to their
|
||||
* unaligned variants: AV_(COPY|SWAP|ZERO)(64|128), AV_[RW]N[8-64]A.
|
||||
* Incorrect usage may range from abysmal performance to crash
|
||||
* depending on the platform.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The unaligned variants are AV_[RW][BLN][8-64] and AV_COPY*U.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if ARCH_ARM
|
||||
# include "arm/intreadwrite.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_AVR32
|
||||
# include "avr32/intreadwrite.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_MIPS
|
||||
# include "mips/intreadwrite.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_PPC
|
||||
# include "ppc/intreadwrite.h"
|
||||
#elif ARCH_X86
|
||||
# include "x86/intreadwrite.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Map AV_RNXX <-> AV_R[BL]XX for all variants provided by per-arch headers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN16) && !defined(AV_RB16)
|
||||
# define AV_RB16(p) AV_RN16(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN16) && defined(AV_RB16)
|
||||
# define AV_RN16(p) AV_RB16(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN16) && !defined(AV_WB16)
|
||||
# define AV_WB16(p, v) AV_WN16(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN16) && defined(AV_WB16)
|
||||
# define AV_WN16(p, v) AV_WB16(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN24) && !defined(AV_RB24)
|
||||
# define AV_RB24(p) AV_RN24(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN24) && defined(AV_RB24)
|
||||
# define AV_RN24(p) AV_RB24(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN24) && !defined(AV_WB24)
|
||||
# define AV_WB24(p, v) AV_WN24(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN24) && defined(AV_WB24)
|
||||
# define AV_WN24(p, v) AV_WB24(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN32) && !defined(AV_RB32)
|
||||
# define AV_RB32(p) AV_RN32(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN32) && defined(AV_RB32)
|
||||
# define AV_RN32(p) AV_RB32(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN32) && !defined(AV_WB32)
|
||||
# define AV_WB32(p, v) AV_WN32(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN32) && defined(AV_WB32)
|
||||
# define AV_WN32(p, v) AV_WB32(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN48) && !defined(AV_RB48)
|
||||
# define AV_RB48(p) AV_RN48(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN48) && defined(AV_RB48)
|
||||
# define AV_RN48(p) AV_RB48(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN48) && !defined(AV_WB48)
|
||||
# define AV_WB48(p, v) AV_WN48(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN48) && defined(AV_WB48)
|
||||
# define AV_WN48(p, v) AV_WB48(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN64) && !defined(AV_RB64)
|
||||
# define AV_RB64(p) AV_RN64(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN64) && defined(AV_RB64)
|
||||
# define AV_RN64(p) AV_RB64(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN64) && !defined(AV_WB64)
|
||||
# define AV_WB64(p, v) AV_WN64(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN64) && defined(AV_WB64)
|
||||
# define AV_WN64(p, v) AV_WB64(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN */
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN16) && !defined(AV_RL16)
|
||||
# define AV_RL16(p) AV_RN16(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN16) && defined(AV_RL16)
|
||||
# define AV_RN16(p) AV_RL16(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN16) && !defined(AV_WL16)
|
||||
# define AV_WL16(p, v) AV_WN16(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN16) && defined(AV_WL16)
|
||||
# define AV_WN16(p, v) AV_WL16(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN24) && !defined(AV_RL24)
|
||||
# define AV_RL24(p) AV_RN24(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN24) && defined(AV_RL24)
|
||||
# define AV_RN24(p) AV_RL24(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN24) && !defined(AV_WL24)
|
||||
# define AV_WL24(p, v) AV_WN24(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN24) && defined(AV_WL24)
|
||||
# define AV_WN24(p, v) AV_WL24(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN32) && !defined(AV_RL32)
|
||||
# define AV_RL32(p) AV_RN32(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN32) && defined(AV_RL32)
|
||||
# define AV_RN32(p) AV_RL32(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN32) && !defined(AV_WL32)
|
||||
# define AV_WL32(p, v) AV_WN32(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN32) && defined(AV_WL32)
|
||||
# define AV_WN32(p, v) AV_WL32(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN48) && !defined(AV_RL48)
|
||||
# define AV_RL48(p) AV_RN48(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN48) && defined(AV_RL48)
|
||||
# define AV_RN48(p) AV_RL48(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN48) && !defined(AV_WL48)
|
||||
# define AV_WL48(p, v) AV_WN48(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN48) && defined(AV_WL48)
|
||||
# define AV_WN48(p, v) AV_WL48(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_RN64) && !defined(AV_RL64)
|
||||
# define AV_RL64(p) AV_RN64(p)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_RN64) && defined(AV_RL64)
|
||||
# define AV_RN64(p) AV_RL64(p)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(AV_WN64) && !defined(AV_WL64)
|
||||
# define AV_WL64(p, v) AV_WN64(p, v)
|
||||
# elif !defined(AV_WN64) && defined(AV_WL64)
|
||||
# define AV_WN64(p, v) AV_WL64(p, v)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Define AV_[RW]N helper macros to simplify definitions not provided
|
||||
* by per-arch headers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
|
||||
|
||||
union unaligned_64 { uint64_t l; } __attribute__((packed)) av_alias;
|
||||
union unaligned_32 { uint32_t l; } __attribute__((packed)) av_alias;
|
||||
union unaligned_16 { uint16_t l; } __attribute__((packed)) av_alias;
|
||||
|
||||
# define AV_RN(s, p) (((const union unaligned_##s *) (p))->l)
|
||||
# define AV_WN(s, p, v) ((((union unaligned_##s *) (p))->l) = (v))
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && (defined(_M_ARM) || defined(_M_X64) || defined(_M_ARM64)) && AV_HAVE_FAST_UNALIGNED
|
||||
|
||||
# define AV_RN(s, p) (*((const __unaligned uint##s##_t*)(p)))
|
||||
# define AV_WN(s, p, v) (*((__unaligned uint##s##_t*)(p)) = (v))
|
||||
|
||||
#elif AV_HAVE_FAST_UNALIGNED
|
||||
|
||||
# define AV_RN(s, p) (((const av_alias##s*)(p))->u##s)
|
||||
# define AV_WN(s, p, v) (((av_alias##s*)(p))->u##s = (v))
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB16
|
||||
# define AV_RB16(x) \
|
||||
((((const uint8_t*)(x))[0] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[1])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB16
|
||||
# define AV_WB16(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint16_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL16
|
||||
# define AV_RL16(x) \
|
||||
((((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL16
|
||||
# define AV_WL16(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint16_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB32
|
||||
# define AV_RB32(x) \
|
||||
(((uint32_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[0] << 24) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 16) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[3])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB32
|
||||
# define AV_WB32(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint32_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL32
|
||||
# define AV_RL32(x) \
|
||||
(((uint32_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[3] << 24) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 16) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL32
|
||||
# define AV_WL32(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint32_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB64
|
||||
# define AV_RB64(x) \
|
||||
(((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[0] << 56) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 48) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 40) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[3] << 32) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[4] << 24) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[5] << 16) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[6] << 8) | \
|
||||
(uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[7])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB64
|
||||
# define AV_WB64(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint64_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[7] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[6] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[5] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[4] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d)>>32; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>40; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>48; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d)>>56; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL64
|
||||
# define AV_RL64(x) \
|
||||
(((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[7] << 56) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[6] << 48) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[5] << 40) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[4] << 32) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[3] << 24) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 16) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
(uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL64
|
||||
# define AV_WL64(p, val) do { \
|
||||
uint64_t d = (val); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[4] = (d)>>32; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[5] = (d)>>40; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[6] = (d)>>48; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[7] = (d)>>56; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
|
||||
# define AV_RN(s, p) AV_RB##s(p)
|
||||
# define AV_WN(s, p, v) AV_WB##s(p, v)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_RN(s, p) AV_RL##s(p)
|
||||
# define AV_WN(s, p, v) AV_WL##s(p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_FAST_UNALIGNED */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN16
|
||||
# define AV_RN16(p) AV_RN(16, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN32
|
||||
# define AV_RN32(p) AV_RN(32, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN64
|
||||
# define AV_RN64(p) AV_RN(64, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN16
|
||||
# define AV_WN16(p, v) AV_WN(16, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN32
|
||||
# define AV_WN32(p, v) AV_WN(32, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN64
|
||||
# define AV_WN64(p, v) AV_WN(64, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
|
||||
# define AV_RB(s, p) AV_RN##s(p)
|
||||
# define AV_WB(s, p, v) AV_WN##s(p, v)
|
||||
# define AV_RL(s, p) av_bswap##s(AV_RN##s(p))
|
||||
# define AV_WL(s, p, v) AV_WN##s(p, av_bswap##s(v))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_RB(s, p) av_bswap##s(AV_RN##s(p))
|
||||
# define AV_WB(s, p, v) AV_WN##s(p, av_bswap##s(v))
|
||||
# define AV_RL(s, p) AV_RN##s(p)
|
||||
# define AV_WL(s, p, v) AV_WN##s(p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_RB8(x) (((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#define AV_WB8(p, d) do { ((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); } while(0)
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_RL8(x) AV_RB8(x)
|
||||
#define AV_WL8(p, d) AV_WB8(p, d)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB16
|
||||
# define AV_RB16(p) AV_RB(16, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB16
|
||||
# define AV_WB16(p, v) AV_WB(16, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL16
|
||||
# define AV_RL16(p) AV_RL(16, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL16
|
||||
# define AV_WL16(p, v) AV_WL(16, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB32
|
||||
# define AV_RB32(p) AV_RB(32, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB32
|
||||
# define AV_WB32(p, v) AV_WB(32, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL32
|
||||
# define AV_RL32(p) AV_RL(32, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL32
|
||||
# define AV_WL32(p, v) AV_WL(32, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB64
|
||||
# define AV_RB64(p) AV_RB(64, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB64
|
||||
# define AV_WB64(p, v) AV_WB(64, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL64
|
||||
# define AV_RL64(p) AV_RL(64, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL64
|
||||
# define AV_WL64(p, v) AV_WL(64, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB24
|
||||
# define AV_RB24(x) \
|
||||
((((const uint8_t*)(x))[0] << 16) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[2])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB24
|
||||
# define AV_WB24(p, d) do { \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL24
|
||||
# define AV_RL24(x) \
|
||||
((((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 16) | \
|
||||
(((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL24
|
||||
# define AV_WL24(p, d) do { \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RB48
|
||||
# define AV_RB48(x) \
|
||||
(((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[0] << 40) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 32) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 24) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[3] << 16) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[4] << 8) | \
|
||||
(uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[5])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WB48
|
||||
# define AV_WB48(p, darg) do { \
|
||||
uint64_t d = (darg); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[5] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[4] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>32; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d)>>40; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL48
|
||||
# define AV_RL48(x) \
|
||||
(((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[5] << 40) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[4] << 32) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[3] << 24) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[2] << 16) | \
|
||||
((uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[1] << 8) | \
|
||||
(uint64_t)((const uint8_t*)(x))[0])
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL48
|
||||
# define AV_WL48(p, darg) do { \
|
||||
uint64_t d = (darg); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[0] = (d); \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[1] = (d)>>8; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[2] = (d)>>16; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[3] = (d)>>24; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[4] = (d)>>32; \
|
||||
((uint8_t*)(p))[5] = (d)>>40; \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The AV_[RW]NA macros access naturally aligned data
|
||||
* in a type-safe way.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_RNA(s, p) (((const av_alias##s*)(p))->u##s)
|
||||
#define AV_WNA(s, p, v) (((av_alias##s*)(p))->u##s = (v))
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN16A
|
||||
# define AV_RN16A(p) AV_RNA(16, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN32A
|
||||
# define AV_RN32A(p) AV_RNA(32, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RN64A
|
||||
# define AV_RN64A(p) AV_RNA(64, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN16A
|
||||
# define AV_WN16A(p, v) AV_WNA(16, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN32A
|
||||
# define AV_WN32A(p, v) AV_WNA(32, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WN64A
|
||||
# define AV_WN64A(p, v) AV_WNA(64, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
|
||||
# define AV_RLA(s, p) av_bswap##s(AV_RN##s##A(p))
|
||||
# define AV_WLA(s, p, v) AV_WN##s##A(p, av_bswap##s(v))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define AV_RLA(s, p) AV_RN##s##A(p)
|
||||
# define AV_WLA(s, p, v) AV_WN##s##A(p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_RL64A
|
||||
# define AV_RL64A(p) AV_RLA(64, p)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef AV_WL64A
|
||||
# define AV_WL64A(p, v) AV_WLA(64, p, v)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The AV_COPYxxU macros are suitable for copying data to/from unaligned
|
||||
* memory locations.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_COPYU(n, d, s) AV_WN##n(d, AV_RN##n(s));
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY16U
|
||||
# define AV_COPY16U(d, s) AV_COPYU(16, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY32U
|
||||
# define AV_COPY32U(d, s) AV_COPYU(32, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY64U
|
||||
# define AV_COPY64U(d, s) AV_COPYU(64, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY128U
|
||||
# define AV_COPY128U(d, s) \
|
||||
do { \
|
||||
AV_COPY64U(d, s); \
|
||||
AV_COPY64U((char *)(d) + 8, (const char *)(s) + 8); \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Parameters for AV_COPY*, AV_SWAP*, AV_ZERO* must be
|
||||
* naturally aligned.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_COPY(n, d, s) \
|
||||
(((av_alias##n*)(d))->u##n = ((const av_alias##n*)(s))->u##n)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY16
|
||||
# define AV_COPY16(d, s) AV_COPY(16, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY32
|
||||
# define AV_COPY32(d, s) AV_COPY(32, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY64
|
||||
# define AV_COPY64(d, s) AV_COPY(64, d, s)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_COPY128
|
||||
# define AV_COPY128(d, s) \
|
||||
do { \
|
||||
AV_COPY64(d, s); \
|
||||
AV_COPY64((char*)(d)+8, (char*)(s)+8); \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_SWAP(n, a, b) FFSWAP(av_alias##n, *(av_alias##n*)(a), *(av_alias##n*)(b))
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_SWAP64
|
||||
# define AV_SWAP64(a, b) AV_SWAP(64, a, b)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_ZERO(n, d) (((av_alias##n*)(d))->u##n = 0)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_ZERO16
|
||||
# define AV_ZERO16(d) AV_ZERO(16, d)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_ZERO32
|
||||
# define AV_ZERO32(d) AV_ZERO(32, d)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_ZERO64
|
||||
# define AV_ZERO64(d) AV_ZERO(64, d)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AV_ZERO128
|
||||
# define AV_ZERO128(d) \
|
||||
do { \
|
||||
AV_ZERO64(d); \
|
||||
AV_ZERO64((char*)(d)+8); \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_INTREADWRITE_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* Lagged Fibonacci PRNG
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Michael Niedermayer
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_LFG_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_LFG_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Context structure for the Lagged Fibonacci PRNG.
|
||||
* The exact layout, types and content of this struct may change and should
|
||||
* not be accessed directly. Only its `sizeof()` is guaranteed to stay the same
|
||||
* to allow easy instanciation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVLFG {
|
||||
unsigned int state[64];
|
||||
int index;
|
||||
} AVLFG;
|
||||
|
||||
void av_lfg_init(AVLFG *c, unsigned int seed);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Seed the state of the ALFG using binary data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, negative value (AVERROR) on failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_lfg_init_from_data(AVLFG *c, const uint8_t *data, unsigned int length);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the next random unsigned 32-bit number using an ALFG.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Please also consider a simple LCG like state= state*1664525+1013904223,
|
||||
* it may be good enough and faster for your specific use case.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline unsigned int av_lfg_get(AVLFG *c){
|
||||
unsigned a = c->state[c->index & 63] = c->state[(c->index-24) & 63] + c->state[(c->index-55) & 63];
|
||||
c->index += 1U;
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the next random unsigned 32-bit number using a MLFG.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Please also consider av_lfg_get() above, it is faster.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline unsigned int av_mlfg_get(AVLFG *c){
|
||||
unsigned int a= c->state[(c->index-55) & 63];
|
||||
unsigned int b= c->state[(c->index-24) & 63];
|
||||
a = c->state[c->index & 63] = 2*a*b+a+b;
|
||||
c->index += 1U;
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the next two numbers generated by a Box-Muller Gaussian
|
||||
* generator using the random numbers issued by lfg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param lfg pointer to the contex structure
|
||||
* @param out array where the two generated numbers are placed
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_bmg_get(AVLFG *lfg, double out[2]);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_LFG_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,387 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_LOG_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_LOG_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#include "attributes.h"
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
typedef enum {
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_NA = 0,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_INPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_OUTPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_MUXER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEMUXER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_ENCODER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DECODER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_FILTER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_BITSTREAM_FILTER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_SWSCALER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_SWRESAMPLER,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_VIDEO_OUTPUT = 40,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_VIDEO_INPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_AUDIO_OUTPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_AUDIO_INPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_OUTPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_INPUT,
|
||||
AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_NB ///< not part of ABI/API
|
||||
}AVClassCategory;
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_IS_INPUT_DEVICE(category) \
|
||||
(((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_VIDEO_INPUT) || \
|
||||
((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_AUDIO_INPUT) || \
|
||||
((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_INPUT))
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_IS_OUTPUT_DEVICE(category) \
|
||||
(((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_VIDEO_OUTPUT) || \
|
||||
((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_AUDIO_OUTPUT) || \
|
||||
((category) == AV_CLASS_CATEGORY_DEVICE_OUTPUT))
|
||||
|
||||
struct AVOptionRanges;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Describe the class of an AVClass context structure. That is an
|
||||
* arbitrary struct of which the first field is a pointer to an
|
||||
* AVClass struct (e.g. AVCodecContext, AVFormatContext etc.).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct AVClass {
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* The name of the class; usually it is the same name as the
|
||||
* context structure type to which the AVClass is associated.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char* class_name;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* A pointer to a function which returns the name of a context
|
||||
* instance ctx associated with the class.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char* (*item_name)(void* ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* a pointer to the first option specified in the class if any or NULL
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_set_default_options()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const struct AVOption *option;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* LIBAVUTIL_VERSION with which this structure was created.
|
||||
* This is used to allow fields to be added without requiring major
|
||||
* version bumps everywhere.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
int version;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset in the structure where log_level_offset is stored.
|
||||
* 0 means there is no such variable
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int log_level_offset_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Offset in the structure where a pointer to the parent context for
|
||||
* logging is stored. For example a decoder could pass its AVCodecContext
|
||||
* to eval as such a parent context, which an av_log() implementation
|
||||
* could then leverage to display the parent context.
|
||||
* The offset can be NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int parent_log_context_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Category used for visualization (like color)
|
||||
* This is only set if the category is equal for all objects using this class.
|
||||
* available since version (51 << 16 | 56 << 8 | 100)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVClassCategory category;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callback to return the category.
|
||||
* available since version (51 << 16 | 59 << 8 | 100)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
AVClassCategory (*get_category)(void* ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Callback to return the supported/allowed ranges.
|
||||
* available since version (52.12)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int (*query_ranges)(struct AVOptionRanges **, void *obj, const char *key, int flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return next AVOptions-enabled child or NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void* (*child_next)(void *obj, void *prev);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Iterate over the AVClasses corresponding to potential AVOptions-enabled
|
||||
* children.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param iter pointer to opaque iteration state. The caller must initialize
|
||||
* *iter to NULL before the first call.
|
||||
* @return AVClass for the next AVOptions-enabled child or NULL if there are
|
||||
* no more such children.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The difference between child_next and this is that child_next
|
||||
* iterates over _already existing_ objects, while child_class_iterate
|
||||
* iterates over _all possible_ children.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const struct AVClass* (*child_class_iterate)(void **iter);
|
||||
} AVClass;
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @addtogroup lavu_log
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_log_constants Logging Constants
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Print no output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_QUIET -8
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Something went really wrong and we will crash now.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_PANIC 0
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Something went wrong and recovery is not possible.
|
||||
* For example, no header was found for a format which depends
|
||||
* on headers or an illegal combination of parameters is used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_FATAL 8
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Something went wrong and cannot losslessly be recovered.
|
||||
* However, not all future data is affected.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_ERROR 16
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Something somehow does not look correct. This may or may not
|
||||
* lead to problems. An example would be the use of '-vstrict -2'.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_WARNING 24
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Standard information.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_INFO 32
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Detailed information.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_VERBOSE 40
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Stuff which is only useful for libav* developers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_DEBUG 48
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Extremely verbose debugging, useful for libav* development.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_TRACE 56
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_MAX_OFFSET (AV_LOG_TRACE - AV_LOG_QUIET)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Sets additional colors for extended debugging sessions.
|
||||
* @code
|
||||
av_log(ctx, AV_LOG_DEBUG|AV_LOG_C(134), "Message in purple\n");
|
||||
@endcode
|
||||
* Requires 256color terminal support. Uses outside debugging is not
|
||||
* recommended.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_C(x) ((x) << 8)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Send the specified message to the log if the level is less than or equal
|
||||
* to the current av_log_level. By default, all logging messages are sent to
|
||||
* stderr. This behavior can be altered by setting a different logging callback
|
||||
* function.
|
||||
* @see av_log_set_callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avcl A pointer to an arbitrary struct of which the first field is a
|
||||
* pointer to an AVClass struct or NULL if general log.
|
||||
* @param level The importance level of the message expressed using a @ref
|
||||
* lavu_log_constants "Logging Constant".
|
||||
* @param fmt The format string (printf-compatible) that specifies how
|
||||
* subsequent arguments are converted to output.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log(void *avcl, int level, const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(3, 4);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Send the specified message to the log once with the initial_level and then with
|
||||
* the subsequent_level. By default, all logging messages are sent to
|
||||
* stderr. This behavior can be altered by setting a different logging callback
|
||||
* function.
|
||||
* @see av_log
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avcl A pointer to an arbitrary struct of which the first field is a
|
||||
* pointer to an AVClass struct or NULL if general log.
|
||||
* @param initial_level importance level of the message expressed using a @ref
|
||||
* lavu_log_constants "Logging Constant" for the first occurance.
|
||||
* @param subsequent_level importance level of the message expressed using a @ref
|
||||
* lavu_log_constants "Logging Constant" after the first occurance.
|
||||
* @param fmt The format string (printf-compatible) that specifies how
|
||||
* subsequent arguments are converted to output.
|
||||
* @param state a variable to keep trak of if a message has already been printed
|
||||
* this must be initialized to 0 before the first use. The same state
|
||||
* must not be accessed by 2 Threads simultaneously.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log_once(void* avcl, int initial_level, int subsequent_level, int *state, const char *fmt, ...) av_printf_format(5, 6);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Send the specified message to the log if the level is less than or equal
|
||||
* to the current av_log_level. By default, all logging messages are sent to
|
||||
* stderr. This behavior can be altered by setting a different logging callback
|
||||
* function.
|
||||
* @see av_log_set_callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avcl A pointer to an arbitrary struct of which the first field is a
|
||||
* pointer to an AVClass struct.
|
||||
* @param level The importance level of the message expressed using a @ref
|
||||
* lavu_log_constants "Logging Constant".
|
||||
* @param fmt The format string (printf-compatible) that specifies how
|
||||
* subsequent arguments are converted to output.
|
||||
* @param vl The arguments referenced by the format string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_vlog(void *avcl, int level, const char *fmt, va_list vl);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the current log level
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see lavu_log_constants
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return Current log level
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_log_get_level(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the log level
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see lavu_log_constants
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param level Logging level
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log_set_level(int level);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the logging callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note The callback must be thread safe, even if the application does not use
|
||||
* threads itself as some codecs are multithreaded.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @see av_log_default_callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param callback A logging function with a compatible signature.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log_set_callback(void (*callback)(void*, int, const char*, va_list));
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Default logging callback
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It prints the message to stderr, optionally colorizing it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param avcl A pointer to an arbitrary struct of which the first field is a
|
||||
* pointer to an AVClass struct.
|
||||
* @param level The importance level of the message expressed using a @ref
|
||||
* lavu_log_constants "Logging Constant".
|
||||
* @param fmt The format string (printf-compatible) that specifies how
|
||||
* subsequent arguments are converted to output.
|
||||
* @param vl The arguments referenced by the format string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log_default_callback(void *avcl, int level, const char *fmt,
|
||||
va_list vl);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Return the context name
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param ctx The AVClass context
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The AVClass class_name
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char* av_default_item_name(void* ctx);
|
||||
AVClassCategory av_default_get_category(void *ptr);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Format a line of log the same way as the default callback.
|
||||
* @param line buffer to receive the formatted line
|
||||
* @param line_size size of the buffer
|
||||
* @param print_prefix used to store whether the prefix must be printed;
|
||||
* must point to a persistent integer initially set to 1
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void av_log_format_line(void *ptr, int level, const char *fmt, va_list vl,
|
||||
char *line, int line_size, int *print_prefix);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Format a line of log the same way as the default callback.
|
||||
* @param line buffer to receive the formatted line;
|
||||
* may be NULL if line_size is 0
|
||||
* @param line_size size of the buffer; at most line_size-1 characters will
|
||||
* be written to the buffer, plus one null terminator
|
||||
* @param print_prefix used to store whether the prefix must be printed;
|
||||
* must point to a persistent integer initially set to 1
|
||||
* @return Returns a negative value if an error occurred, otherwise returns
|
||||
* the number of characters that would have been written for a
|
||||
* sufficiently large buffer, not including the terminating null
|
||||
* character. If the return value is not less than line_size, it means
|
||||
* that the log message was truncated to fit the buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_log_format_line2(void *ptr, int level, const char *fmt, va_list vl,
|
||||
char *line, int line_size, int *print_prefix);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Skip repeated messages, this requires the user app to use av_log() instead of
|
||||
* (f)printf as the 2 would otherwise interfere and lead to
|
||||
* "Last message repeated x times" messages below (f)printf messages with some
|
||||
* bad luck.
|
||||
* Also to receive the last, "last repeated" line if any, the user app must
|
||||
* call av_log(NULL, AV_LOG_QUIET, "%s", ""); at the end
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_SKIP_REPEATED 1
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Include the log severity in messages originating from codecs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Results in messages such as:
|
||||
* [rawvideo @ 0xDEADBEEF] [error] encode did not produce valid pts
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AV_LOG_PRINT_LEVEL 2
|
||||
|
||||
void av_log_set_flags(int arg);
|
||||
int av_log_get_flags(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_LOG_H */
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,66 @@
|
|||
/*
|
||||
* LZO 1x decompression
|
||||
* copyright (c) 2006 Reimar Doeffinger
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file is part of FFmpeg.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
|
||||
* version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
* Lesser General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
|
||||
* License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
* Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef AVUTIL_LZO_H
|
||||
#define AVUTIL_LZO_H
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @defgroup lavu_lzo LZO
|
||||
* @ingroup lavu_crypto
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @{
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/** @name Error flags returned by av_lzo1x_decode
|
||||
* @{ */
|
||||
/// end of the input buffer reached before decoding finished
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_INPUT_DEPLETED 1
|
||||
/// decoded data did not fit into output buffer
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_OUTPUT_FULL 2
|
||||
/// a reference to previously decoded data was wrong
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_INVALID_BACKPTR 4
|
||||
/// a non-specific error in the compressed bitstream
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_ERROR 8
|
||||
/** @} */
|
||||
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_INPUT_PADDING 8
|
||||
#define AV_LZO_OUTPUT_PADDING 12
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @brief Decodes LZO 1x compressed data.
|
||||
* @param out output buffer
|
||||
* @param outlen size of output buffer, number of bytes left are returned here
|
||||
* @param in input buffer
|
||||
* @param inlen size of input buffer, number of bytes left are returned here
|
||||
* @return 0 on success, otherwise a combination of the error flags above
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Make sure all buffers are appropriately padded, in must provide
|
||||
* AV_LZO_INPUT_PADDING, out must provide AV_LZO_OUTPUT_PADDING additional bytes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int av_lzo1x_decode(void *out, int *outlen, const void *in, int *inlen);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* @}
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* AVUTIL_LZO_H */
|
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Loading…
Reference in New Issue